Electrical BB
Electrical BB
Electrical BB
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Description SectionPage #
FORWARD................................................................................................................................................................. 01-1
INTRODUCTION........................................................................................................................................................ 02-1
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM OVERVIEW......................................................................................................................... 03-1
GENERAL ELECTRICAL.......................................................................................................................................... 04-1
GENERAL.................................................................................................................................................................. 05-1
BODY CONTOLLER.................................................................................................................................................. 06-1
BATTERY, IGNITION, AND ACCESSORY TAPS .................................................................................................... 07-1
CB AND 2-WAY RADIO ACCOMMODATION PACKAGES..................................................................................... 08-1
POWER WINDOWS, LOCKS, REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY.................................................................................... 09-1
FUSED BATTERY CONNECTIONS INSIDE CAB.................................................................................................... 10-1
PRODUCTIVITY FEATURES .................................................................................................................................... 11-1
FOG, PLOW, GUIDE POST AND WIG WAG ACCOMMODATIONS ....................................................................... 12-1
BODY BUILDER WIRING FOR STOP/TAIL/TURN LIGHTS.................................................................................... 13-1
WORK LIGHT AND OUTSIDE CAB POWER FEATURES....................................................................................... 14-1
AIR CONDITIONING.................................................................................................................................................. 15-1
TRANSMISSION SPARE INPUT/OUTPUTS AND TRANSMISSION CODES ......................................................... 16-1
GAUGES.................................................................................................................................................................... 17-1
REMOTE POWER MODULES................................................................................................................................... 18-1
SWITCHES AND SWITCH LABLE PART NUMBERS AND INFORMATION .......................................................... 19-1
POWER FEATURES USING REMOTE POWER MODULES................................................................................... 20-1
INDICATOR LIGHTS AND ALARMS........................................................................................................................ 21-1
BODY BUILDER INTEGRATION HARNESS............................................................................................................ 22-1
PTO POWER TAKE OFF .......................................................................................................................................... 23-1
REMOTE ENGINE SPEED CONTROL FEATURES................................................................................................. 24-1
REMOTE AIR SOLENOID MODULE......................................................................................................................... 25-1
REMOTE START/STOP ............................................................................................................................................ 26-1
LIFT GATE ACCOMMODATION PACKAGE............................................................................................................ 27-1
POWERPACK 3 PRIMARY AND TEMPORARY MOUNT FEATURE...................................................................... 28-1
THEFT DETERRENT................................................................................................................................................. 29-1
HYBRID ELECTRIC VEHICLE.................................................................................................................................. 30-1
ELECTRICAL FUNCTIONALITY WITHOUT ASSOCIATED FEATURE CODES..................................................... 31-1
CROSS REFERENCE ............................................................................................................................................... 32-1
INDEX
TABLE OF CONTENTS - PAGE 2 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 01 - PAGE 1
FORWARD
FORWARD
CONTENTS
In this manual, Navistar
Inc. provides information about its different products to assist those who wish to modify
these products for individual applications. Navistar does not recommend or approve any firm nor make any
judgments on the quality of the work performed by a particular firm. Individuals who use the services of a Body
Builder must satisfy themselves as to the quality of the work.
The party installing a body, a fifth wheel, any other equipment, or making any modifications to complete the vehicle
for delivery and make it road-ready is responsible to see that the completed vehicle complies with all applicable
certification procedures and safety standards, as may be set forth in Federal, State, and local statutes, rules and
regulations.
Specifications, descriptions and illustrative material in this literature are as accurate as known at time of publication
but are subject to change without notice. Illustrations are not always to scale and may include optional equipment
and accessories but may not include all standard equipment.
In addition to this Body Builder Electrical Data Book, publication CT-471, Body Builder Data, may be required. The
CT-471 - Body Builder Data is a set of booklets which includes a General Information Body Builder Data booklet for
information about the Navistar, Inc. product line; model series Body Builder Data booklets which contain information
related to the features and specifications for each of their respective models; Component Body Builder Data booklet
containing information for components which have common application in two or more truck series, Body Builder
Engine Programming information and any supplemental Body Builder Data booklets containing information for
components which have common application in two or more truck series.
SAFETY INFORMATION
IMPORTANT - Read the following before starting the service procedure.
You must follow your company safety procedures when you service or repair equipment. Be sure to understand all of
the procedures and instructions before you begin work on the unit.
Navistar uses the following types of notations to give warning of possible safety problems and to give information that
will prevent damage to the equipment being serviced or repaired.
WARNING - A warning indicates procedures that must be followed exactly. Personal injury or possible death, along
with damage to the vehicle, can occur if the procedure is not followed.
CAUTION - A caution indicates procedures that must be followed exactly. If the procedure is not followed, damage to
equipment or components can occur.
NOTE - A note indicates an operation, procedure or instruction that is important for correct service.
Some procedures require the use of special tools for safe and correct service. Failure to use these special tools when
required can cause injury to service personnel or damage to vehicle components.
SECTION 01 - PAGE 2 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
FORWARD
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 02 - PAGE 1
INTRODUCTION
INTRODUCTION
DISCLAIMER: NAVISTAR DOES NOT TAKE ANY RESPONSIBILITY FOR CUSTOMER OR BODY BUILDER
WIRING.
NOTE: After-market installed wiring for engine speed control must comply with the following guidelines:
1. Sealed switches and connectors must be used for switches and connections that are exposed to the weather or to salt spray emanating from
the vehicle's tires.
2. Route and clip wiring to minimize chafing and exposure to weather. Use conduit, loom, and/or tape to achieve this.
3. Fuse all power leads as close to the power source as possible. Remember fuses protect the wiring - size fuses accordingly.
4. All ground connections that will be made to the frame or body must be connected to clean bare metal. Remove all dirt, paint, grease and rust
that would insulate the terminal from ground. After connecting the ground, seal the connection with a good quality grease or surface sealant
to protect the connection from corrosion.
5. Spliced wires should be twisted together and soldered. Use a heat shrink tube with a meltable inner wall to seal the connection. Do not expose
splices to the weather.
WARNING: To avoid serious personal injury, possible death, or damage to the vehicle, make sure the transmission is
in neutral, parking brake is set, and the wheels are blocked before undertaking service procedures. In addition, turn
off the engine when you leave the vehicle. Never leave the vehicle unattended with the engine running.
WARNING: To avoid personal injury, possible death, or damage to the vehicle when adding electrical features,
disconnect batteries. Reconnect batteries when installation is complete.
Whenever disconnecting battery terminals always disconnect the ground terminal first. When reconnecting,
always connect the ground terminal last.
To prevent injury to the eyes, face, limbs and body, it is imperative that lighted materials, flames or sparks be kept
away from the vent openings of the battery. The gas mixture in the battery cells, which escapes through the
vents, could ignite and/or cause an explosion. This is particularly true when jumper cables are being used.
In addition, inhaling of gas produced by the normal operation of the battery could result in partial or permanent
damage to the respiratory system.
Always wear eye protection when working around batteries. Do not attempt to jump-start a vehicle having a
frozen battery because the battery may explode. If a frozen battery is suspected, examine all fill vents on the
battery. If ice can be seen, do not attempt to start with jumper cables as long as the battery remains frozen. Thaw
out the battery and recharge.
Do not check battery condition by shorting (flashing) across terminals.
Failure to observe these instructions could result in personal injury and/or damage to the vehicle.
Battery cable terminals must be clean and tight. Use hot water and common baking soda for removing terminal
corrosion and for cleaning the top of the battery. Brighten the contact surface with steel wool, apply a light coat of
lubricant sealing grease such as Fleetrite
DIAMOND LOGIC
Diamond Logic
Builder software,
provides the Body Builder with unprecedented flexibility in adding and customizing the electrical features on a
vehicle.
International
Diamond Logic
Electrical System
f_003
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 04 - PAGE 1
GENERAL ELECTRICAL
GENERAL ELECTRICAL
Navistar vehicle electrical systems are becoming increasingly complex with the addition of a BC, electronic engine
and transmission controls, electronically driven instrument gauges, and Antilock Brake Systems (ABS) to name a
few. While most systems still operate on battery voltage (12 volts), some systems operate at as high as 107 volts
(electronic fuel injection) and as low as five (5) volts (electronic engine controls).
Navistar publishes Electrical Circuit Diagram Manuals for all its models. Body builders and installers should refer to
these manuals before connecting body lights and accessories to the vehicle electrical system to assure that circuits
chosen are both appropriate and not overloaded. Modifications not defined in the circuit diagram book are not to be
made to the vehicle electrical/electronic control systems without first contacting Navistar for assistance at its Tech
Central Department, telephone 1-800-336-4500.
J1939 HIGH SPEED DATA LINK CABLE (SAE J1939/15)
The information in this section applies to all 3200, DuraStar, WorkStar, and 8000 models.
Performing the proper repairs or modifications of the cable is critical to the integrity and performance of the
vehicle systems. (For repair procedure see Electrical Troubleshooting Guide - S08250 or Data Link Repair in
this manual.) This information based on SAE J1939/15.
COLOR CODE SYSTEM FOR INTERNATIONAL
TRUCK
Table 1
NOTE: The wiring in multiple conductor jacketed cable does not follow the above color code system. See the
electrical circuit diagram manual for specific colors and circuit numbers used with each system. Use only
GXL", SXL" or TXL" insulated wire. Crimp and solder all connections.
RECOMMENDED CIRCUIT PROTECTION
Table 2
Color Description
Red Alternator/Battery Feeds
Pink Ignition Feeds
Light Blue Accessory Feeds
Yellow Headlight System (Daytime Running Lights, Fog, Hi-Beam,etc.); Data Link J1939(+)
Dark Blue Interior Lights (Dome, Panel, etc.); Data Link J1708(+)
Brown Exterior Lights (Tail, Market, Clearance, etc.)
Orange Exterior Lights (Turn, back-up, etc.)
Gray Engine/Chassis Systems (Fuel Solenoid, Horn, etc.); Data Link J1708(-)
Tan Engine/Chassis Monitoring Systems (Gauges)
Green Data Link J1939(-)
Light Green Driver Aid Systems (Windshield Washer, Heater, etc.)
Violet Engine Controls - Electronic
White GND
Black Battery GND Cables or Computer Data Link Systems
Wire Gauge Protective Device Size Maximum Current (Amps)
18 Ga 10 AMP Fuse/Circuit Breaker 8 A
16 Ga 15 AMP Fuse/Circuit Breaker 12 A
14 Ga 20 AMP Fuse/Circuit Breaker 16 A
12 Ga 25 AMP Fuse/Circuit Breaker 20 A
10 Ga 30 AMP Fuse/Circuit Breaker 24 A
8 Ga 12 Gauge Fusible Link 80 A
6 Ga 10 Gauge Fusible Link 108 A
4 Ga 2-12 Gauge Fusible Link 160 A
SECTION 04 - PAGE 2 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
GENERAL ELECTRICAL
CAUTION: Wire gauge is designed to match fuse/circuit breaker rating. Do not increase the size of a circuit
breaker or fuse. To do so could cause wiring to overheat and burn.
CIRCUIT PROTECTION DEVICES
Table 3
Circuit breakers and fuses can be installed in the chassis wiring using the following in-line connectors:
1676841C91 - Inline socket and cable for circuit breaker/fuse (20 A Maximum)
1682115C91 - Inline socket and cable for circuit breaker/fuse (30 A Maximum)
Table 4
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS COMMONLY USED BY EQUIPMENT INSTALLERS
Table 5
NOTE: Any unused circuit cavities must be plugged with sealing plugs provided with chassis harness.
Size Circuit Breakers Part Number Color
7.5 A Type III - Manual Reset 3536177C1 Brown
10 A Type III - Manual Reset 3536178C1 Red
15 A Type III - Manual Reset 3536179C1 Blue
20 A Type III - Manual Reset 3536180C1 Yellow
25 A Type III - Manual Reset 3536181C1 White
30 A Type III - Manual Reset 3536182C1 Green
Size Fuses Part Number Color
5 A Mini - SAE J2077 3534208C1 Tan
7.5 A Mini - SAE J2077 3546109C1 Brown
10 A Mini - SAE J2077 3534209C1 Red
15 A Mini - SAE J2077 3534210C1 Blue
20 A Mini - SAE J2077 3534211C1 Yellow
25 A Mini - SAE J2077 3534212C1 Natural
30 A Mini - SAE J2077 3534213C1 Green
Size Devices Part Number Color
20 A Autofuse 131224C1 Yellow
20 A Circuit Breaker - Type III 3529688C1
30 A Autofuse 571691C1 Green
30 A Circuit Breaker - Type III 3529690C1
3200, DuraStar,
WorkStar
Type
At Fuse Block
3534164C1 Terminal Fuse Block (18/20 Gauge)
3573312C1 Terminal Fuse Block (14/16 Gauge)
3573311C1 Terminal Fuse Block (10/12 Gauge)
At Tail Lights
589390C1 Seal, Wire - (Blue) .165-.138 O.D. Cable (12-14 Gauge)
589391C1 Seal, Wire - (Gray) .137-.111 O.D. Cable (14-16 Gauge)
1652325C1 Seal, Wire - (LtGn) .110-.080 O.D. Cable (16-20 Gauge)
1661375C2 Body Connector, 5-Way Male
1661377C1 Terminal, Female - 14/16 Gauge
1661376C1 Lock, 5-Way Male Connector
1677851C1 Body Connector, 5-Way Female
1671609C1 Terminal, Male - 14-16 Gauge
1677914C1 Lock, 5-Way Female Connector
587579C1 Sealing Plug (for Empty Connector Cavities)
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 04 - PAGE 3
GENERAL ELECTRICAL
CONNECTORS 4450 AND 4460
Connectors 4450 and 4460 have their mating connectors attached filled with cavity plugs. To use connectors,
remove cavity plugs and use the following:
Table 6
STANDARD TERMINALS AND SPLICES
1. Cut the cable just before the insulation wings on the terminal.
2. Remove the insulation being careful not to cut any of the wire strands ( inch exposed copper stranding is
typical).
3. Position cable in the new terminal.
4. Hand crimp the core wings first, then the insulation wings.
5. Check to ensure copper stranding is not cut as this can cause hot spots.
6. Ensure no copper is exposed beyond the insulation crimp as this will allow a pivot point and the copper
stranding will break.
7. Solder all hand crimped terminals and electrically check for continuity.
NOTE: Always use the recommended crimp tool for each terminal. A detailed crimp chart is included in the
repair kit.
Terminals Wire Gauge
2033912C1 12, 14
2033911C1 16, 18, 20
Cavity Seals Wire Gauge
0589390C1 12
0589391C1 14
1652325C1 16, 18, 20
Mating Connector Part Numbers
4450 Connector 2039312C91
4450 Lock 2039342C1
4460 Connector 3553961C1
4460 Lock 3554019C1
SECTION 04 - PAGE 4 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
GENERAL ELECTRICAL
1. Mating End
2. Core Wings
3. Insulation Wings
4. Cable
5. Lock Tang
6. Insulation
7. Wire Strands
8. Solder
SPLICE CLIP INSTALLATION
NOTE: A new clip must be located a minimum of 1.5 inches (40 mm) from a connector, sleeve or another clip
1. Cut off the old clip or bad section of wire.
2. Remove the insulation being careful not to cut any of the wire strands.
3. Install the proper clip on the wire strands.
4. Hand crimp the clip until securely fastened.
5. Solder the clip and electrically check for continuity.
6. Cover the entire splice with splice tape. Extend the tape onto the insulation on both sides of the splice(s).
Standard Terminal
f_004
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 04 - PAGE 5
GENERAL ELECTRICAL
1. Insulation
2. Wire Strands
3. Clip (Positioned Correctly)
4. Crimped Correctly
5. Solder
6. Tape
SPLICE INSPECTION
1. Terminal Application
2. Insulation Crimp
3. Wire Strands Visible in this Area
4. Core Crimp
5. Solder Application
6. Good Solder Application
7. Crimp and Seal Heat Application
8. Evidence of Glue
Splice Clip Installation
f_005
Splice Inspection
f_006
SECTION 04 - PAGE 6 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
GENERAL ELECTRICAL
CRIMP AND SEAL SPLICE SLEEVE INSTALLATION
NOTE: A new sleeve must be located a minimum of 1.5 inches (40 mm) from a connector, clip or another
sleeve.
1. Cut off the old sleeve or bad section of the wire.
2. Remove insulation being careful not to cut any of the wire strands.
3. Install the proper sleeve on the wire strands, making sure the ends of the wire hit the stop.
4. Hand crimp to the sleeve. Gently tug on the wire to make sure that they are secure.
NOTE: Always use the recommended crimp tool for each sleeve. A detailed crimp chart is included in the
Repair Kit.
CAUTION: Use appropriate heat gun. Do not use a match or open flame to heat the sleeve seal.
5. Electrically check the sleeve and wire cable for continuity.
1. Wire Strands
2. Wire Stop
3. Crimp Connector
4. Evidence of Glue
DATA LINK REPAIR
J1708
Repairs to damaged J1708 circuits should be accomplished using similar types of wiring. Splices should be
crimped and soldered. Insure the twist in the wire pair (one twist per inch) is maintained and individual wires are
covered with heat shrink.
J1939/11 Shielded Only
Repairs to damaged J1939 circuits should be accomplished using identical types of wiring. Splices should be
crimped, soldered and covered with heat shrink. Insure the twist in the wire pair (one twist per inch) is
maintained and that any wire bundles in the engine compartment are shielded and covered with heat shrink.
Part Number Description Quantity
3517501C1 12-10 AWG Splice 2
3517502C1 16-14 AWG Splice 7
3517503C1 22-18 AWG Splice 2
2644000R1 Dual Wall Heat Shrink, 50mm 50
Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeve Installation
f_007
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 04 - PAGE 7
GENERAL ELECTRICAL
Wire Repair
This instruction addresses termination and splicing of J1939 wire.
1. Strip back (view C) outer shield 3 1/8 in. (76 mm).
2. Strip (view A) green wire and yellow wire 1/4 in. (6.35 mm) being careful not to cut individual strands.
3. Re-twist all three wires (one twist per inch) if they have separated.
4. Sleeve drain wire (view B) may be soldered to aid in sleeving.
5. Install terminals on green and yellow wire ends, and crimp.
6. The 1/4" heat shrink tube (view D) will be shrunk later after the wires have been inserted into the crimp connector.
WIRE SPLICING
1. Strip wire ends 1/4 inch.
2. Re-twist any loose wires (one twist per inch).
Preparation of J1939 Wire for Connection
f_008
Re-Twist Any Loose Wires
f_009
SECTION 04 - PAGE 8 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
GENERAL ELECTRICAL
3. Slide 2-inch pieces of insulated heat shrink tube over wire for later use.
4. Put heat shrink tube over each wire.
5. Insert ends of wires into splice joint and crimp.
6. Solder the wires and crimp joint together.
7. Center heat shrink tube over splice and shrink.
Put Heat Shrink Tube Over Each Wire
f_010
Solder Wires Together
f_011
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 04 - PAGE 9
GENERAL ELECTRICAL
8. Wrap wires with foil tape. Maintain at least 1/2 wrap overlap.
.
9. Center heat shrink tube over the splice and shrink.
Center Heat Shrink Tube Over Splice
f_012
Center Heat Shrink Tube Over Cable
f_013
Center Heat Shrink Tube Over Cable
f_014
SECTION 04 - PAGE 10 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
GENERAL ELECTRICAL
J1939 HIGH SPEED DATA LINK CABLE (SAE J1939/15)
Performing the proper repairs or modifications of the cable is critical to the integrity and performance of the
vehicle systems. (For repair procedure see Electrical Troubleshooting Guide - S08250 or Data Link Repair in
this manual.) This information is based on SAE J1939/15 and TMC RP 142.
These instructions are intended for modifications that meet the SAE spec; i.e., no internal resistor. When
extending the backbone the proper materials must be used. The data link cable consists of a twisted pair of
insulated wires and is covered by an insulating jacket. The data link cable must meet the SAE - specified
characteristic impedance of 120 ohms. Never splice regular automotive type wire such as GXL, SXL or TXL
into the data link cable. Use data link cable furnished by Raychem, part number 2021D0309.
The backbone is the main part of the cable. This is terminated at each end with a 120 ohm resistor. When
adding a device the backbone must be extended. This is done by removing the resistor, inserting the backbone
extension, then plugging the resistor and the device into the extension.
The International
high performance vehicle will always have a power train J1939 system. This is for key
operations that come from the factory direct. A second J1939 system is put in place for body builders and will
be referred to as body builder J1939. Circuit diagrams are shown in Chapter 9 of the Circuit Diagram Book
(S08322) under Remote Power Units, Solenoid Packs, Remote Engine Speed Controller.
J1939
J1939 is a high speed serial communications data link. The system requires two resistor caps. The first resistor
cap for Body Builder J1939 currently starts in the engine compartment. The second resistor cap ends where the
last module is placed. The wire between these two resistors is called the backbone. The backbone cannot be
longer than 131.2 feet (40m). A module can tap into the backbone. This point is called the Node. The distance
between two nodes cannot be less than 3.9 inches (0.1m). The cable length from the node to the module
cannot be longer than 9.8 feet (3m).
With the research of the robustness of the J1939-15 lite (unshielded) International
TRUCKS
AND BUSES
Only a trained technician may perform service inside high voltage components. When working around or
maintaining high voltage circuits, please seek high voltage training.
WARNING: To avoid property damage, personal injury, or death; refer to the manufacturer's service information
before working on any high voltage equipment. By definition, high voltage circuits and components contain
voltage levels that may cause equipment damage, electrical shock, and/or electrocution if handled incorrectly.
NOTE: The intent of this section IS to provide some basic guidelines when working on or around International
vehicles that are equipped with high voltage electrical equipment and circuits. For specific instructions,
maintenance, or service information on specific equipment or options, refer to the service manuals for the
specified truck models and component(s). It IS NOT the intent of this section to provide detailed service
instructions for high voltage equipment and circuits.
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 04 - PAGE 11
GENERAL ELECTRICAL
High voltage systems require the maintainer to be familiar with two types of electrical systems.
DC (Direct Current)
Most DC systems on today's trucks use 12 volt negative GND. Some systems can store DC electricity in
batteries with operating voltages as high as 600 DC volts.
AC (Alternating Current)
The main difference between AC and DC systems is that the voltage levels in DC systems remain constant
while the voltage levels in AC systems are constantly changing. When measuring an AC system, it is important
to know that the average voltage is zero, and that is why A VOLTMETER SET TO DC WILL NOT INDICATE
THE PRESENCE OF AN AC VOLTAGE WHEN CONNECTED TO AN AC CIRCUIT!
High voltage can be lethal. Always refer to the manufacturer of the high voltage component when maintenance
or repairs are needed. In most cases, diagnostics and repair are performed after the high voltage circuits are
disabled. If working around or maintaining high voltage circuits, please seek high voltage training.
WARNING: To avoid property damage, personal injury, or death, circuits must be checked using a voltmeter for
the presence of both DC and AC voltages. A voltmeter set to DC will not indicate the presence of an AC voltage
when connected to an AC circuit! Contacting an unknown AC or DC voltage may cause equipment damage,
electrical shock, and/or electrocution.
Only a trained technician may perform service inside high voltage components. If working around or
maintaining high voltage circuits, please seek high voltage training.
UNDERSTANDING HIGH VOLTAGE EQUIPMENT AND CIRCUITS ON INTERNATIONAL
PRODUCTS
Some examples of high voltage equipment that can be encountered on products are as follows:
Auxiliary Power Units (APUs)
APUs are basically small diesel powered generator units that are integrated into the vehicle electrical system.
APUs are utilized in combination with inverters and battery chargers. APUs are often set up to automatically
start when the electrical management system deems it necessary to maintain battery charge or electrical
demand requires it.
NOTE: APU high voltage wiring may NOT be marked for easy identification as high voltage.
Shore Power
Shore power is a connection from a vehicle to an external 120 volt AC power source. The vehicle is equipped
with an exterior receptacle that allows connection to an external shore power source.
NOTE: High voltage shore power wiring may NOT be marked for easy identification as high voltage.
Inverters
Inverters are electronic devices used to change DC (Direct Current) into AC (Alternating Current). Some
inverters contain converters that also convert AC to DC for battery charging or running 12V equipment.
NOTE: High voltage wiring for inverters may NOT be marked for easy identification as high voltage.
Hybrid Electric Vehicles (HEVs)
HEVs combine internal combustion engines with high voltage batteries, electric motors, and inverters to offer
higher fuel efficiency and lower emissions without compromising power, range, and convenient fueling of
conventional vehicles. Regardless of the HEV design, high electrical voltages and currents are present.
NOTE: The industry standard for high voltage cables is for the cables to be covered in ORANGE CONDUIT.
If orange conduit is observed on a vehicle, please review the safety precautions for that system.
SECTION 04 - PAGE 12 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
GENERAL ELECTRICAL
HOW TO IDENTIFY HIGH VOLTAGE CIRCUITS
High voltage circuits are not always connected with large wires. The best way to identify high voltage
equipment or circuits is to be familiar with the equipment and circuit diagrams as well as to look for high voltage
warning labels and orange conduit. Inspect the vehicle for any equipment or circuits added after the truck was
built (owner/operators may add high voltage components such as inverters or APUs).
All electrical circuits associated with APUs, shore power, inverters, and HEVs should be considered high
voltage. The standard for high voltage cabling on HEVs is orange. APUs, inverters, shore power, and cabin
110/120V outlet wiring may not indicate high voltage by visual inspection (they may not be marked and are
NOT orange in color).
SERVICING NAVISTAR PRODUCTS
The following steps outline the appropriate method to follow to identify and address any maintenance or service
on Navistar products with factory-installed high voltage equipment.
1. Complete related training prior to attempting to identify and service any high voltage system.
2. Review the line-set ticket provided with the vehicle or from ISIS, and identify all high voltage components.
Inspect the vehicle for any equipment or circuits added after the truck was built (owner/operators may add
high voltage components such as inverters or APUs that could be live and powering circuits in the vehicle
EVEN WITH THE IGN OFF AND THE BATTERIES DISCONNECTED).
3. Refer to manufacturers service publications for identified high voltage components.
4. Physically locate high voltage components on the vehicle and disable them according to manufacturers
instructions (some components may require a waiting period or special procedures to discharge the voltage
completely).
5. Use Best Work Practices (see below) when performing work on electrical systems.
Best Work Practices
WARNING: To avoid personal injury or death, permit only trained responsible and capable persons to operate
or maintain the equipment. Carelessly operating or neglecting maintenance despite the safe design of any
vehicle and its high voltage equipment may result in personal injury or death.
The danger of injury through electrical shock is possible whenever electrical power is present. Most fatal
injuries result from high-voltage exposure; however, people can sustain severe injuries from low voltage power
if it has a high current flow.
Be aware of ALL high voltage equipment on the vehicle; review line-set/build ticket and the owner and
service manuals of high voltage equipment BEFORE starting any work.
When working on this equipment, remain alert at all times. Never work on the equipment when physically or
mentally fatigued, and never work alone near high voltage equipment.
Always stand on an insulated, dry surface when working on any electrical circuit. Do not handle any kind of
electrical device while standing in water, while barefoot, or while hands or feet are wet.
Always work in an adequately illuminated area.
Always use appropriate protective equipment: insulated gloves, rubber gloves, goggles/face shield, safety
shoes, protective clothing, and insulated tools when working on electrical components/circuits of the vehicle.
Never wear jewelry when working on this equipment. Jewelry can conduct electricity resulting in electric
shock or burns and may get caught in moving components causing injury.
When working on vehicles that have high voltage devices or equipment, use appropriate alerting techniques
in plain view to warn people that may be in the general area and to prevent inadvertent activation of any
disabled high voltage circuit(s) during service: safety signs, safety symbols, tags, barricades, cones, etc.
Keep a fire extinguisher close by at all times. Extinguishers rated ABC by the National Fire Protection
Association are appropriate for use on the electrical system. Make sure the extinguisher is properly charged
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 04 - PAGE 13
GENERAL ELECTRICAL
and be familiar with its use. Consult the local fire department with any question pertaining to fire
extinguishers.
Ensure that the high voltage power, high voltage power generating equipment and high voltage storage
devices are disconnected, locked out, or otherwise disabled BEFORE working on or around the vehicle, its
electrical circuits, or components. Unless disabled, Auxiliary Power Units (APUs) may start at any time
without warning; when this occurs, the circuits associated with the APU become energized with potentially
lethal high voltage. Some components may require a waiting period or special procedures to discharge the
voltage completely.
Use an appropriate electrical tester and procedures to confirm that the power is disconnected BEFORE
performing any work on or near any high voltage components/circuits.
Exercise caution around output circuits even when the input power is off. Parallel power sources and energy
storage devices can still be dangerous. Be familiar with the high voltage equipment installed on the vehicle.
Some systems contain high voltage condensers that may require time to discharge after power is removed.
After disconnecting or exposing a high-voltage connector or terminal, insulate it immediately using insulation
tape.
After completion of any electrical work, BEFORE restoring the power, verify that parts and/or tools are
removed from the work area and that the fasteners are firmly tightened to the specified torque and the
connectors are correctly connected.
Voltage can be fatal at levels greater than 60 volts. High voltage can jump a larger air gap than low voltage. If
contact is made with high voltage, it may not be possible to simply let go.
Towing a HEV with its drive wheels on the ground may cause the motor to generate electricity. Consult the
operators/owners manual for proper towing procedures.
If a high voltage fuse or circuit protection device trips, do not re-energize the circuit until it has been
determined that the circuit is safe. See manufacturers troubleshooting procedures before servicing a high
voltage system.
Reference OSHA Regulations as necessary and applicable.
SUPPRESSION
International
.
Table 8
WELDING INFORMATION
Whenever electric welding is done on any part of the vehicle, it is not necessary to disconnect the
International
electronic modules in the cab such as the BC, ESC or RPM, and the instrument cluster. The
welder's GND must be connected as close to the weld as possible. If the vehicle is equipped with an
International
engine, disconnect both the positive (+) and the negative (-) battery cables including the
electronic power feeds prior to electric welding. If it is necessary to weld close to an electronic component, it is
Suppressed Relays and Magnetic Switches
Part Number Description
1691520C91 Magnetic Switch - Continuous Duty (Suppressed) 100 AMP
1693479C91 Magnetic Switch - Intermittent Duty (Suppressed) 100 AMP
3519350C1 Micro Relay SPDT (Suppressed), NO 20 AMP, NC 10 AMP
SECTION 04 - PAGE 14 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
GENERAL ELECTRICAL
recommended that the component be temporarily removed.
Consult manufacturers instructions for all other electronic modules such as Allison Transmission, Eaton Auto
Shift Transmission, Bendix ABS, Wabco ABS, Cummins Engine, Caterpillar Engine, and Detroit Diesel Engine.
ROUTING GUIDELINES
Any hosing, tubing, battery cable, wiring or electrical harness must not rub on a sharp edge. However, due to
the high abrasion resistance of synflex tubing, it is permissible for synflex tubing to make contact with the lower
edge of the frame rail flange when the tubing is making the transition from the outside to down and under the
rail. This does not mean that proper clearance or the need for protective wrap is not needed when synflex line
contacts sharp edges or threaded fasteners.
Any hosing, tubing, battery cable, wiring or electrical harness must not rub or make contact with a hot surface.
There should be 5" minimum clearance from the exhaust depending on the situation. The further back from the
turbo, the less clearance required.
Nothing should rub or make contact with the copper compressor discharge tubing other than the clamp(s) that
support it.
All hosing, tubing, battery cables or electrical harnesses should be supported at least every 18" to 20".
Straplocks used to directly clamp or support battery cables or main engine wiring harnesses must be no less
than 7/16" in width.
Straplocks are not to be used on any bulk hose materials (heater hoses, make-up lines, etc.).
Route and Clip Recommendations
Table 9
Heat Source Distance From
Exhaust Manifold to Muffler Inlet 6
Aftertreatment 8
Muffler Inlet to Tail Pipe Out 3
Other (EGR Discharge Pipe/Hose) 1/2
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 04 - PAGE 15
GENERAL ELECTRICAL
Electrical Harness
Table 10
ELECTRICAL DOS AND DON'TS
The information in this section applies to all DuraStar 3200, 4200, 4300, 4400, and WorkStar models.
Table 11
Problem Requirement
Sharp or Abrading Surface No Contact
Tension Along Harness/Wires/Hoses None
Distance From Moving Parts 1
Connector Clipped to Avoid Damage Yes
Connectors Are Sealed Yes
Max Eyelets Per Stud 3
Harness Protected From Damage Yes
Drip Point For Harness Yes
Distance of Harness to Flammable Fluids 1/2
Harness Location to Flammable Fluids Not Directly Under
Battery Cables to Flammable Fluids 1 Minimum
Battery Cable to Conductive Surface 1/2 Minimum
Battery Cable Tie Strap 1/2 (250 Pound) Wide
Harness Contact with Metal Surface No Relative Motion
P-Clamps Electrical Cushioned Only
P-Clamps Fastening Support No Cantilever
High Pressure Pipe/Hose (>200 PSI) Dont Clip Anything to Them
Harness Through Metal Holes Use Grommet
Full Articulated Position Operates Without Damage
Clipping Fixed MAX Distance Harness 14
Splices Use Shrink Wrap
Item Do Dont
Accessory (power taps with key in Accessory
mode)
Connect to accessory relay output in the inside
cab fuse block; circuit A12B.
Connect to key switch accessory output.
Battery - Clean (unfused) power and
maxi-fused power feeds and GND connection
points
Use inline Maxi-holder from Mega-fuse unfused
side.
Exceed additional 45 AMPS
Exceed 3 ring terminals total on Maxi-fuse stud.
GND
GND additional electrical loads (customer
supplied devices) to chassis or GND studs
located on the dash panel.
GND to vehicle batteries for additional loads.
GND with ammeter
GND to frame or dash GND stud to allow for
ammeter to register current.
GND directly to batteries for meter signal.
IGN (power taps with key in IGN)
Connect to the IGN relay output in the inside
cab fuse block; circuit A13FC
Connect circuits directly to key switch IGN
circuits.
Start (power taps with key in Start)
Connect to the starter relay input circuit A17 at
the outside fuse block.
Connect circuits directly to the key switch start
circuits.
BC (access to pinouts of discrete circuits) Connect to BC outputs only.
a) Exceed BC outputs amperage refer to BC
section
b) Connect to signal inputs of the BC
Electric City Horn
a) Connect to circuit A85E (Dash), M85E,
M85N, or M85L (Forward chassis) and M85H
(Horn jumper) or
b) Only use suppressed type horn assembly.
Connect to Electric City Horn circuit without a
diode for protection.
Air Horn (or Air Horn Accommodation)
Connect air line to output side of the solenoid
pack controlled through BC.
Connect to input side of air switch electrical
circuit.
CB Radio (or CB Accommodation)
Use power connector 2303 and CB antenna
connector 2306 at CB opening in overhead
console with optional code 08RCB
Exceed 10 AMPS.
Radio installation for customer aftermarket
radio accommodation
a) Connect to pigtail (A13B) owner/operator
IGN feed
b) Use a relay if load exceeds 5 AMPS.
Exceed 5 AMPS.
SECTION 04 - PAGE 16 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
GENERAL ELECTRICAL
Cruise/Stationary Throttle via Remote Throttle
module and via hardwire for remote hook-up
For I6 or V8 engines without optional code
12VZA - Add circuit to Pins 16, 49, 60, and 68
of Engine ECM connector 6020 depending on
desired function, or add a Remote Engine
Speed Control Module (RESCM). Refer to
12VZA Component Information Diamond
Logic
Controller Engine
Control Features and Programmable
Parameters for vehicles equipped with these
optional codes. Install discrete oil pressure
sensor or tap signal off the ATA or public J1939
Datalink.
Connect directly to oil pressure sensor circuit.
Vehicle Speed output with Manual
Transmission for optional feature control; i.e.,
sand spreader
For I6 or V8 engines without optional code
12VZA - Add circuit to Pin 72 of Engine ECM
connector 6020 depending on desired function;
or add a RESCM. This provides 30,000
pulse/mile output for speed. Use an isolated
Dual wound sensor with manual transmission.
Refer to Component Information Diamond
Logic
parts system is set up to give part information that is specific to a particular vehicle that has
been built. This includes all optional features that were ordered. If a feature is to be added after the vehicle was
built, the dealer must be provided with the vehicle VIN number, the last 8 characters, and the feature code to be
added. The dealer will contact Parts Spec to obtain a listing of parts required for that feature.
The circuits provided for the feature will be what are referred to as overlay circuits and are to be layered on
and taped to existing harnesses. In some cases, a total harness may be provided. The harness may include
standard wiring circuits.
The body builder will have to refer to the circuit diagram book for connector cavity information. If the decision is
made to build the overlay locally, part numbers of the terminals can be found in the Connector Body
Composites section at the rear of the circuit diagram manual S08322.
All hardware associated with a specific feature code, switches, brackets, etc. will be provided. The body builder
must decide which parts are to be ordered it is not required that all parts for a code be ordered. Generally,
except for a few features, there are no kits available, hence, detailed instructions are not provided, and this
section will cover some basic direction.
If a feature is not available on a specific model, a parts list will not be provided.
Some features will require reprogramming of the Body Controller (BC). If reprogramming is required, the
vehicle must be returned to the dealer.
If the body builder adds a feature, they must assume full responsibility for proper operation of that feature.
International
Engines
Remote Engine Speed Control Features Section 24-Page 1
12VZB
Engine Control, Remote Mounted for PTO with
MaxxForce 11 & 13 Engines
Remote Engine Speed Control Features Section 24-Page 1
13GSB Eaton 6-Spd Hybrid without ePTO Capability Hybrid Electric Vehicle Section 30-Page 19
13GSS
6-Spd Auto Manual with Electronic Shift Controls
not with ePTO capability Beverage Tractor only
Hybrid Electric Vehicle Section 30-Page 19
13WDH
Wiring for Transmission/PTO Controls for Allison
2000, 2100, 2200, 2400, 2500 Series
PTO (Power Take OFF) and PTO Hourmeter Section 23-Page 54
13GUE
Transmission, Manual {Eaton Fuller Eaton Hybrid
EH-8E406A-UP} 6-Speed Automated Manual,
Hybrid Drive Unit, With Electronic Shift Controls,
ePTO Capability, Less APG Capability
Hybrid Electric Vehicle Section 30-Page 1
13GUG
Transmission, Manual {Eaton Fuller Eaton Hybrid
EH-8E406A-UPG} 6-Speed Automated Manual,
Hybrid Drive Unit, With Electronic Shift Controls,
ePTO Capability, APG Capability
Hybrid Electric Vehicle Section 30-Page 1
13WDN PTO Control, Dash Mounted PTO (Power Take OFF) and PTO Hourmeter Section 23-Page 54
13WUA
Automatic Neutral Allison WT Transmission Shifts
to Neutral When Park Brake is Engaged
Transmission Spare Input/Outputs and
Transmission Codes
Section 16-Page 6
13WUB
Allison Spare Input/Output for Highway Series (HS);
General Purpose Trucks
Transmission Spare Input/Outputs and
Transmission Codes
Section 16-Page 6
13WUC
Allison Spare Input/Output for Rugged Duty Series
(RDS); General Purpose Trucks, Construction
Transmission Spare Input/Outputs and
Transmission Codes
Section 16-Page 6
13WUD
Allison Spare Input/Output for Emergency Vehicle
Series (EVS); Rescue, Ambulance
Transmission Spare Input/Outputs and
Transmission Codes
Section 16-Page 6
13WUE
Allison Spare Input/Output for Emergency Vehicle
Series (EVS); Fire/Pumper, Tank, Aerial/Ladder
Transmission Spare Input/Outputs and
Transmission Codes
Section 16-Page 6
13WUG
Allison Spare Input/Output for Truck Recreational
Vehicle (TRV)
Transmission Spare Input/Outputs and
Transmission Codes
Section 16-Page 6
13WUH
Allison Spare Input/Output for Rugged Duty Series
(RDS); Airport Refueler, Sewer Evac
Transmission Spare Input/Outputs and
Transmission Codes
Section 16-Page 6
13WUJ
Allison Spare Input/Output for Rugged Duty Series
(RDS); Front Loaders, Rear Loaders, Recycling/
Packer Trucks
Transmission Spare Input/Outputs and
Transmission Codes
Section 16-Page 6
13WUK
Allison Spare Input/Output for Rugged Duty Series
(RDS); Side Loaders
Transmission Spare Input/Outputs and
Transmission Codes
Section 16-Page 6
13WUL
Allison Spare Input/Output for Rugged Duty Series
(RDS); Street Sweeper
Transmission Spare Input/Outputs and
Transmission Codes
Section 16-Page 6
13WUM
Allison Spare Input/Output for Pupil Transportation
Series (PTS)
Transmission Spare Input/Outputs and
Transmission Codes
Section 16-Page 6
Feature Code Index
Feature Code Description Section Name Section & Page #
SECTION 05 - PAGE 4 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
GENERAL
13WUP Allison Spare Input/Output for Bus Series (B)
Transmission Spare Input/Outputs and
Transmission Code
Section 16-Page 6
13WUR
Allison Spare Input/Output for Dump/Construction
with Two- Speed Axle or Auxiliary Transmission
(RDS)
Transmission Spare Input/Outputs and
Transmission Codes
Section 16-Page 7
13WUS
Allison Spare Input/Output for Rugged Duty Series
(RDS); General Purpose Trucks Modified for Single
Input Auto Neutral
Transmission Spare Input/Outputs and
Transmission Codes
Section 16-Page 7
13WUT
Allison Spare Input/Output for Emergency Vehicle
Series (EVS); without Split Shaft PTO
Transmission Spare Input/Outputs and
Transmission Codes
Section 16-Page 7
13WUU
Allison Spare Input/Output for Specialty
Transmission Series (SP)
Transmission Spare Input/Outputs and
Transmission Codes
Section 16-Page 7
13WUV
Allison Spare Input/Output for Highway Series (HP);
General Purpose Trucks Modified for Single Input
Auto Neutral
Transmission Spare Input/Outputs and
Transmission Codes
Section 16-Page 7
13WUZ
Allison Spare Input/Output for Emergency Vehicle
Series (EVS), 127/198 includes J1939 Based Auto
Neutral; Fire/Pumper, Tank, Aerial/Ladder
Transmission Spare Input/Outputs and
Transmission Codes
Section 16-Page 7
13XAA
Dash-Mounted PTO Control for Customer- Provided
Clutched, Air-Shifted PTO
PTO (Power Take OFF) and PTO Hourmeter Section 23-Page 54
13ZYV HEV, Power Electronics Carrier, Back of Fuel Tank Hybrid Electric Vehicle Section 30-Page 1
13ZYW
HEV, Power Electronics Carrier, Back of Battery
Box
Hybrid Electric Vehicle Section 30-Page 1
13ZYX HEV, Power Electronics Carrier, Behind PEC Hybrid Electric Vehicle Section 30-Page 1
16HCK Seatbelt Warning Prewire 1 to 3 Belts Productivity Features Section 11-Page 6
16HCL Seatbelt Warning Prewire 4 to 6 Belts Productivity Features Section 11-Page 6
16HGG Optional Engine Oil Temperature Gauge Gauges Section 17-Page 3
16HGH
Optional Allison Transmission Oil Temperature
Gauge
Gauges Section 17-Page 4
16HGJ
Optional Manual Transmission Oil Temperature
Gauge
Gauges Section 17-Page 5
16HGL Optional Rear Axle Oil Temperature Gauge Gauges Section 17-Page 6
16HGN Optional Air Application Gauge Gauges Section 17-Page 8
16HHT Optional Ammeter Gauge Gauges Section 17-Page 9
16HKA Optional IP Cluster display Omit fault codes Gauges Section 17-Page 11
16HKT IP Cluster Display Diagnostics Gauges Section 17-Page 11
16VCN Remote Keyless Entry w/Aux. Work Light Feature Power Windows, Locks, Remote Keyless Entry Section 09-Page 1
16WJU Power Windows/Locks (2) Power Windows, Locks, Remote Keyless Entry Section 09-Page 1
16VCP Keyless Entry Remote w/ Trailer Function Power Windows, Locks, Remote Keyless Entry Section 09-Page 1
16WJV Power Windows/Locks (4) Power Windows, Locks, Remote Keyless Entry Section 09-Page 1
16WKB Air Conditioning Air Conditioning Section 15-Page 1
16WKZ Remote Keyless Entry and Use of Aux Feature Power Windows, Locks, Remote Keyless Entry Section 09-Page 1
16WLM PTO Hourmeter for Customer-Supplied PTO PTO (Power Take OFF) and PTO Hourmeter Section 23-Page 83
60AAA Remote Power Module (1) With 6 Latched Switches Remote Power Modules Section 18-Page 2
60AAB
Remote Power Modules (2) With 12 Latched
Switches
Remote Power Modules Section 18-Page 2
60AAC
International
Diamond Logic
PowerPack 3,
Battery Box Mount
PowerPack 3 Primary and Temporary Mount
Features
Section 28-Page 1
60AAD
Remote Power Modules (2) With 6 Latched
Switches
Remote Power Modules Section 18-Page 2
60AAE
International
Diamond Logic
PowerPack 3, Temp
Mount
PowerPack 3 Primary and Temporary Mount
Features
Section 28-Page 1
60AAG Remote Power Module (1) With 6 Latched Switches Remote Power Modules Section 18-Page 2
60AAH
Remote Power Modules (2) With 12 Latched
Switches
Remote Power Modules Section 18-Page 2
60AAJ
Remote Power Modules (3) With 18 Latched
Switches
Remote Power Modules Section 18-Page 2
60AAK
Remote Power Modules (2) Special With 6 Latched
Switches
Remote Power Modules Section 18-Page 2
60AAL Remote Power Module Special Remote Power Modules Section 18-Page 2
60AAM Remote Power Module (1) With No Switches Remote Power Modules Section 18-Page 1
Feature Code Index
Feature Code Description Section Name Section & Page #
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 05 - PAGE 5
GENERAL
60AAN Remote Power Module (1) With No Switches Remote Power Modules Section 18-Page 2
60ABA Cable Shift PTO Accommodation Package PTO (Power Take OFF) and PTO Hourmeter Section 23-Page 1
60ABB Muncie Lectra-Shift PTO Accommodation Package PTO (Power Take OFF) and PTO Hourmeter Section 23-Page 6
60ABC Remote Start/Stop Remote Start/Stop Feature Section 26-Page 1
60ABD
Remote Start/Stop With Emergency Pump
Accommodation
Remote Start/Stop Feature Section 26-Page 3
60ABE
Electric Over Hydraulic PTO Accommodation
Package
PTO (Power Take OFF) Section 23-Page 17
60ABK
Electric Over Air (Non-Clutched) PTO
Accommodation Package
PTO (Power Take OFF) Section 23-Page 26
60ABL
Electric Over Air (Clutched) PTO Accommodation
Package
PTO (Power Take OFF) Section 23-Page 35
60ABM I/O Expansion Harness Body Builder Integration Harness Section 22-Page 1
60ABN I/O Expansion Harness Body Builder Integration Harness Section 22-Page 1
60ACA
Unadvertised Code for Remote Power Module with
One Latched Switch
Remote Power Modules Section 18-Page 13
60ACB
Unadvertised Code for Remote Power Module with
Two Latched Switches
Remote Power Modules Section 18-Page 13
60ACC
Unadvertised Code for Remote Power Module with
Three Latched Switches
Remote Power Modules Section 18-Page 13
60ACD
Unadvertised Code for Remote Power Module with
Four Latched Switches
Remote Power Modules Section 18-Page 13
60ACE
In Cab Switch Controls for High Current (40AMP)
Body Accessories
Power Features Using Remote Power Modules Section 20-Page 1
60ACG
In Cab Switch Control (1) With Vehicle Speed
Interlock for Body Accessories
Power Features Using Remote Power Modules Section 20-Page 2
60ACH
In Cab Switch Controls (2) With Vehicle Speed
Interlock for Body Accessories
Power Features Using Remote Power Modules Section 20-Page 7
60ACJ
Unadvertised Code for Remote Power Module with
Five Latched Switches
Remote Power Modules Section 18-Page 13
60ACK
Unadvertised Code for Remote Power Module with
Six Latched Switches
Remote Power Modules Section 18-Page 13
60ACS
In Cab/External Switch for Body Accessories (3
Way Momentary), Two Switches
Power Features using Remote Power Modules Section 20-Page 14
60ACT
In Cab/External Switch for Body Accessories (3
Way Momentary), Two Switches
Power Features using Remote Power Modules Section 20-Page 16
60ACU
In Cab/External Switch for Body Accessories (3
Way Momentary), Three Switches
Power Features using Remote Power Modules Section 20-Page 19
60ACV
Unadvertised Code for Remote Power Module with
an Additional Six Latched Switches
Remote Power Modules Section 18-Page 13
60ACW
Body Integration Input/Output Expansion Harness
(DLB Controlled
Body Builder Integration Harness Section 22-Page 1
60ACX Theft Deterrent Feature Theft Deterrent Section 29-Page 1
60AJA
Throttle Control Accommodation for Single
Customer- Mounted External Engine Speed Control
Switch Recovery Applications
Remote Engine Speed Control Features Section 24-Page 21
60AJC
Special Gauge Cluster Indicators and Alarms (Gate
Open and Rear Alert) for Refuse Applications
Indicator Lights and Alarms Section 21-Page 1
60AJD
Special Gauge Cluster Indicators and Alarms
(Boom Not Stowed and Outriggers Not Stowed) for
Utility Applications
Indicator Lights and Alarms Section 21-Page 5
60AJE
Throttle Control Accommodation for Single
Customer- Mounted External Engine Speed Control
Switch General Purpose
Remote Engine Speed Control Features Section 24-Page 25
60AJG
Throttle Control Accommodation for Single
Customer- Mounted External Engine Speed Control
Switch Utility Applications
Remote Engine Speed Control Features Section 24-Page 29
60AJH
Remote Throttle Control for Dual Function Engine
Running/Emergency Power Engine Off
Remote Engine Speed Control Features Section 24-Page 32
60AJJ
Remote Throttle Control for Customer- mounted
Momentary Switch Refuse Applications
Remote Engine Speed Control Features Section 24-Page 36
Feature Code Index
Feature Code Description Section Name Section & Page #
SECTION 05 - PAGE 6 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
GENERAL
60AJK
Body Integration, Indicator Lights (Body Up and
Gate Open) Plow/Dump Applications
Indicator Lights and Alarms Section 21-Page 9
60AJL
Remote Power Module (1) With 6 Latched
Switches
Remote Power Modules Section 18-Page 2
60AJM
Remote Power Module (2) With 12 Latched
Switches
Remote Power Modules Section 18-Page 3
60AJN
International
Diamond Logic
PowerPack 3,
Battery Box Mount
PowerPack 3 Primary and Temporary Mount
Features
Section 28-Page 16
60AJR Dash Indicator Light Red (1) Indicator Lights and Alarms Section 21-Page 12
60AJS Dash Indicator Light Red (2) Indicator Lights and Alarms Section 21-Page 12
60AJT Dash Indicator Light Red (3) Indicator Lights and Alarms Section 21-Page 12
60AJU Dash Indicator Light Red (6) Indicator Lights and Alarms Section 21-Page 12
60AJV Dash Indicator Light Green (1) Indicator Lights and Alarms Section 21-Page 12
60AJW Dash Indicator Light Green (2) Indicator Lights and Alarms Section 21-Page 12
60AJX Dash Indicator Light Green (3) Indicator Lights and Alarms Section 21-Page 12
60AJY Dash Indicator Light Green (6) Indicator Lights and Alarms Section 21-Page 13
60AJZ Dash Indicator Light Yellow (1) Indicator Lights and Alarms Section 21-Page 12
60AKA Dash Indicator Light Yellow (2) Indicator Lights and Alarms Section 21-Page 12
60AKB Dash Indicator Light Yellow (3) Indicator Lights and Alarms Section 21-Page 12
60AKC Dash Indicator Light Yellow (6) Indicator Lights and Alarms Section 21-Page 12
60AKD
Auxiliary Power Generator Hybrid Mounted Inside
Rail, Back of Cab
PowerPack 3 Primary and Temporary Mount
Features
Section 28-Page 15
60AKE
Auxiliary Power Generator Hybrid Mounted Left
Side Outside Rail, Back of Cab
PowerPack 3 Primary and Temporary Mount
Features
Section 28-Page 15
60AKG PTO Control, Engine Compartment (LS) PTO (Power Take Off) and PTO Hourmeter Section 23-Page 44
60AKK
Bdy INTG, Headlight Wig Wag, Park Brake Disables
Wig Wag
Fog, Plow and Guide Post Accommodation
Packages
Section 12-Page 14
60AKL
Bdy INTG, Headlight Wig Wag, Park Brake Disables
High Beam, Enables Low Beam
Fog, Plow and Guide Post Accommodation
Packages
Section 12-Page 14
595AKY Dome Light Features
Electrical Functionality without associated feature
codes
Section 31-Page 1
595ANR Park Brake Applied Connection
Electrical Functionality without associated feature
codes
Section 31-Page 2
595ABC Brake Applied Connection
Electrical Functionality without associated feature
codes
Section 13-Page 3
Feature Code Index
Feature Code Description Section Name Section & Page #
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 06 - PAGE 1
BODY CONTROLLER
BODY CONTROLLER
3200, DURASTAR, WORKSTAR MODELS
At the center of the Diamond Logic
Builder software (see local dealer).
Set the desired programmable parameters for each signal using the Diamond Logic
Name on Top
Provides two 4 long CB antennas.
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
None
WIRING INFORMATION
Locations for connecting to the vehicle IGN and cab GND have been provided. The table below lists the
connection point along with information about that point. For a complete diagram of the IGN system and for
connector and terminal part numbers, see vehicle circuit diagram manual.
Table 20
The mating connector for the CB connector is 1661196C1 and terminal 1661209C1 (16 gauge).
TESTING
To test these circuits, refer to the above chart and verify that battery voltage is present in the correct key-state
for each respective feature.
HOW DO I ADD THESE FEATURES?
If the vehicle was ordered without one of the desired features, they can be installed in the field. Refer to the
section How Do I General Information section of this electrical guide for information on obtaining required
parts. The same parts that are used in the OEM installation are available (cables, components, etc.). Also, refer
to the circuit diagram that applies to the vehicle to aid in the installation.
Feature Codes Max. Current (Amps) Power Feed Description
08RCB 10 Accessory
CB Radio Accommodation Package
(Includes 2 Antenna Bases and Cable)
SECTION 08 - PAGE 2 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
CB & 2-WAY RADIO ACCOMMODATION
2-WAY RADIOS
Refer to the Circuit Diagram Manual S08322, Chapter 4, Cab Accessories, 2-Way Radio.
08REA
2-WAY RADIO Wiring Effects; Wiring With 20 AMP Fuse Protection, Includes IGN Wire With 5 AMP Fuse, Wire
Ends Heat Shrink and 10 Coil Taped to Base Harness
Feature code 08REA provides a fused 20 AMP battery feed power wire, GND wire and fused 5 AMP IGN
feed for applications requiring twoway radio communications such as local municipal government units or
state DOT highway maintenance vehicles. The three wires are taped to the main cab harness.
08RGA
2-WAY RADIO Wiring Effects; Wiring With 20 AMP Fuse Protection, Includes IGN Wire with 5 AMP Fuse, Wire
Ends Heat Shrink and Routed to Center of Header Console in Cab
Feature code 08RGA provides a fused 20 AMP battery feed power wire, GND wire and fused 5 AMP IGN
feed for applications requiring twoway radio communications such as local municipal government units or
state DOT highway maintenance vehicles. The three wires are located in the center of the header console in
the cab.
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
None
WIRING INFORMATION
Locations for connecting to the vehicle IGN have been provided. The table below lists the connection point
along with information about that point. For a complete diagram of the IGN system and for connector and
terminal part numbers, see vehicle circuit diagram manual.
Table 21
Feature Code Max. Current (AMPS) Power Feed Description
08REA
20 Battery Power feed to two-way radio
5 IGN IGN feed to two-way radio
08RGA
20 Battery Power feed to two-way radio
5 IGN Ignition feed to two-way radio
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 08 - PAGE 3
CB & 2-WAY RADIO ACCOMMODATION
08REA and 08RGA provide radio power and GND directly from the battery to minimize electrical noise on the
line.
The cable is coiled up under the Instrument Panel (IP) as shown above in 08REA, and is of sufficient length to
route to the back of the Travelcrew cab.
The wiring is located in the center of the header console in the cab for 08RGA.
TESTING
To test these circuits, refer to the applicable circuit diagram for the feature and verify that battery voltage is
present in the correct key-state for each respective feature.
HOW TO ADD THESE FEATURES
If the vehicle was ordered without one of the desired features, it can be installed in the field. Refer to the How
Do I General Information section of this electrical guide for information on obtaining required parts. The same
parts that are used in the OEM installation are available (cables, components, etc.). Also, refer to the circuit
diagram that applies to the vehicle to aid in the installation.
f_027
SECTION 08 - PAGE 4 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
CB & 2-WAY RADIO ACCOMMODATION
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 09 - PAGE 1
POWER WINDOWS, LOCKS, REMOTE
KEYLESS ENTRY
POWER WINDOWS, LOCKS, REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY
KEYLESS ENTRY SYSTEM REMOTE/WINDOW, POWER
Refer to the Circuit Diagram Manual S08322, Chapter 4, (Page 4 & 5) Cab Accessories, Front Door Windows
and Locks (Power), or For Crew for crew cab vehicles.
16WKZ
KEYLESS ENTRY SYSTEM REMOTE With Panic and Auxiliary Buttons, Includes One Key Fob (Transmitter)
16VCN
KEYLESS ENTRY SYSTEM REMOTE With Panic and Auxiliary Work Light Function, Includes One Key Fob
(Transmitter)
16VCP
KEYLESS ENTRY REMOTE W/ TRAILER FUNCTION
16WJU
WINDOW, POWER (2) and Power Locks, Left and Right Doors
16WJV
WINDOW, POWER (4) and Power Door Locks, Front and Rear Doors, Left and Right
16WSS
WINDOW, POWER and Power Lock, Left Side Only
Driver and passenger power windows and door locks are available. The driver switches are located on the
driver door trim and can control all door windows and locks. The passenger switches are located on the
passenger door trim and can control the passenger door window and all locks. Window express down is
available for all window switches by momentarily depressing the window down switch. The driver can lockout
all non-driver controllable window switches by momentarily depressing the lower left switch on the driver door
control.
REQUIRED SOFTWARE FEATURE CODE FOR SALES CODE:
16VCN: 595ABZ & 595ABT
16WJU: 595ABY
16WJV: 595AEJ
16WKZ, 16VCP: 595ABZ
16WSS: 595ALE
SECTION 09 - PAGE 2 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
POWER WINDOWS, LOCKS, REMOTE
KEYLESS ENTRY
The International
Keyless Entry System uses electronic door pods in the driver and passenger side doors
which also operate the power door locks and the power windows. If equipped with Remote Keyless Entry
(optional code), the memory in the receiver (front passenger door pod) learns the transmitter codes from the
key fobs (transmitters) and only recognizes those which it has learned in the programming process. Each
vehicle's passenger side door pod has the ability to learn up to six transmitter codes allowing the vehicle to be
accessed by six different key fobs. Each key fob has a unique code which can be learned by any number of
RKE equipped vehicles.
The key fob controls the following functions:
Chirp of the horn and doors lock if the lock button is pressed on the key fob.
Autolock function, which automatically locks the doors at a vehicle speed of 15 MPH see details below.
Panic function, button with horn symbol, which chirps the horn on/off in unison with the headlights and park
lights for three minutes when the panic button on the key fob is pressed and the ignition (IGN) switch is off. If
the button is pressed prior to the time out period, the lights, etc. will go off
Driver's Side Door Pod
f_028
Passenger's Side Door Pod
f_029
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 09 - PAGE 3
POWER WINDOWS, LOCKS, REMOTE
KEYLESS ENTRY
Pressing the AUX button will toggle the work light circuit on. Pressing the button will turn the work light off.
Vehicle must be ordered with work light or work light accommodation package.
With the IGN on, if wheel-based vehicle speed is above the auto lock speed, the park brake was released
below the auto lock speed and is still released, and the doors were closed below the auto lock speed and are
still closed, all doors will lock.
The auto lock feature will only lock the doors once regardless of the number of times the truck stops and starts.
Cycling the key and/or opening the door, while below the auto lock speed, will allow the auto lock feature to lock
the doors again when the speed conditions are met.
NOTE: Horn chirp, auto lock are programmable parameters.
TRANSMITTER LEARNING AND ERASING
Before the transmitter can be used for the first time, it has to be "learned" by the receiver. Up to 6 transmitters
with different identification codes can be learned by a single RKE Pod.
These procedures are designed for manual learning/erasing operations on a complete vehicle. They can be
used for learning replacement transmitters, for using up to six transmitters for accessing the same vehicle, or
for accessing any number of vehicles using the same transmitter. If RKE is being added to the vehicle,
additional programming of the Body Controller (BC) is required to operate the horn, panic, and dome light
functions with RKE.
PROCEDURE FOR ERASING ALL LEARNED TRANSMITTERS
1. Cycle the IGN from Off to On.
NOTE: Step 2 must be initiated (all four buttons pressed) within 10 seconds of this IGN event.
2. On the driver door pod, do the following:
While holding down the driver window-up, driver window-down, and unlock switches, depress and hold the lock
switch. All four switches must be held for at least 5 seconds. Six or seven seconds is recommended. After the
5 seconds, the door pod RKE unit will erase all learned transmitters and the RKE will be disabled. At this point,
the erase procedure is finished and a new IGN cycle must be initiated to perform any transmitter learning.
PROCEDURE FOR LEARNING A TRANSMITTER
NOTE: This learning procedure cannot be performed during the same IGN cycle as the "erase all learned
transmitters" procedure. If necessary, the erase procedure should be completed before this procedure is
started.
Keyless Entry Controller
f_030
SECTION 09 - PAGE 4 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
POWER WINDOWS, LOCKS, REMOTE
KEYLESS ENTRY
1. Cycle the IGN from Off to On (leaving the IGN on will not work, it must be cycled). Step 2 must be initiated
(all four buttons pressed) within 10 seconds of this IGN event.
2. On the passenger door pod, do the following:
While holding down the window-up, window-down, and unlock switches, depress and hold the lock switch.
All four switches must be held for at least 5 seconds. Six or seven seconds is recommended.
3. After the 5 seconds, the Door Pod RKE unit will enter "Learn Mode" and stay there for 10 seconds (or until
a transmitter is learned). Once the RKE enters the "Learn Mode", the four buttons can be released. During
the ten second "Learn Mode" any function on the new fob/transmitter must be keyed at least twice (See
NOTE 1).
NOTE: After the transmitter is learned, the next keying of the new transmitter will perform the indicated
function. It is recommended that the transmitter be successively keyed until the selected key's function is
actually performed; i.e., pressing the lock button on the transmitter two times should learn its code; on the third
push, it should lock the door and momentarily beep the city horn. This is a good way to quickly confirm the
success of the learning.
NOTE: Steps 1 through 5 of the learning process must be repeated for each transmitter to be learned.
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 09 - PAGE 5
POWER WINDOWS, LOCKS, REMOTE
KEYLESS ENTRY
PARTS INFORMATION
Replacement key fobs/transmitters can be obtained from Service Parts by ordering part number 3544938C2.
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
Required software feature code for sales code 16VCN or 16WKZ: 595ABZ
Turning the Panic_Enable parameter ON enables the Panic Mode feature of the keyless remote. The panic
function chirps the horn on/off in unison with the headlights and park lights for three minutes when the panic
button on the key fob is pressed and the IGN switch is off. If the button is pressed prior to the time out period,
the lights and horn will go off.
Turning the Chirp_Enable parameter ON enables the Chirp feature for the keyless remote. The chirp feature
results in a chirping sound when the truck is locked and unlocked.
Table 22
The AutoLock_Speed parameter sets the vehicle speed at which the vehicle doors will lock automatically.
Table 23
WIRING INFORMATION
When using the Aux feature, the work light circuit can be used for other features other than a work light - see
Work Light Feature for additional information.
If truck was built with power locks but not the keyless entry, see How Do I Add Work Light Feature.
With the Diamond Logic
Builder software, one other system can be activated. For example, the Aux button
could turn on headlights or hazard lamps, not both.
HOW TO ADD THIS FEATURE
The Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) feature can be added if power windows/power locks
(16WJU/16WJV/16WSS) are already installed on the vehicle by replacing the standard front passenger side
door pod with an RKE compatible door pod.
Software feature code 595ABZ must be enabled on the vehicle using the Diamond Logic
Builder software
(see local dealer).
Parameter ID Description Default Units Min Max Step
Panic_ Enable 644
Enable/disable the Panic Mode
for the Keyless Remote. A value
of 1 enables and a value of 0
disables the feature.
On No_Units N/A N/A N/A
Chirp_ Enable 647
Enable/disable the remote lock
"chirp" for Keyless Remote. A
value of 1 enables and a value of
0 disables the feature.
On No_Units N/A N/A N/A
Parameter ID Description Default Units Min Max Step
AutoLock_
Speed
652
uto lock speed. The speed at
which the vehicle doors will lock
automatically (requires power
locks); Setting this parameter to
zero will disable auto door locks.
15 mph 0 155 1
SECTION 09 - PAGE 6 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
POWER WINDOWS, LOCKS, REMOTE
KEYLESS ENTRY
Remove the existing passenger side door pod and replace it with the RKE compatible pod, part number
3544937C6 as described below. The desired quantity of remote key fobs, part number 3544938C2, must
also be ordered.
Set the applicable programmable parameters, chirp enable, panic enable - see above, using the Diamond
Logic
Builder software (see local dealer if not owned). The auto lock with vehicle speed option should
already be set since power locks are installed.
As noted above, additional wiring may be required if the Aux button on the key fob will be utilized for turning
on a work light or other functions.
Program the RKE receiver to recognize the desired key fobs as described above.
REMOVAL/REPLACEMENT OF PASSENGER SIDE DOOR POD
To remove the door pod use the DIN Radio Removal Tool part number 2504954C1.
Insert the extraction tools (2) into the two holes on either side of the pod housing until the locking tabs are fully
depressed. The pod can then be removed from the door panel and the extraction tools removed.
To install the new replacement pod, connect the appropriate connectors and push the pod in until the locking
tabs are fully engaged.
f_031
f_032
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 10 - PAGE 1
FUSED BATTERY CONNECTIONS INSIDE
CAB
FUSED BATTERY CONNECTIONS INSIDE CAB
FUSED BATTERY CONNECTIONS INSIDE CAB
08518
CIGAR LIGHTER
Provides cigar lighter.
08718
POWER SOURCE Cigar Type Receptacle without Plug and Cord
This option provides a power source for customers who wish to use CB radios, hand held spotlights or
trouble lights, or other accessories that plug into the power socket receptacle for 12-Volt power.
08WCK
POWER SOURCE, TERMINAL TYPE 2-Post
Customers often desire the ability to power 12-volt accessories with the trucks electrical system. This option
provides a power source for items equipped to receive power from post-type terminals.
Refer to the Circuit Diagram Manual S08322, Chapter 4, Cab Accessories, Cigar Lighter and Power Feeds.
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
None
Locations for connecting to the vehicle Ignition (IGN) have been provided. The table below lists the connection
point along with information about that point. For a complete diagram of the IGN system and for connector and
terminal part numbers, see vehicle circuit diagram manual.
Table 24 Vehicle Ignition Connections.
Feature Code Max. Current
(Amperes)
Power Feed Description
08WCK 20 Battery Power Source, Two Post-Type
08718 20 Battery Power Source (Cigar-Type Receptacle)
08518 15 Battery
Cigar Lighter (provides customer with a 15
AMP battery supply)
SECTION 10 - PAGE 2 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
FUSED BATTERY CONNECTIONS INSIDE
CAB
TESTING
To test these circuits, refer to the applicable circuit diagram for the feature and verify that battery voltage is
present in the correct key-state for each respective feature.
HOW TO ADD THESE FEATURES
If the vehicle was ordered without one of the desired features, it can be installed in the field. Refer to the How
Do I General Information section of this electrical guide for information on obtaining required parts. The same
parts that are used in the OEM installation are available (cables, components, etc.). Also, refer to the circuit
diagram that applies
Power Source Connections
f_033
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 11 - PAGE 1
PRODUCTIVITY FEATURES
PRODUCTIVITY FEATURES
TEST EXTERIOR LAMPS EXCEPT BACK UPS
08WPZ
Test Exterior Lights Pre-Trip Inspection will cycle all exterior lamps except back-up lights.
Exterior light test feature allows easier verification of light illumination during walk-around checks. Exterior
lights shall illuminate in a fashion that allows the operator to verify the illumination of exterior lights. Feature
595AZY comes with push button LMPv (Lamp Check) to activate the lamp test. If this sales code is not
ordered, the feature 595AES may be added for functionality without the push button.
For feature 595AZY, to enable the external lamp check sequence:
Turn the key to IGN or ACCESSORY
All exterior lights are off
All of the external lights inputs, park light switch, service brake switch, cruise switch and key state have a
good status
Set the park brake
Push the ELC button in the cluster
To disable the external lamp check sequence, the operator must:
Press the service brake OR
Manually turn on any of the external lights OR
Turn the key to the off or crank position OR
Release the park brake.
NOTE: A bad status on any of the external light inputs, park light switch, service brake switch or key state will
also terminate the lamp check sequence.
For feature 595AES, to enable the external lamp check sequence:
Turn the key to IGN or ACCESSORY
All exterior lights are off
All of the external lights inputs, park light switch, service brake switch, cruise switch and key state have a
good status
Set the park brake
Simultaneously press the cruise on and cruise resume switches
THEN
Press and release the brake pedal.
To disable the external lamp check sequence, the operator must:
Press the service brake OR
Manually turn on any of the external lights OR
Turn the key to the off or crank position OR
Release the park brake.
NOTE: (Note: A bad status on any of the external light inputs, park light switch, service brake switch or key
state will also terminate the lamp check sequence)
The backup lamp cannot be included within this test since the ESC does not control this lamp's functionality.
The lamp test repeatedly flashes all the lights on in the following sequence. This allows the operator to get
outside the vehicle and verify that all the lights are working properly.
The following sequence is repeated with no delay between the steps; the programmable time parameter (PP)
shall have a default value of two seconds, a minimum of one second, and a maximum of 10 seconds, with
increments of one second. This parameter is set at FLEET access.
SECTION 11 - PAGE 2 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
PRODUCTIVITY FEATURES
Table 25
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
Required software feature code: 595AZY or 595AES
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES THAT MUST BE REMOVED
None
Table 26
Sequence Number Lights Requested On Time In This
Sequence
0 High Beam on Plow (if plow is installed) PP
1 High Beams and Park Lights on PP
2
Fog Lamps (if installed) and Park Lights on PP
If fog lamps not installed, skip sequence one PP
3 Low Beam on Plow (if plow installed) PP
4 Low Beam and Park Lights on PP
5 Right Front and Rear Turn Light and Park Lights on PP
6 Left Front and rear Turn Light and park Brake Lights on PP
7 All Lights Off PP
8 Brake Lights PP
9 All Lights Off PP
Push Button Switch Located Below the Instrument Cluster (595AZY)
f_034
Parameter
Name
Parameter
ID#
Parameter
Description
Default
Settings
Units Minimum
Value
Maximum
Value
STEP
Ext_Lamp_
Test_ Seq_Time
2230
The time
between each
step of the
exterior lamp
check
2 5 1 10 1
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 11 - PAGE 3
PRODUCTIVITY FEATURES
WIRING INFORMATION
None required.
TESTING
Refer to the FEATURES/BODY FUNCTION section.
HOW TO ADD THIS FEATURE
1. Enable the software feature code using the Diamond Logic
Builder.
WINDSHIELD WIPER SPEED CONTROL
08WGL
Windshield Wiper Speed Control forces wipers to slowest Intermittent Speed when the park brake is set and left
on for a predetermined time.
Feature 08WGL is a software feature that forces the windshield wipers to their slowest intermittent speed when
the park brake is set and the wipers are left on for a programmable period of time
(Wipers_To_Low_Int_Timeout).
The user may override this feature by manually moving the wiper switch to another position. The wipers will
remain at this speed for the same programmable period of time and then return to their slowest intermittent
speed after that time has passed.
If the IGN switch is turned off, this feature will be overridden.
There are two programmable parameters associated with this feature: Wipers_To_Low_Int_Enabled and
Wipers_To_Low_Int_Timeout. These parameters can be modified by anyone with the appropriate interface tool
and Fleet access or higher.
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
Software Feature Codes that must be installed: 08WGL 595AJD
595AJD activates this feature; however, the parameters below can be found under 595AYC.
The Wipers_To_Low_Int_Enabled parameter shall enable or disable this feature. The default setting shall be
ON when this feature is ordered.
The Wipers_To_Low_Int_Timeout parameter shall determine the amount of time the park brake has to be set
before the wipers are forced to their slowest intermittent speed. The default value for this parameter is 60
seconds. The minimum time allowed is 10 seconds and the maximum time allowed is 300 seconds with 10
second intervals.
Table 28
WIRING INFORMATION
This feature is software driven.
TESTING
1. Start vehicle and make sure the parking brake is engaged.
2. Turn the windshield wipers on any setting except for the slowest intermittent speed.
3. Leave the wipers on this setting for 60 seconds without adjusting the wiper speed.
4. After 60 seconds, the wipers should slow to the lowest speed.
5. Adjust the wiper speed control.
6. The wiper setting should match the user set speed.
Parameter ID Description Default Units Min Max Step
Wipers_To_Low_
Int_Enabled
2171
Enables or disables the wiper speed
override, if it is present.
1 None 0 1 1
Wipers_To_Low_
Int_Timeout
2228
Defines the amount of time the
parking brake has to be set before
the wiper speed is overridden.
60 S 10 300 10
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 11 - PAGE 5
PRODUCTIVITY FEATURES
HOW TO ADD THESE FEATURES
Use the Diamond Logic
Builder software to install the appropriate software and determine correct settings for
programmable parameters.
HAZARD LIGHT OVERRIDE STOP LIGHTS
08THN
TURN SIGNAL SWITCH With Hazard Flasher Overrides Brake, to be done With Programming System
Controller.
This feature is for vehicles with combination stop and turn lamps. This feature allows hazard flashers to
continue flashing when service brakes are applied. This feature is used on bulk fuel transport where some
states require hazard lamps to remain flashing when stopped at R/R crossings. When the Stop Override
Hazard programmable parameter below is turned on, this feature allows hazard flashers on the rear of the
vehicle to stop flashing and stay illuminated as long as the brake pedal is depressed.
This feature can be enabled or disabled by using the Diamond Logic
Builder software.
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
Required Software Feature Codes: 0595AAL
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES THAT MUST BE REMOVED
None
Activating the Stop_Override_Hazard_Enabled parameter means that the brake lights will override the hazard
lights if both are activated at the same time.
Table 29
WIRING INFORMATION
None required.
TESTING
Stop Override Hazard Disabled:
1. Turn on the Hazard lights and verify normal operation (flashing), front and rear.
2. Depress the brake pedal and verify that both front and rear hazard lights remain flashing.
Stop Override Hazard Enabled:
1. Turn on the Hazard lights and verify normal operation, front and rear.
2. Depress the brake pedal and verify that both rear stoplights are on (not flashing) and that the front hazard
lights remain flashing.
3. Release the brake pedal and verify that normal operation of the flashing hazards resumes at the rear of the
vehicle.
HOW TO ADD THIS FEATURE
If it is desired to have the HAZARD lights override the STOP lights, then the Stop_Override_Hazard_Enabled
parameter must be turned OFF.
Parameter ID Description Default Units Min Max Step
Stop_ Override_
Hazard_ Enabled
562
Activate/deactivate stop light
override of flashing hazards on rear
of vehicle. A value of 1 enables and
a value of 0 disables this feature.
On On/Off N/A N/A N/A
SECTION 11 - PAGE 6 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
PRODUCTIVITY FEATURES
HEADLIGHT WARNING BUZZER
08WXB
HEADLIGHT WARNING BUZZER Sounds When Head Light Switch is on and Ignition Switch is in Off
Position.
The purpose of the Headlight Warning Buzzer is to alert drivers if their headlights are still in when the vehicle is
turned off.
This feature can be enabled or disabled by using the Diamond Logic
Builder software.
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
Required Software Feature Codes: 0595BHH
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES THAT MUST BE REMOVED
None
Table 30
WIRING INFORMATION
None required.
TESTING
Exterior_Lamp_Warn Disabled:
1. Turn the key off.
2. Turn headlights on. There should be no warning.
Exterior_Lamp_Warn Enabled:
1. Turn the key off.
2. Turn headlights on. The warning will beep five times (with the door closed).
3. Open door. The warning will buzz continuously.
HOW TO ADD THIS FEATURE
Use the Diamond Logic
Builder software to install the appropriate software and determine correct settings for
programmable parameters.
SEATBELT WARNING PREWIRE
16HCK
SEATBELT WARNING PREWIRE for 1 to 3 Belts.
16HCL
SEATBELT WARNING PREWIRE for 4 to 6 Belts.
These features include Seat Belt Switches and Seat Sensors for belted positions in the cab and a harness
routed to the center of the dash for the aftermarket installation of a Data Recorder and Seat Belt Indicator
System.
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
None
Parameter ID Description Default Units Min Max Step
Exterior_Lamp_
Warn
2179
se this parameter to enable exterior lamp
reminder. A value of 1 will result in an
audible warning when the vehicle is off and
the lights are on. A value of 0 is used to
deactivate the audible warning
On On/Off 0 1 N/A
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 11 - PAGE 7
PRODUCTIVITY FEATURES
WIRING INFORMATION
Refer to the circuit diagram manual chapter 4, pages 39-41 for wiring information.
ELECTRICAL LOAD CONTROL 11.8 VOLTS
595BMY
ELECTRICAL LOAD CONTL 11.8 Volts
595BMY is the Electrical Load Control/Shedding (ELCS) intended to protect the vehicles batteries from
excessive discharge. The goal is to save enough charge to deliver sufficient power to the starting system to
start the engine. The feature is intended to provide a convenient means of automatically shutting down loads
overnight in order to conserve energy. This feature is specifically designed to be used for a Celadon split
battery system. The first shed point for this system shall be 11.8 Volts. The second shed point is at 10 V and the
third is at 9 V.
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
Required software feature code: 595BMY and (595AYE or 595AYS or 595BJM or 595BJH)
Conflicts with Software feature: 595ACL, 595BRM
Features disabled by the Electrical Load Control/Shedding (ELCS) with an available parameter to specify the
level include the following: Work Lights, Fog Lights, Heated Mirrors, Air Shield Lights, Sleeper Dome Light,
Floor Search Lights, Skirt Light, Fuel Heater and Aux Trailer Circuit.
595AMU WORK LIGHT Rocker Switch
595ABR WORK LIGHT Push Button B
595AAU HEATED MIRRORS Rocker Switch, Aftermarket only
595AMP HEATED MIRRORS in Push Button Location B, Aftermarket only
595AMR HEATED MIRRORS in Push Button Location A
595ACE FOG LIGHTS Rocker Switch
595AMS FOG LIGHTS Push Button Location A
595AMT FOG LIGHTS Push Button Location B
595BMJ FOG LIGHTS REAR ECE R38 Compliant, Red LED
595ADK AIR SHIELD LIGHTING
595AAS INTERIOR DOME LIGHTS in Sleeper
595AAT INTERIOR FLOOR LIGHTS in Sleeper
595ADU INTERIOR FLOOR LIGHTS in Cab
595 AEG SKIRT LIGHTS Customer Supplied
595ADG FUEL HEATER Will be Activated by ESC
595ADB TRAILER AUX CIRCUIT Accessory Powered
595ADC TRAILER AUX CIRCUIT Battery Powered
The Load_Shed _Level_Work_Light parameter specifies at what level the work light may be shed or loaded.
The Load_Shed _Mirror_Heat_Level parameter specifies at what level the work heated mirrors may be shed or
loaded.
The Load_Shed _Level_Fog_Light parameter specifies at what level the fog light may be shed or loaded.
SECTION 11 - PAGE 8 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
PRODUCTIVITY FEATURES
The Load_Shed _Level_Air_Shield_Lights parameter specifies at what level the air shield lights may be shed or
loaded.
The Load_Shed _Sleeper_Dome_Light parameter specifies at what level the sleeper dome light may be shed
or loaded.
The Load_Shed _Floor_Search_Lights parameter specifies at what level the floor search lights may be shed or
loaded.
The Load_Shed _Level_Skirt_Light parameter specifies at what level the skirt light may be shed or loaded.
The Load_Shed _Level_Fuel_Heater parameter specifies at what level the fuel heater may be shed or loaded.
The Load_Shed _Level_Aux_Trailer_Circuit parameter specifies at what level the auxiliary trailer circuit may be
shed or loaded.
For features 595AMU or 595ABR: Table 78
For features 595AAU or 595AMP or 595AMR: Table 79
For features 595ACE or 595AMS or 595AMT or 595BMJ: Table 80
For features 595ADK: Table 81
For features 595AAS:Table 82
Parameter ID Description Default Units Min Max Step
Load_Shed_Level_
Work_Light
2327
Level at which load or shed occurs
(0 = Do not load shed,
1= Load shed at first level,
2 = Load shed at second level,
3 = Load shed at third level
1 List N/A N/A N/A
Parameter ID Description Default Units Min Max Step
Load_Shed_Mirror
_Heat_Level
2360
Level at which load or shed occurs
(0 = Do not load shed,
1= Load shed at first level,
2 = Load shed at second level,
3 = Load shed at third level
1 List N/A N/A N/A
Parameter ID Description Default Units Min Max Step
Load_Shed_Level_
Fog_Light
2369
Level at which load or shed occurs
(0 = Do not load shed,
1= Load shed at first level,
2 = Load shed at second level,
3 = Load shed at third level
1 List N/A N/A N/A
Parameter ID Description Default Units Min Max Step
Load_Shed_Level_
Air_Shield_Lights
511
Level at which load or shed occurs
(0 = Do not load shed,
1= Load shed at first level,
2 = Load shed at second level,
3 = Load shed at third level
1 List N/A N/A N/A
Parameter ID Description Default Units Min Max Step
Load_Shed_
Sleeper_Dome-
Light
2363
Level at which load or shed occurs
(0 = Do not load shed,
1= Load shed at first level,
2 = Load shed at second level,
3 = Load shed at third level
1 List N/A N/A N/A
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 11 - PAGE 9
PRODUCTIVITY FEATURES
For features 595AAT or 595ADU: Table 83
For features 595AEG:Table 84
For features 595AMU or 595ABR:Table 85
For features 595ADB or 595ADC:Table 86
WIRING INFORMATION
No additional wiring is needed.
TESTING
No physical testing is specified for this feature. If there is access to DLB, the signal for Battery Voltage could be
set below 11.8 V to test those features that should be shed at level 1, but it is not recommended that the actual
battery voltage be allowed to drain just to test the feature.
HOW TO ADD THIS FEATURE
Select software feature 595BMY using the Diamond Logic
Builder software.
Parameter ID Description Default Units Min Max Step
Load_Shed_Floor_
Search_Lights
2324
Level at which load or shed occurs
(0 = Do not load shed,
1= Load shed at first level,
2 = Load shed at second level,
3 = Load shed at third level
1 List N/A N/A N/A
Parameter ID Description Default Units Min Max Step
Load_Shed_Level_
Skirt_Light
2370
Level at which load or shed occurs
(0 = Do not load shed,
1= Load shed at first level,
2 = Load shed at second level,
3 = Load shed at third level
1 List N/A N/A N/A
Parameter ID Description Default Units Min Max Step
Load_Shed_Level_
Fuel_Heater
2054
Level at which load or shed occurs
(0 = Do not load shed,
1= Load shed at first level,
2 = Load shed at second level,
3 = Load shed at third level
1 List N/A N/A N/A
Parameter ID Description Default Units Min Max Step
Load_Shed_Level_
Aux_Trailer_Circuit
601
Level at which load or shed occurs
(0 = Do not load shed,
1= Load shed at first level,
2 = Load shed at second level,
3 = Load shed at third level
1 List N/A N/A N/A
SECTION 11 - PAGE 10 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
PRODUCTIVITY FEATURES
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 12 - PAGE 1
FOG, PLOW, GUIDE POST & WIG WAG
ACCOMMODATION PACKAGES
FOG, PLOW, GUIDE POST & WIG WAG ACCOMMODATION PACKAGES
FOG/DRIVING LIGHTS
Codes 08585, 08WPL, 08WPM, 08WLM, and 08WLN
Refer to the Circuit Diagram Manual S08322, Chapter 9, Lights, Fog Light and Work Light.
DuraStar
08585
TOGGLE SWITCH, AUXILIARY and Wiring; For Driving Lights or Fog Lights Mounted by Customer
08WPL
FOG LIGHTS (2) Amber, Oval, With H355W Halogen Bulb
08WPM
FOG LIGHTS (2) Clear, Oval, With H355W Halogen Bulb
WorkStar
08585
TOGGLE SWITCH, AUXILIARY and Wiring; For Driving Lights or Fog Lights Mounted by Customer
08WLM
FOG LIGHTS {Peterson} Amber, Halogen, Rectangular
08WLN
FOG LIGHTS {Peterson} Clear, Halogen, Rectangular
Feature codes 08WPL, 08WPM, 08WLM, and 08WLN come with the fog light system (wiring and fog lamps)
completely installed. Feature code 08585 is an accommodation package that comes with wiring and a fog light
connector. Customer must supply the mating connector, terminals, and seals, and must install the fog lamps.
All above features operate as follows: to turn on the fog lamps; the headlamps must be on and in the low beam
position. The lamps will go off if the headlamps are switched to high beam.
SECTION 12 - PAGE 2 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
FOG, PLOW, GUIDE POST & WIG WAG
ACCOMMODATION PACKAGES
1603 (BC J1)
f_035
1603 (BC J1)
f_036
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 12 - PAGE 3
FOG, PLOW, GUIDE POST & WIG WAG
ACCOMMODATION PACKAGES
Depending on the other features ordered on the vehicle, the fog light button switch could also be located on the
left of the steering column under the instrument cluster.
For the customers who prefer to mount their own lamps, installation integrity is improved with the factory toggle
switch and wiring feature.
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS - REQUIRED SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES:
595ACE for Rocker Switch
595AMT for Push Button in Location B under the instrument cluster
595AMS for Push Button in Location A under the instrument cluster
595AHT for 08585
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES THAT MUST BE REMOVED
None
Fog Light Switch in Switch Pack
f_037
Fog Light Switch Located Under the Instrument Cluster
f_038
SECTION 12 - PAGE 4 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
FOG, PLOW, GUIDE POST & WIG WAG
ACCOMMODATION PACKAGES
Table 31
WIRING INFORMATION
With feature 08585 and if the vehicle is a 3200, 4200, 4300 or 4400, a thin fog lamp must be used if mounted
in the bumper opening.
The fog lamp connections are located at the front of the frame on each side. See view below.
Care must be taken when adding fog lamps as lamps may have a GND wire and also have a grounded base.
Be sure that the feed circuit, cavity A, the connector at front of frame, is not connected to GND.
Mating connector part number 587568C91
Terminal (16 gauge) part number 587575C1
Seal part number 1652325C1
Parameter ID Description Default Units Min Max Step
Left_Fog_Light
_Hi_Current
2309
Left Fog Light High Current Detection Level
(AMPS)
10 A 0 10 0.1
Left_Fog_Light
_Lo_Current
2310
Left Fog Light Low Current Detection Level
(AMPS)
0.5 A 0 10 0.1
Left_Fog_Light
_OC_Current
2311
Left Fog Light Open Circuit Detection Level
(AMPS)
0.5 A 0 10 0.1
Load_Shed_
Level_Fog_
Lights
2369 Level for Load Shed for the Fog Lights 0 List N/A N/A N/A
Right_Fog_
Light_Hi_
Current
2312
Right Fog Light High Current Detection Level
(AMPS)
10 A A 0 10
Right_Fog_
Light_Lo_
Current
2313
Right Fog Light Low Current Detection Level
(AMPS)
0.5 A A 0 10
Right_Fog_
Light_OC_
Current
2314
Right Fog Light Open Circuit Detection Level
(AMPS)
0.5 A A 0 10
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 12 - PAGE 5
FOG, PLOW, GUIDE POST & WIG WAG
ACCOMMODATION PACKAGES
Thin fog lamps must be used if mounted in the bumper opening of the 3200, 4200, 4300 and 4400 models.
f_039
View of Fog Lamp Breakout
f_040
SECTION 12 - PAGE 6 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
FOG, PLOW, GUIDE POST & WIG WAG
ACCOMMODATION PACKAGES
TESTING
1. Activate fog light switch with the IGN key on and the headlamp switch on the low-beam mode.
2. Verify that pin F (labeled Left_Fog_Light) and pin K (labeled Right_Fog_Light) in DLB located in connector
(#1603 J1) are providing battery voltage.
3. Verify that the fog lights are functioning correctly.
4. Turn the fog light switch OFF.
5. Verify that the fog light output goes OFF.
HOW TO ADD THIS FEATURE
Software feature code 595ACE, 595AMY, or 595AMS (depending on switch location) must be enabled on the
vehicle using the Diamond Logic
Builder
software to determine the fog light switch assignment after the software has been programmed into the BC.
Set the desired programmable parameters for each signal using the Diamond Logic
4200, 4300,
4400, and 8500 trucks.
Table 32 Parts Information
Install fog lights using hardware included in the kit. The Figure below shows installation.
Part Number Description Quantity
2507254C91 Amber Light Kit 1
2507255C91 Clear Light Kit 1
Front View with Attachment Points
f_042
SECTION 12 - PAGE 8 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
FOG, PLOW, GUIDE POST & WIG WAG
ACCOMMODATION PACKAGES
SWITCH INSTALLATION
Refer to the Figure below.
If there is an available switch opening in location one, install the fog light control switch in this location. If, in
location one, the switch pack module is fully populated, install a six pack (part number 3549776C4) in location
two. Additional switch blanks (part number 3533950C1) may be needed to cover unused switch locations.
Location 1: Six pack
Location 2: Six Pack
Location 3: Twelve Pack
WIRING FOG LIGHTS
Refer to the Circuit Diagram Manual S08322, Chapter 9, Lights, Fog Light and Work Light for circuit
installations.
PROGRAMMING FOG LIGHTS
Adding fog lights will require reprogramming the system controller. See local dealer.
Control Panel
f_043
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 12 - PAGE 9
FOG, PLOW, GUIDE POST & WIG WAG
ACCOMMODATION PACKAGES
Table 33 Fog Light Kit - Clear
Table 34 Fog Light Kit - Amber
AUXILIARY FRONT LIGHTS
Refer to the Circuit Diagram Manual S08322, Chapter 9, Lights, Aux Headlights, Snow Plow Lights.
Feature Code Description
08THJ
AUXILIARY HARNESS 3.0 for Auxiliary Front Headlights and Turn Signals for Front Plow Applications
08TNP
AUXILIARY HARNESS 5.0 for Auxiliary Front Headlights and Turn Signals for Front Plow Applications
When front-mounted equipment blocks the vehicle headlamps and turn lamps, such as a snowplow, this feature
code is available to connect additional lamps to be used in place of the normal headlamps. These features
provide either a 3-foot or a 5-foot extension harness with a sealed 7-way connector cap for front-mounted
auxiliary headlights, park or identification, right turn signal, left turn signal and ground. The connector is located
behind the drivers side headlight under the hood.
The harness and connector provide a 20 Amp high and low beam feed, a 10 Amp right and left turn signal feed
and a 20 Amp park light feed. The connector comes with a mating connector and sealing plugs pre-installed.
The auxiliary park or identification, right and left turn signals are directly tied to the respective front lighting
circuits. When the headlight switch is turned to the PARK or ON position, both the vehicle park and auxiliary
park lights will come on. If the turn signal switch is activated, both the vehicle turn and auxiliary turn signal lights
will come on.
Part Number Description
2507255C91 Fog Light Kit Clear
3555568C91 Light, Fog w/Brkt (Clear) Slim
3535162C1 Nut, Hex Metr Prev Torq*M8X1.25
306132C1 Strap, Cable Lock
3560279C91 Harness, *Fog Lights
3560225C91 Harness, Electrical, Chassis Wi
3549438C91 Switch, Light *Assy Fog Light
3554890C1 Screen, Air Intake Radiator Gau
3552493C1 Bolt, Sems M6X1.025 SST Blk Ox
3526712C1 Nut, Special *M6
3535292C1 Bolt, Sems All 6mm X15 Torx
30592R1 Nut, Speed Standard Part M6 X1
2507524R1 Manual, Inst Fog Light Instl
Part Number Description
2507254C91 Fog Light Kit Amber
3555569C91 Light, Fog w/Brkt (Amber) Slim
3535162C1 Nut, Hex Metr Prev Torq*M8X1.25
306132C1 Strap, Cable Lock
3560279C91 Harness, *Fog Lights
3560225C91 Harness, Electrical, Chassis Wi
3549438C91 Switch, Light *Assy Fog Light
3554890C1 Screen, Air Intake Radiator Gau
3552493C1 Bolt, Sems M6X1.025 SST Blk Ox
3526712C1 Nut, Special *M6
3535292C1 Bolt, Sems All 6mm X15 Torx
30592R1 Nut, Speed Standard Part M6 X1
2507524R1 Manual, Inst Fog Light Instl
SECTION 12 - PAGE 10 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
FOG, PLOW, GUIDE POST & WIG WAG
ACCOMMODATION PACKAGES
An auxiliary lighting switch labeled PLOW LIGHTS is mounted in the dash panel. The switch controls whether
the auxiliary or vehicle headlights are on. The headlamp switch must be ON for the auxiliary headlamps to
operate. Note that both sets of headlamps cannot be turned on at the same time. The plow light switch will only
function with the key in the ON or ACCESSORY position.
This option is not available with the fog light or customer-mounted fog light options and is not available
factory-installed on DuraStar models.
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS - REQUIRED SOFTWARE FEATURE CODE:
595AMV Push button located in position A below instrument cluster
595AMW Push button located in position B below instrument cluster
595AYY Rocker switch
Plow Lights Push Button Locations
f_044
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 12 - PAGE 11
FOG, PLOW, GUIDE POST & WIG WAG
ACCOMMODATION PACKAGES
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES THAT MUST BE REMOVED
595AMS, 595AMT, 595ACE
WIRING INFORMATION
The circuit ratings are as follows: the headlamp hi beam 20 AMP, the headlamp low beam 20 AMP, the left turn
10 AMP, the right turn 10 AMP and the park 15 AMP. Since the auxiliary park and turn current is shared with
vehicle lighting current, make sure the added lighting does not exceed the stated current rating for each circuit.
All circuit protection is internal to the BC (Body Controller).
NOTE: If the plow lights are turned on without the lights being connected, the BC will log a headlamp fault
code.
Table 35 Aux. Connector Circuit Identification
Plow Light Rocker Switch
f_045
Circuit Number Cavity Function
M64HI A Hi Beam
M11-GE B GMD
M64LO C Low Beam
M56D D T/S Left
M58F E Park
M57D F T/S Right
Plug G Plug
SECTION 12 - PAGE 12 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
FOG, PLOW, GUIDE POST & WIG WAG
ACCOMMODATION PACKAGES
To mate with the chassis harness use the following:
Table 36 Part Information
The terminals and seals in the above table are for 14-gauge cable.
NOTE: It is suggested that an extra connector (Part # 2039312C91), be completely filled with plugs, which can
be saved and connected to the chassis harness connector when the plowing season is over this procedure
protects against corrosion.
TESTING
1. Activate the plow light switch in the dash using the Diamond Logic
provides standard rear stop and turn signal lights on every vehicle. If the Body Builder or TEM
needs to add different rear light configurations, such as separate stop and rear turn signals, various methods
are offered to tap into the tail light circuits. The first and most common way is to use the standard sealed tail
light 5-way Packard connector to provide lighting circuits for body-mounted lights that need combined stop and
rear turn signals. It is recommended that a sealed mating connector and terminals be used to attach body
wiring to the vehicle wiring. If the existing rear lighting is used and a marker or identification light feed is
needed, International
recommends using the 5-way connector on the driver side rear tail light. Other optional
methods for adding various light configurations are available (feature codes 08HAA, 08HAB, and 08NAA).
A feed terminal for body marker lights is provided in "terminal D" position on the left tail lamp. To wire body
lights, Body Builders are to attach a terminal (International
connector
1677851C1 or Packard Electric P12186400. Be sure to use a terminal plug in any unused cavities in the
connector body. Alternately, order feature code 08NAA which includes separate wiring for standard left and
right tail lights with 8' of extra cable for extending tail light wiring and separate wiring for left and right
body-mounted tail lights.
The standard tail light connectors are located at the lights mounted to both the driver and passenger sides of
the frame rail at the rear.
STANDARD TAIL, MARKER, AND CLEARANCE LAMP CONNECTION
This feature is standard with standard tail lamps.
International
provides a connection point at the left rear standard tail lamp. The connection point is made
available so that power can be provided to additional tail, marker and clearance lamps.
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
None
WIRING INFORMATION
There is an unused cavity in the left rear tail lamp connector that can be used to provide tail, marker and
clearance power. Remove the connector from the lamp and remove the cavity seal. Terminate added circuit
with terminal and seal below, and insert into cavity D.
Table 41
NOTE: Circuit is protected internally by the Body Controller (BC) at 15 Amperes (AMPS). If current is close to
or exceeds 15 AMPS, a relay must be added.
Parts Part Numbers
Terminal (12 gauge) 2033816C1
Seal 589390C1
SECTION 13 - PAGE 2 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
BODY BUILDER WIRING FOR
STOP/TAIL/TURN LIGHTS
If the rear lighting is to be entirely body-mounted, and a connection to the rear harness tail lamp connector is
needed, use connector, terminal and seal specified below.
Table 42
Parts Part Numbers
Connector 1677851C1
Terminal
1687848C1 10 Gauge
2033912C1 12-14 Gauge
Lock 1677914C1
Seal
0589390C1 10-12 Gauge
0589391C1 14-16 Gauge
Feed Terminal Location on Left Tail Lamp
f_048
Feed Terminal Location on Left Tail Lamp
f_049
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 13 - PAGE 3
BODY BUILDER WIRING FOR
STOP/TAIL/TURN LIGHTS
TESTING
When additional lights are added, test those lights for functionality and test the connection point for battery
voltage.
BODY BUILDER WIRING AT END OF FRAME
Refer to the Circuit Diagram Manual S08322, Chapter 10, Chassis Accessories, Body Builder and Trailer
Socket Back of Cab (BOC) and EOF.
08HAA
BODY BUILDER WIRING To EOF, With Stop, Tail, Turn, and Marker Lights Circuits, Ignition (IGN)-Controlled
Auxiliary Feed and Ground (GND), Less Trailer Socket
This feature is for vehicles that have heavy-duty lighting requirements. This feature has a 30 AMP IGN Feed.
Right and left turn signals can support up to seven turn lamps per side. Code 08HAA is designed for separate
stop and turn lamps only. The 7-wire breakout is located at the EOF, and there is no connector. The wires are
blunt-cut with heat shrink covering.
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
Software Feature Codes that must be added: 595ABC
Software Feature Codes that must be removed: NONE
These parameters should be left at their factory default values!
Table 43
WIRING INFORMATION
08HAA gives 7 wires located at EOF that are blunt-cut.
Table 44 08HAA
Connector pinout is labeled as Trailer Socket (9734) connector in Circuit Diagram Manual S08322, Chapter 10,
Chassis Accessories, Body Builder and Trailer Socket BOC and EOF. The connector itself is not supplied,
and wires are blunt-cut.
Parameter ID Description Default Units Min Max Step
LT_FT_Turn_
Lo_Current
1910
Park and ID Lights Low Current
Detection Level (AMPS)
0.5 A 0 10 0.1
LT_FT_Turn_
Hi_Current
1911
Park and ID Lights High Current
Detection Level (AMPS)
10 A 0 10 0.1
LT_FT_Turn_
OC_Current
1912
Park and ID Lights Open Circuit
Detection Level (AMPS)
0.5 A 0 10 0.1
RT_FT_Turn_
Lo_Current
1913
Park and ID Lights Low Current
Detection Level (AMPS)
0.5 A 0 10 0.1
RT_FT_Turn_
Hi_Current
1914
Park and ID Lights High Current
Detection Level (AMPS)
10 A 0 10 0.1
RT_FT_Turn_
OC_Current
1915
Park and ID Lights Open Circuit
Detection Level (AMPS)
0.5 A 0 10 0.1
Cavity Circuit Number Maximum Current Description Fused by
N/A R70 30 A Stop Lights F7-D F4-E4
N/A R68 20 A Park Lights F3-B D2-C2
N/A R94 30 A IGN Feed F8-D F4-E4
N/A R58 20 A Identification Lights F3-D D4-C4
N/A R56 15 A Left Turn F2-A F1-E1
N/A R57 15 A Right Turn F2-C F3-E3
N/A R10 N/A GND
SECTION 13 - PAGE 4 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
BODY BUILDER WIRING FOR
STOP/TAIL/TURN LIGHTS
TESTING
WARNING: To avoid property damage, personal injury or death, park the vehicle on a level surface, set the
parking brake, chock the wheels and turn the engine off.
1. Turn on vehicle headlights.
2. Verify that the taillight circuit (# R68) has battery voltage levels present.
3. Verify that the marker light circuit (# R58) has battery voltage levels present.
4. Turn off vehicle headlights.
5. Turn on left turn signal in vehicle.
6. Verify that left turn circuit (# R56) is cycling between battery voltage and GND.
7. Turn off vehicle left turn signal.
8. Turn on right turn signal in vehicle.
9. Verify that right turn circuit (# R57) is cycling between battery voltage and GND.
10. Turn off vehicle left turn signal.
11. Put the vehicle in reverse.
12. Turn the key to the accessory or IGN position.
13. Verify that the IGN circuit (# R94) has battery voltage levels present.
14. Press the vehicle brake pedal.
15. Verify that the stop circuit (# R70) has battery voltage levels present.
16. Release brake pedal.
CIRCUIT DIAGRAM
See Circuit Diagram Manual S08322, Chapter 10, Chassis Accessories, Body Builder and Trailer Socket
BOC and EOF.
Location of 7-Wire Breakout at EOF
f_050
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 13 - PAGE 5
BODY BUILDER WIRING FOR
STOP/TAIL/TURN LIGHTS
HOW TO ADD THIS FEATURE
Feature 08HAA is not available with code 08HAG and 08HAH Electric Trailer Brake or codes 08TME and
08TMG Trailer Connection Socket and 08THH Aux Trailer Socket with Center Pin Circuit. If the vehicle has any
of these codes, 08HAA cannot be installed in the vehicle.
This feature is not easy to install, and every effort should be made to order the vehicle with the desired code.
Refer to the How Do I General Information section of this electrical guide for obtaining information on
obtaining required circuits.
Refer to the 7-way socket at EOF for information covering circuit connections and use of the circuit diagram
manual to aid in assembly.
BODY BUILDER WIRING
Refer to the Circuit Diagram Manual S08322, Chapter 10, Chassis Accessories, Body Builder Connections.
08HAB
BODY BUILDER WIRING, BOC AT LEFT OF FRAME, includes 7-way sealed connector for
tail/amber/backup/accessory power/GND and sealed connectors for combination stop/turn and a 3-way for
separate stop/turn lights.
08HAE
BODY BUILDER WIRING, BOC REAR OF FRAME, includes 7-way sealed connector for tail/
amber/backup/accessory power/GND and sealed connectors for combination stop/turn and a 3-way for
separate stop/turn lights.
08HAU
BODY BUILDER WIRING INSIDE CAB; Includes Sealed Connectors for Tail/Amber,
Turn/Marker/Backup/Accessory, Power/Ground, and Stop/Turn.
These features provide power to operate various body loads or after-market accessories such as
stop/tail/backup/marker/rear turn signal lights, motors, heaters, etc. There are two connectors that come with
these options. A 7-way and a 3-way both have sealed mating connectors and sealing plugs pre-installed. The
7-way connector provides the combined stop and turn signal circuits while the 3-way provides the separate
stop and turn signal circuits. It is always recommended that sealed mating connector terminals be used to
attach body wiring to the vehicle wiring. Also, if this option is used in place of the standard rear lighting
connector, it is recommended that a mating connector with sealing plugs be placed into the standard rear tail
light connector.
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
Software Feature Codes that must be added: 595ABC
Software Feature Codes that must be removed: NONE
These parameters should be left at their factory default values!
SECTION 13 - PAGE 6 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
BODY BUILDER WIRING FOR
STOP/TAIL/TURN LIGHTS
Table 45
WIRING INFORMATION
08HAB: Connectors are located inside the drivers side frame rail at the BOC.
08HAE: Connectors are located inside the drivers side frame rail at the EOF.
08HAU: Connectors are located inside the cab.
Table 46 7-Way Connector Information
Table 47 More 7-Way Connector Information
Parameter ID Description Default Units Min Max Step
LT_FT_Turn_
Lo_Current
1910
Park and ID Lights Low
Current Detection Level
(AMPS)
0.5 A 0 10 0.1
LT_FT_Turn_
Hi_Current
1911
Park and ID Lights High
Current Detection Level
(AMPS)
10 A 0 10 0.1
LT_FT_Turn_
OC_Current
1912
Park and ID Lights Open
Circuit Detection Level
(AMPS)
0.5 A 0 10 0.1
RT_FT_Turn_
Lo_Current
1913
Park and ID Lights Low
Current Detection Level
(AMPS)
0.5 A 0 10 0.1
RT_FT_Turn_
Hi_Current
1914
Park and ID Lights High
Current Detection Level
(AMPS)
10 A 0 10 0.1
RT_FT_Turn_
OC_Current
1915
Park and ID Lights Open
Circuit Detection Level
(AMPS)
0.5 A 0 10 0.1
Wire Number Cavity Gauge Color Description Fuse Rating
(Amps)
Available
Current (Amps)
N68BB A 14 Brown Tail Light 20 20
N56BB B 16 Yellow Left Turn Light 10 8
N57BB C 16 Light Green Right Turn Light 10 8
N54BB D 14 Brown Marker Light 20 20
N71BB E 16 Light Blue Back-up Light 10 6
N12BB F 14 Light Blue Accessory Feed 20 20
N11-GD G 12 White GND -- --
Description Chassis Harness Body Builder Harness
(4450) 7-Way Connector 2039311C91 2039312C91
Lock 2039342C1
12 Gauge Seals 589390C1
14 Gauge Seals 589391C1
16 Gauge Seals 1652325C1
12 Gauge Terminals 2039344C1 1687848C1
14 Gauge Terminals 3535486C1 2033912C1
16 Gauge Terminals 2039343C1 2033911C1
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 13 - PAGE 7
BODY BUILDER WIRING FOR
STOP/TAIL/TURN LIGHTS
Table 48 3-Way Connector Information
Table 49 More 3-Way Connector Information
Wire Number Cavity Gauge Color Description Fuse Rating
(Amps)
Available
Current (Amps)
N56BC A 16 Orange Left Turn Light 10 6
N57BC B 16 Orange Right Turn Light 10 6
N70BB C 14 Orange Stop Light 15 15
Description Chassis Harness Body Builder Harness
(4460) 7-Way Connector 1686834C1 3553961C1
Lock 1664408C1
14 Gauge Seals 589391C1
16 Gauge Seals 1652325C1
14 Gauge Terminals 2033816C1 2033912C1
16 Gauge Terminals 2033819C1 2033911C1
7-Way and 3Way Connectors for 08HAB (BOC)
f_051
SECTION 13 - PAGE 8 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
BODY BUILDER WIRING FOR
STOP/TAIL/TURN LIGHTS
1
7-Way and 3Way Connectors for 08HAE (EOF)
f_052
7-Way and 3Way Connectors for 08HAU (Inside Cab)
f_053
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 13 - PAGE 9
BODY BUILDER WIRING FOR
STOP/TAIL/TURN LIGHTS
TESTING
WARNING: To avoid property damage, personal injury or death, park the vehicle on a level surface, set the
parking brake, chock the wheels and turn the engine off.
For Combined Stop and Turn:
1. Turn on vehicle headlights.
2. Verify that the tail light circuit, Cavity A of 7-way socket with brown 14 gauge wire, has battery voltage
levels present.
3. Verify that the marker light circuit, Cavity D of 7-way socket with brown 14 gauge wire, has battery voltage
levels present.
4. Turn OFF vehicle headlights.
5. Turn on left turn signal in vehicle.
6. Verify that left turn/stop circuit, Cavity B of 7-way socket with orange 16 gauge wire, is cycling between
battery voltage and GND.
7. Turn off vehicle left turn signal.
8. Turn on right turn signal in vehicle.
9. Verify that right turn/stop circuit, Cavity C of 7-way socket with orange 16 gauge wire, is cycling between
battery voltage and GND.
10. Turn off vehicle left turn signal.
11. Put the vehicle in reverse.
12. Verify that the body backup lights are working correctly.
13. Verify that the backup light circuit, Cavity E of 7-way socket with orange 16 gauge wire, has battery voltage
levels present.
14. Take the vehicle out of reverse.
15. Turn key to accessory or IGN position.
16. Verify that the accessory circuit, Cavity F of 7-way socket with light blue 14 gauge wire, has battery voltage
levels present.
17. Press the vehicle brake pedal.
18. Verify that the brake lights are functioning correctly.
19. Verify that the left turn/stop circuit, Cavity B of 7-way socket with orange 16 gauge wire, AND the right
turn/stop circuit, Cavity C of 7-way socket with orange 16 gauge wire have battery voltage levels present.
20. Release brake pedal.
For Separate Stop and Turn:
1. Turn ON vehicle headlights.
2. Verify that the tail light circuit, Cavity A of 7-way socket with brown 14 gauge wire, has battery voltage
levels present.
3. Verify that the marker light circuit, Cavity D of 7-way socket with brown 14 gauge wire, has battery voltage
levels present.
4. Turn off vehicle headlights.
5. Turn on left turn signal in vehicle.
6. Verify that left turn circuit, Cavity A of 3-way socket with orange 16 gauge wire, is cycling between battery
voltage and GND.
7. Turn off vehicle left turn signal.
8. Turn on right turn signal in vehicle.
SECTION 13 - PAGE 10 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
BODY BUILDER WIRING FOR
STOP/TAIL/TURN LIGHTS
9. Verify that right turn circuit, Cavity B of 3-way socket with orange 16 gauge wire, is cycling between battery
voltage and GND.
10. Turn off vehicle left turn signal.
11. Put the vehicle in reverse.
12. Verify that the backup light circuit, Cavity E of 7-way socket with orange 16 gauge wire, has battery voltage
levels present.
13. Take the vehicle out of reverse.
14. Turn key to accessory or IGN position.
15. Verify that the accessory circuit, Cavity F of 7-way socket with light blue 14 gauge wire, has battery voltage
levels present.
16. Press the vehicle brake pedal.
17. Verify that the stop circuit, Cavity C of 3-way socket with orange 14 gauge wire, has battery voltage levels
present.
18. Release brake pedal.
HOW TO ADD THIS FEATURE
This feature is not easy to install and every effort should be made to order the vehicle with the desired code.
Refer to the How Do I General Information section of this electrical guide for obtaining information on
obtaining required circuits.
Refer to the 7-Way Socket at EOF for information covering circuit connections and use of the circuit diagram
manual to aid in assembly.
AUXILIARY 7-WAY TRAILER SOCKET
Refer to Circuit Diagram Manual S08322, Chapter 10, Chassis Accessories, Body Builder and Trailer Socket
BOC and EOF.
08THG
AUX. TRAILER SOCKET 7-Way; With Battery Fed Circuit to Center Pin, With 25 AMP Fuse and Relay
Controlled by Switch with Indicator Light on Instrument Panel (IP) Fed from Hot Battery Feed (Not Wired Thru
Key Switch)
08THH
AUX. TRAILER SOCKET 7-Way; With Battery Fed Circuit to Center Pin, With 25 AMP Fuse and Relay
Controlled by Switch with Indicator Light Controlled by Accessory Side of Key Switch, Switch Mounted on IP
08THU
TRAILER SOCKET 7-Way; With Battery Fed Circuit to Center Pin, With 30 Amp Fuse and Relay Controlled by
Switch With Indicator Light on Instrument Panel Fed from Hot Battery Feed, When Parking Brake Is Applied,
Not Wired Thru Key Switch
08TMN
TRAILER CONNECTION SOCKET {Phillips STA-DRY} 7-Way; Equipped With ABS Feed, Mounted at BOC
and End of Frame Locations
These features allow a customer to connect two trailer lighting circuits to the vehicle. These options provide the
same functionality as sales code 08HAB but provide a second 7-way socket next to the existing 7-way socket
at the BOC.
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 13 - PAGE 11
BODY BUILDER WIRING FOR
STOP/TAIL/TURN LIGHTS
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES THAT MUST BE ADDED
None
Refer to feature code 08HAB for wiring and installation information. The circuits from the first 7-way trailer
socket are directly spliced to the circuits of the second 7-way trailer socket. Part numbers for the connector and
terminals remain the same.
TRAILER AUXILIARY FEED CIRCUIT, 30 AMP ACCESSORY FEED
Refer to Circuit Diagram Manual S08322, Chapter 10, Chassis Accessories, Body Builder and Trailer Socket
BOC and EOF.
08TKK
TRAILER AUXILIARY FEED CIRCUIT for Electric Trailer Brake Accommodation/Air Trailer ABS; With 30 Amp
Fuse and Relay, Controlled by Ignition Switch
These features enables a truck to be wired to accommodate multiple trailer sockets that will drive the electrical
loads of either an air brake type trailer or a trailer with electric brakes.
The 30 amp feed may be used for air brake Trailer ABS Power or as a charging circuit for electric trailer brake
batteries.
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES THAT MUST BE ADDED
None
Refer to feature code 08HAB for wiring and installation information. The circuits from the first 7-way trailer
socket are directly spliced to the circuits of the second 7-way trailer socket. Part numbers for the connector and
terminals remain the same. The circuit is routed to the end of the frame rail with blunt cut wires.
EXTENDING TAIL LIGHT HARNESSES
08NAA
TAIL LIGHT WIRING MODIFIED Includes: Separate Wiring for Standard Left and Right Tail Lights, With 8.0 of
Extra Cable; Separate Wiring for Left and Right Body-Mounted Tail Lights, With 8.0 of Extra Cable
Feature code 08NAA provides eight additional feet of stop, turn, and tail light wiring to relocate the stop/turn
lights provided with the vehicle.
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
None
WIRING INFORMATION
The extra harness length for code 08NAA is coiled at the EOF on both the right and left frame rail per view
below. The loose harness connector is covered with a sealed connector. If standard tail lights are being
removed, use sealing cap to protect open connector.
If a harness is to be connected to the OEM connector, see below for parts requirements. The part number for
the 08NAA extension harness is 3547275C91.
SECTION 13 - PAGE 12 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
BODY BUILDER WIRING FOR
STOP/TAIL/TURN LIGHTS
Table 50 Left Side Connector
Table 51 Right Side Connector
Plug P/N 587579C1
Connector Lock P/N 1677914C1
HOW TO ADD THIS FEATURE
See the part numbers identified in the Wiring Information section of this document.
Connector Cavity Information and Parts Required to connect to OEM Connector
Connector P/N Cavity Circuit # Description Term P/N Seal P/N
1677851C1
A S71H Back up 2033911C1 589391C1
B S68F Tail 2033911C1 589391C1
C S56E Stop/Turn 2033911C1 589391C1
D Plug -- 2033911C1 589391C1
E S10-GF GND 2033911C1 589391C1
Connector Cavity Information and Parts Required to connect to OEM Connector
Connector P/N Cavity Circuit # Description Term P/N Seal P/N
1677851C1
A S71G Back up 2033911C1 589391C1
B S68G Tail 2033911C1 589391C1
C S57E Stop/Turn 2033911C1 589391C1
D Plug -- 2033911C1 589391C1
E S10-GE GND 2033911C1 589391C1
f_054
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 13 - PAGE 13
BODY BUILDER WIRING FOR
STOP/TAIL/TURN LIGHTS
CENTER CHASSIS EXTENSION HARNESS
08WEB
SPECIAL WIRING HARNESS, BODY for Chassis, With 6' Additional Length to Accommodate Drop Frame
Beverage Body Application
Feature code 08WEB provides an additional 6 feet to the center chassis harness. This feature is to
accommodate drop frame applications but may be specified when additional chassis harness length is desired.
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
None
WIRING INFORMATION
A 6 extension of the center chassis harness, part number 3560971C91, is provided for Beverage Body
Applications. A 24-pin connector is provided at the end of the extension.
HOW TO ADD THIS FEATURE
See the part numbers identified in the Wiring Information section of this document.
f_055
SECTION 13 - PAGE 14 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
BODY BUILDER WIRING FOR
STOP/TAIL/TURN LIGHTS
AUXILIARY HARNESS FOR AUXILIARY POWER SOURCE
08WEX
AUXILIARY HARNESS for Auxiliary Power Source; 30 Amp, Key Switched, 2-Pin Connector, Located on Floor
Between Seats
This feature consists of an ignition key switched wiring that is routed up the right A pillar to the back of cab to
a coil that when stretched out can reach between the seats. The circuit is protected with a 30 AMP fuse. This
feature is only available on the 7000 models.
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
None
WIRING INFORMATION
The wiring inside back of cab includes both GND and feed circuits, and the circuits are terminated to a two pin
connector. The GND circuit is white, and the Ign12V feed is orange.
Connector Part Number: 0587568C91
Connector ref # 1872F
This switch is hard wired and there are no multiplex circuits associated with this feature. NOTE - This feature
does depend on IGNITION key position, and can not be turned on with the key off.
View of Coiled Wire Location , Viewed From Inside Vehicle
f_056
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 13 - PAGE 15
BODY BUILDER WIRING FOR
STOP/TAIL/TURN LIGHTS
If wire is to be routed out of cab the desired hole location for the harness to exit the cab and location may vary
from customer to customer, circuits are left on the floor for customer to drill hole.
Note that there are floor or back of cab reinforcements that should not be drilled into. Remove interior
components to locate harness and determine best hole location. Install grommet into the hole and seal around
cables and grommet to prevent leakage of moisture into cab.
When connecting to load, be sure to use sealed connectors or a splice protected with heat shrink sleeve with
an adhesive inner lining.
TESTING
1. Turn on ignition switch.
2. Verify that the added feature operates.
3. Verify that the feed wire is receiving battery voltage.
HOW TO ADD THIS FEATURE
If the vehicle was not ordered with the feature, it may be added. For information on parts and components, see
How Do I General Information section of this electrical guide.
ELECTRIC TRAILER BRAKES
Refer to the Circuit Diagram Manual S08322, Chapter 10, Chassis Accessories, Electric Trailer Brake.
08HAG
ELECTRIC TRAILER BRAKE/LIGHTS Accommodation Package to Rear of Frame (ROF); for Separate Trailer
Stop, Tail, Turn, Marker Light Circuits; Includes Electric Trailer Brake Accommodation Package With Cab
Connections for Mounting Customer- Installed Electric Brake Unit, Less Trailer Socket
08HAH
ELECTRIC TRAILER BRAKE/LIGHTS Accommodation Package to Rear of Frame; for Combined Trailer Stop,
Tail, Turn, Marker Light Circuits; Includes Electric Trailer Brake Accommodation Package With Cab
Connections for Mounting Customer-Installed Electric Brake Unit, Less Trailer Socket
These features provide a four-circuit breakout, blunt-cut with heat shrink covering located under the Instrument
Panel (IP) on the left side of the steering column. The circuits include a Ground (GND) circuit, an electric brake
feed to electric trailer brakes, a 30 Ampere (AMP) power circuit plus the stop lamp feed. The circuits are
designed to work with all popular electric trailer brake controllers.
The two different features are designed to handle trailers with separate stop and turn and combination stop and
turn circuits.
The seven circuits that connect to the trailer are located at the rear of frame and are blunt cut with heat shrink
covering. The appropriate socket assembly needs to be added by the customer.
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
Required software feature codes: 595AHU, 595ABC
Software Feature Codes That Must Be Removed: 0595ABS
These parameters should be left at their factory default values!
SECTION 13 - PAGE 16 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
BODY BUILDER WIRING FOR
STOP/TAIL/TURN LIGHTS
Table 52
WIRING INFORMATION
For circuit installation, see Circuit Diagram Manual S08322, Chapter 10, Chassis Accessories, Electric Trailer
Brake.
The circuit colors/function to the electric brake controller are as follows:
Table 53
08HAG and 08HAH provides seven blunt-cut wires located at end of frame and four blunt-cut wires located
under cab IP.
The following are the wires for the circuits found in the blunt-cut wires located at the end of the frame.
Table 54
Parameter ID Description Default Units Min Step Max
LT_FT_Turn_
Hi_Current
1911
Left front turn signal high current
detection level (AMPS)
10 A 0 10 0.1
LT_FT_Turn_
Lo_Current
1910
Left front turn signal low current
detection level (AMPS)
0.5 A 0 10 0.1
LT_FT_Turn_
OC_Current
1912
Left front turn signal open circuit
detection level (AMPS)
0.5 A 0 10 0.1
RT_FT_Turn_
Hi_Current
1914
Right front turn signal high
current detection level (AMPS)
10 A 0 10 0.1
RT_FT_Turn_
Lo_Current
1913
Right front turn signal low current
detection level (AMPS)
0.5 A 0 10 0.1
RT_FT_Turn_
OC_Current
1915
Right front turn signal open circuit
detection level (AMPS)
0.5 A 0 10 0.1
Circuit Wire Color Wire Gauge
Power feed to the controller Black 12
Stop lamp feed Red 16
Feed to electric trailer brakes Grey 10
GND White 16
Circuit Number Maximum
Current
Description/Labeled Color
08HAG and 08HAH Label Number (Connector 9724)
R70 30 A Stop Lights Red
R68 20 A Park Lights Brown
R94 30 A Trailer Brake Grey
R58 20 A Identification Lights Brown
R10 N/A GND White
08HAG Connector (Connector 9724)
R56 15 A Left Turn Yellow
R57 15 A Right Turn Light Green
08HAH Connector (Connector 9724)
R56 15 A Left/Stop Turn Yellow
$57 15 A Right/Stop Turn Light Green
08HAG and 08HAH Label ETB Controller (Connector 1923)
AJ11-GNA -- GND Signal White
A14NS 30 A Power Supply Signal Black
A70NS 15 A Stop Lights Red
A94T 20 A Elec Brake Signal Dark Blue
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 13 - PAGE 17
BODY BUILDER WIRING FOR
STOP/TAIL/TURN LIGHTS
NOTE: Many trailers combine trailer marker lamps with the tail lamp. If this has been done, leave the black
circuit covered with the heat shrink tube.
Location of 4-Wire Breakout under Dash
f_057
Location of 7-Wire Breakout at End of Frame
F_050
SECTION 13 - PAGE 18 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
BODY BUILDER WIRING FOR
STOP/TAIL/TURN LIGHTS
TESTING
1. Make proper trailer connections.
2. Turn on headlights.
3. Verify that the brown tail light wire and the black identification light wire have battery voltage levels present.
4. Turn off headlights.
5. Press the footbrake.
6. Verify that the red brake wire has battery voltage levels present.
7. Release the footbrake.
8. Turn on the left turn signal.
9. Verify that the yellow left turn signal wire is cycling between battery voltage and GND.
10. Turn off left turn signal.
11. Turn on the right turn signal.
12. Verify that the light green right turn signal wire is cycling between battery voltage and GND.
13. Turn off right turn signal.
14. Activate trailer brakes with the trailer brake controller.
15. Verify that the dark blue electric trailer brake wire has variable voltage levels present commensurate with
the position of the brake controller lever.
16. Verify that trailer brakes are functioning correctly by calibrating the electric trailer brake controller according
to the manufacturers instructions.
TRAILER SOCKETS
Refer to Circuit Diagram Manual S08322, Chapter 10, Chassis Accessories, Body Builder and Trailer Socket
BOC and EOF.
08TME
TRAILER CONNECTION SOCKET 7-Way; Mounted at EOF, Wired for Turn Signals Independent of Stop,
Compatible with Trailers That Have Amber or Side Lamps
08TMG
TRAILER CONNECTION SOCKET 7-Way; Mounted at EOF, Wired for Turn Signals Combines With Stop,
Compatible With Trailers That Use Combined Stop, Tail, Turn Lamps
These features are used to connect trailer lighting circuits to the vehicle. These options are for providing
separate and combined stop and turn signals and are located at the EOF. These 7-way sockets provide
IGN-controlled fused 30 AMP center pins for trailer Antilock Brake Systems (ABS). Feature 08TMG is designed
for trailers with combined stop and turn lamps. With all trailer connection features, the socket is a standard SAE
recommended socket used in the trucking industry. The circuit arrangement in the socket is also the same as
SAE recommendation, except for 08TMG which has no separate stop circuit.
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
Software Feature Codes that must be added: 595ABW, 595AAD, and 595ABC.
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES THAT MUST BE REMOVED
None
These parameters should be left at their factory default values!
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 13 - PAGE 19
BODY BUILDER WIRING FOR
STOP/TAIL/TURN LIGHTS
Table 55
WIRING INFORMATION
A 7-Way Trailer socket is provided at the end of the drivers side frame rail.
Parameter ID Description Default Units Min Max Step
LT_FT_Turn_
Lo_Current
1910
Park and ID Lights Low Current
Detection Level (Amps)
0.5 A 0 10 0.1
LT_FT_Turn_
Hi_Current
1911
Park and ID Lights High Current
Detection Level (Amps)
10 A 0 10 0.1
LT_FT_Turn_
OC_Current
1912
Park and ID Lights Open Circuit
Detection Level (Amps)
0.5 A 0 10 0.1
RT_FT_Turn_
Lo_Current
1913
Park and ID Lights Low Current
Detection Level (Amps)
0.5 A 0 10 0.1
RT_FT_Turn_
Hi_Current
1914
Park and ID Lights High Current
Detection Level (Amps)
10 A 0 10 0.1
RT_FT_Turn_
OC_Current
1915
Park and ID Lights Open Circuit
Detection Level (AMPS)
0.5 A 0 10 0.1
Trailer Socket (Mating End View)
f_058
SECTION 13 - PAGE 20 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
BODY BUILDER WIRING FOR
STOP/TAIL/TURN LIGHTS
Table 56 Electrical Description of 08TME
Table 57 Electrical Description of 08TMG
TESTING
08TME
1. Turn on vehicle headlights.
2. Verify that the tail lights circuit (brown wire, top left cavity on trailer socket) has battery voltage levels
present.
3. Verify that trailer marker circuit (black wire, top right cavity on trailer socket) has battery voltage levels
present.
4. Turn off vehicle headlights.
5. Turn on vehicle right turn lamp.
6. Verify that the trailer right turn lamp circuit (green wire, bottom left cavity on trailer socket) is cycling
between battery voltage and GND.
7. Turn off vehicle right turn lamp.
8. Turn on vehicle left turn lamp.
9. Verify that the trailer left turn lamp circuit (yellow wire, bottom right cavity on trailer socket) is cycling
between battery voltage and GND.
10. Turn off vehicle left turn lamp.
11. Press the vehicle brake pedal.
12. Verify that the trailer brake light circuit (red wire, bottom center cavity on trailer socket) has battery voltage
levels present when the IGN key is in the accessory position.
13. Verify that trailer brake circuit (Blue wire, center cavity on trailer socket) has battery voltage levels present.
14. Release brake pedal.
08TMG
1. Turn on vehicle headlights.
2. Verify that the tail lights circuit (brown wire, top left cavity on trailer socket) has battery voltage levels
present.
3. Verify that trailer marker circuit (black wire, top right cavity on trailer socket) has battery voltage levels
present.
4. Turn off vehicle headlights.
5. Turn on vehicle right turn lamp.
Circuit Description Fused Available Current Color
GND -- -- White
Tail Lamp 20 20 Brown
Right Turn 15 15 Green
Left Turn 15 15 Yellow
Marker 20 20 Black
Stop 30 30 Red
Center Pin 30 30 Blue
Circuit Description Fused Available Current Color
GND -- -- White
Tail Lamp 20 20 Brown
Right Turn 15 15 Green
Left Turn 15 15 Yellow
Marker 20 20 Black
Stop -- Not Provided --
Center Pin 30 30 Blue
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 13 - PAGE 21
BODY BUILDER WIRING FOR
STOP/TAIL/TURN LIGHTS
6. Verify that the trailer right turn/stop lamp circuit (green wire, bottom left cavity on trailer socket) is cycling
between battery voltage and GND.
7. Turn off vehicle right turn lamp.
8. Turn on vehicle left turn lamp.
9. Verify that the trailer left turn/stop lamp circuit (yellow wire, bottom right cavity on trailer socket) is cycling
between battery voltage and GND.
10. Turn off vehicle left turn lamp.
11. Press the vehicle brake pedal.
12. Verify that the right turn/stop circuit (green wire, bottom left cavity on trailer socket) and the left turn/stop
circuit (yellow wire, bottom right cavity on trailer socket) have battery voltage levels present.
13. Verify that the trailer brake light circuit (red wire, bottom center cavity on trailer socket) has battery voltage
levels present when the IGN key is in the accessory position.
14. Release brake pedal.
HOW TO ADD THIS FEATURE
Adding these features after the vehicle is built is not an easy task. It is encouraged that the vehicle be ordered
with the desired feature.
Refer to the How Do I General Information section of this electrical guide to obtain information on circuits and
components. It is necessary to have the circuit diagram manual that applies to the vehicle to complete the
installation.
The installation requires additional fuses and relays be added to the Power Distribution Center (PDC) in the
cab. Be sure to label the function of the added relays and fuses to the decal on the underside of the PDC cover.
The loose circuits will be numbered and correspond to the circuits outlined in the circuit diagram manual.
SECTION 13 - PAGE 22 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
BODY BUILDER WIRING FOR
STOP/TAIL/TURN LIGHTS
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 14 - PAGE 1
WORK LIGHT AND OUTSIDE CAB POWER
FEATURES
WORK LIGHT AND OUTSIDE CAB POWER FEATURES
WORK LIGHT/AUXILIARY REAR LIGHT
Refer to the Circuit Diagram Manual S08322, Chapter 9, Lights, Fog Light and Work Light.
Tractor
08WLL
WORK LIGHT; Pedestal Mounted With Switch on Instrument Panel
08WAA
WORK LIGHT; Pedestal Mounted With Switch on Instrument Panel (Truck Lite 81 Series)
Straight Truck
08WMA
WORK LIGHT TOGGLE SWITCH, on Instrument Panel and Wiring Effects for Customer Furnished Back of
Cab Light
08WXN
WORK LIGHT (2) (Grote) 60 Series, Mounted Under Hood One Each Side
With the International
-installed work light (08WLL, 08WAA), nighttime trailer hook-ups are made easier with a
work light mounted at the Back of Cab (BOC) on tractors. This light illuminates the fifth wheel area of the
vehicle. Both features include a switch in the Instrument Panel (IP), or 08WMA can also come with a push
button switch located below the instrument cluster. Either switch will illuminate when the switch is on. These
features provide an out-of-cab load on pin G of the Body Controller (BC) connector #1603. The feature without
the light (08WMA) can be used to satisfy any number of electrical needs for vehicles with straight truck brakes
(4091) such as lights inside dry van boxes, small pumps, and illumination to aid in various job functions.
If the engine is off, there is a time out feature, which is factory set at 120 minutes. The time out period can be
changed through the Diamond Logic
Builder software (see local dealer if not owned). If the vehicle is running,
the work light will not time out after 120 minutes. If the work light is left on when the vehicle is moving, the green
indicator light in the work light switch will flash.
1603 (BC J1)
f_059
SECTION 14 - PAGE 2 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
WORK LIGHT AND OUTSIDE CAB POWER
FEATURES
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS-REQUIRED SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES
08WLL, 08WAA: 595ABR Switch located in the switch pack
08WMA:
595ABR or
595AMU Switch located below the instrument cluster in position B and
595AJE
08WXN:
595AMU Switch located below the instrument cluster on right side
The Work_Light_Timeout_Enable parameter is used to set the amount of time that the customer desires the
work light to remain on after the IGN key is turned off. This parameter is for customers who desire to have their
work light time out after a specified length of time so that the light does not drain the battery(s) in case the
operator forgets to turn the work light off.
Work Light Located in Switch Pack
f_060
Push Button Switch Located Below the Instrument Cluster
f_061
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 14 - PAGE 3
WORK LIGHT AND OUTSIDE CAB POWER
FEATURES
If the current in the work light circuit falls below the level set by the Work_Light_Lo_Current parameter, the
Body Controller (BC) will register a fault code.
If the current in the work light circuit exceeds the level set by the Work_Light_Hi_Current parameter, the Body
Controller (BC) will shut off the circuit and register a fault code.
The Work_Light_OC_Current parameter should be left at its factory default of zero.
Table 58
WIRING INFORMATION
The maximum current load for the work light/aux light is 10 AMPS. The circuit protection is internal to the Body
Controller (BC).
Table 59 Parts Required to Connect to Work Light Cable
Table 60 Terminals Designed for 16-Gauge Wire
Parameter ID Description Default Units Min Max Step
Work_Light_
Timeout_ Enable
640
This signal is a parameter that can be
adjusted to vary the amount of time that the
work light will remain on after the IGN key is
turned off. If this value is set to 6, the work
light will remain on for 60 minutes after the
IGN key is turned off.
120 Min 10 1440 10
Work_Light_
Lo_Current
1898
Work Light Low Current Detection Level
(Amps)
0 A 0 10 0.1
Work_Light_
Hi_Current
1899
Work Light High Current Detection Level
(Amps)
10 A 0 10 0.1
Work_Light_
OC_Current
1900
Work Light Open Circuit Detection Level
(Amps)
0 A 0 10 0.1
Load_Shed_
Level _Work_
Light
2327 Level at which GEN2 work light is shed 1 List 0 3 1
Work_Light_Off_
Speed
2568
Speed at which the Work Light
will be turned off
90 Mph 1 90 2
Connector Part # Lock Part # Term Part # Seal Part #
1661778C1 1661874C1 1661875C1 1661872C1
Connector Cavity Circuit Number Circuit Description
A N65 Work Light Feed
B N65-G Work Light GND
SECTION 14 - PAGE 4 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
WORK LIGHT AND OUTSIDE CAB POWER
FEATURES
Arrow Indicates Location of Work Light Connector (Straight Truck)
f_062
Arrow Indicates Location of Work Light (Tractor)
f_063
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 14 - PAGE 5
WORK LIGHT AND OUTSIDE CAB POWER
FEATURES
TESTING
1. Activate work light switch.
2. Verify that pin G (labeled Work_Light) on the Body Controller (BC) connector (#1603) is providing battery
voltage.
3. Verify that the work light (or alternate load) is functioning properly.
4. Turn work light switch OFF.
5. Verify that the work light output goes OFF.
HOW TO ADD THIS FEATURE
For 08WLL, the software feature code 595ABR must be enabled on the vehicle using the Diamond Logic
Builder software (see local dealer).
For 08WMA, the software feature codes 595ABR or 595AMU (dependent on switch location) and 595AJE
must be enabled on the vehicle using the Diamond Logic
Builder software (see local dealer).
Set the desired programmable parameters for each signal using the Diamond Logic
Builder software to add the following software feature: 595AJH BC Prog, SWITCH
AUXILIARY In Center Panel, With 40 AMP Fuse Circuit, Accessory-Controlled.
Also refer to the Center Panel tab in the Diamond Logic
Builder software.
SECTION 14 - PAGE 12 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
WORK LIGHT AND OUTSIDE CAB POWER
FEATURES
Electrical Data Body Builder Book September 2012 SECTION 15 - PAGE 1
AIR CONDITIONING
AIR CONDITIONING
AIR CONDITIONING
Refer to the circuit diagram in S08322, Chapter 12, Air Conditioning.
16WKB
Air Conditioner (International
Builder software.
REQUIRED SOFTWARE FEATURE CODE
595AZR
CONFLICTS WITH SOFTWARE FEATURE
595ABC
There are no programmable parameters associated with this feature.
SECTION 15 - PAGE 4 September 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
AIR CONDITIONING
WIRING INFORMATION
See the graphic below. Install the circuits, as illustrated, if they were not factory installed.
TESTING
1. With Park Brake released, Air Conditioning Demand on and compressor running, accelerate from a stop.
The Compressor (s) should be shut off, upon initial acceleration is completed.
2. The Compressor (s) should be shut off, upon initial acceleration is completed.
f_052
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 16 - PAGE 1
TRANSMISSION SPARE INPUTS/OUTPUTS
AND TRANSMISSION CODES
TRANSMISSION SPARE INPUTS/OUTPUTS AND TRANSMISSION CODES
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION INTERFACES
13AHE
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 1000_HS} 4th Generation Controls; Close Ratio, 5-Speed, With
Overdrive; Less PTO Provision, Includes Park Pawl, Less Retarder, With 19,500-lb GVW & 26,000-lb GCW
Max
13AHK
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 1000_PTS} 4th Generation Controls; Close Ratio, 5-Speed, With
Overdrive; Less PTO Provision, Includes Park Pawl, Less Retarder, With 19,500-lb GVW & 26,000-lb GCW
Max
13AKX
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 1000_RDS} 4th Generation Controls; Close Ratio, 5-Speed, With
Overdrive; Includes Park Pawl, With PTO Provision, Less Retarder, With 19,500-lb GVW & 26,000-lb GCW
Max.
13AKY
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 1000_EVS} 4th Generation Controls; Close Ratio, 5-Speed, With
Overdrive; Includes Park Pawl, With PTO Provision, Less Retarder, With 19,500-lb GVW & 26,000-lb GCW
Max.
13AHG
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 2100_HS} 4th Generation Controls; Close Ratio, 5-Speed, With
Overdrive; Less PTO Provision, Less Retarder, With 26,000-lb GVW & GCW Max.
13AHJ
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 2500_HS} 4th Generation Controls; Wide Ratio, 5-Speed, With
Overdrive; Less PTO Provision, Less Retarder, With 33,000-lb GVW & GCW Max.
13AHL
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 2100_PTS} 4th Generation Controls; Close Ratio, 5-Speed, With
Overdrive; Less PTO Provision, Less Retarder, With 26,000-lb GVW & GCW Max.
13AHN
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 2500_PTS} 4th Generation Controls; Wide Ratio, 5-Speed, With
Overdrive; Less PTO Provision, Less Retarder, With 33,000-lb GVW & GCW Max.
13AHP
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 2100_RDS_P} 4th Generation Controls; Close Ratio, 5-Speed, With
Overdrive; With PTO Provision, Less Retarder, With 26,000-lb GVW & GCW Max.
13AHS
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 2500_RDS_P} 4th Generation Controls; Wide Ratio, 5-Speed, With
Overdrive; On/Off Hwy; 33,000 lb GVW & GCW Max., With PTO Provision, Less Retarder
SECTION 16 - PAGE 2 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
TRANSMISSION SPARE INPUTS/OUTPUTS
AND TRANSMISSION CODES
13AHT
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 2500_RDS_P} 4th Generation Controls; Wide Ratio, 5-Speed, With
Overdrive; Refuse; With PTO Provision, Less Retarder, With 24,200-lb GVW Max.
13AHU
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 2100_EVS_P} 4th Generation Controls; Close Ratio, 5-Speed, With
Overdrive; With PTO Provision, Less Retarder, With 26,000-lb GVW & GCW Max.
13AHW
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 2500_EVS_P} 4th Generation Controls; Wide Ratio, 5-Speed, With
Overdrive; With PTO Provision, Less Retarder, With 33,000-lb GVW & GCW Max.
13AHY
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 2500_MH} 4th Generation Controls; Wide Ratio, 5-Speed, With
Overdrive, Less PTO Provision, Less Retarder, With 33,000-lb GVW & GCW Max.
13ALN
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 2500_SP} 4th Generation Controls; Wide Ratio, 5-Speed, With
Overdrive; Less PTO Provision, Less Retarder, With 33,000-lb GVW & GCW Max.
13AHH
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 2200_HS} 4th Generation Controls; Close Ratio, 5-Speed, With
Overdrive; Includes Park Pawl, Less PTO Provision, Less Retarder, With 26,000-lb GVW & GCW Max.
13AHM
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 2200_PTS} 4th Generation Controls; Close Ratio, 5-Speed, With
Overdrive; Includes Park Pawl, Less PTO Provision, Less Retarder, With 26,000-lb GVW & GCW Max.
13AHR
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 2200_RDS_P} 4th Generation Controls; Close Ratio, 5-Speed, With
Overdrive; Includes Park Pawl, With PTO Provision, Less Retarder, With 26,000-lb GVW & GCW Max.
13AHV
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 2200_EVS_P} 4th Generation Controls; Close Ratio, 5-Speed, With
Overdrive; Includes Park Pawl, With PTO Provision, Less Retarder, With 26,000-lb GVW & GCW Max.
13ALG
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 2200_SP} 4th Generation Controls; Close Ratio, 5-Speed, With
Overdrive; Includes Park Pawl, With PTO Provision, Less Retarder, With 26,000-lb GVW & GCW Max. Military
use only.
13AHZ
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 3000_HS} 4th Generation Controls; Close Ratio, 5-Speed, With
Overdrive; Includes Oil Level Sensor, Less PTO Provision, Less Retarder, With 80,000-lb GVW & GCW Max.
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 16 - PAGE 3
TRANSMISSION SPARE INPUTS/OUTPUTS
AND TRANSMISSION CODES
13AJA
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 3000_HS} 4th Generation Controls; Close Ratio, 6-Speed, With
Double Overdrive; Includes Oil Level Sensor, Less PTO Provision, Less Retarder, With 80,000-lb GVW & GCW
Max.
13AJB
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 3000_PTS} 4th Generation Controls; Close Ratio, 5-Speed, With
Overdrive, Includes Oil Level Sensor, Less PTO Provision, Less Retarder, School Max. Bus GVW N/A
SCHOOL BUS
13AJC
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 3000_PTS} 4th Generation Controls; Close Ratio, 5-Speed, With
Overdrive; Includes Oil Level Sensor, Less PTO Provision, Less Retarder, Shuttle Bus, With 33,000 lb GVW &
GCW Max.
13AJE
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 3000_RDS_P} 4th Generation Controls; Close Ratio, 5-Speed, With
Overdrive; On/Off Hwy; Includes Oil Level Sensor, With PTO Provision, Less Retarder, With 80,000-lb GVW &
GCW Max.
13AJG
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 3000_RDS_P} 4th Generation Controls; Close Ratio, 5-Speed, With
Overdrive; Refuse/Mixer; Includes Oil Level Sensor, With PTO Provision, Less Retarder, With 62,000-lb GVW
13AJH
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 3000_RDS_P} 4th Generation Controls; Close Ratio, 6-Speed, With
Double Overdrive; On/Off Hwy; Includes Oil Level Sensor, With PTO Provision, Less Retarder, With 80,000-lb
GVW
13AJJ
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 3000_RDS_P} 4th Generation Controls; Close Ratio, 6-Speed, With
Double Overdrive; Refuse/Mixer; Includes Oil Level Sensor With PTO Provision, Less Retarder, With 62,000-lb
GVW Max.
13AJK
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 3500_RDS_P} 4th Generation Controls; Wide Ratio, 5-Speed, With
Overdrive; On/Off Hwy; Includes Oil Level Sensor, With PTO Provision, Less Retarder, With 80,000-lb GVW &
GCW Max.
13AJL
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 3500_RDS_P} 4th Generation Controls; Wide Ratio, 5-Speed, With
Overdrive; Refuse/Mixer; Includes Oil Level Sensor, With PTO Provision, Less Retarder, With 60,000-lb GVW
13AJM
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 3500_RDS_P} 4th Generation Controls; Wide Ratio, 5-Speed, With
Overdrive; Specialty PTO; Includes Oil Level Sensor, With PTO Provision, Less Retarder, MAX. GVW N/A
SECTION 16 - PAGE 4 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
TRANSMISSION SPARE INPUTS/OUTPUTS
AND TRANSMISSION CODES
13AJN
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 3500_RDS_P} 4th Generation Controls; Wide Ratio, 6-Speed, With
Double Overdrive; On/Off Hwy; Includes Oil Level Sensor, With PTO Provision, Less Retarder, With 80,000-lb
GVW & GCW Max.
13AJP
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 3500_RDS_P} 4th Generation Control; Wide Ratio, 6-Speed, With
Double Overdrive; Refuse/Mixer; Includes Oil Level Sensor, With PTO Provision, Less Retarder, With 60,000-lb
GVW Max.
13AJR
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON B-300} 4th Generation Controls; 5-Speed; With Overdrive, Includes
Oil Level Sensor, With Deep Sump, Less PTO Provision and Less Retarder, With 38,000-lb GVW Max.
13AJU
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 3000EVS_P} 4th Generation Controls; Close Ratio, 6-Speed; With
Double Overdrive, Includes Oil Level Sensor, With Provision for PTO, Less Retarder, Max. GVW N/A
13AJV
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 3000EVS_P} 4th Generation Controls; Close Ratio, 5-Speed; With
Overdrive, Includes Oil Level Sensor, With Provision for PTO, Less Retarder, Max. GVW N/A
13AJW
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 3500EVS_P} 4th Generation Controls; Wide Ratio, 6-Speed; With
Double Overdrive, Includes Oil Level Sensor, With Provision for PTO, Less Retarder, Max. GVW N/A
13AJX
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 3500EVS_P} 4th Generation Controls; Wide Ratio, 5-Speed; With
Overdrive, Includes Oil Level Sensor, With Provision for PTO, Less Retarder, Max. GVW N/A
13AKA
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 3000TRV_P} 4th Generation Controls; Close Ratio, 6-Speed; With
Double Overdrive, Includes Oil Level Sensor, With Provision for PTO Gear, Less Retarder, Max. GVW N/A with
40,000-lb
13AKB
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 3000TRV_P} 4th Generation Controls; Close Ratio, 5-Speed; With
Overdrive, Includes Oil Level Sensor, With Provision for PTO Gear, Less Retarder, Max. GVW N/A with
40,000-lb GCW
13AKG
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 4000_HS} 4th Generation Controls; Close Ratio, 5-Speed, With
Overdrive, Includes Oil Level Sensor, Less PTO Provision, Less Retarder
13AKH
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 4000_HS} 4th Generation Controls; Close Ratio, 6-Speed, With
Double Overdrive, Includes Oil Level Sensor, Less PTO Provision, Less Retarder
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 16 - PAGE 5
TRANSMISSION SPARE INPUTS/OUTPUTS
AND TRANSMISSION CODES
13AKJ
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 4500_HS} 4th Generation Controls; Wide Ratio, 5-Speed, With
Overdrive; Includes Oil Level Sensor, Less PTO Provision, Less Retarder
13AKK
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 4500_HS} 4th Generation Controls; Wide Ratio, 6-Speed, With
Double Overdrive; Includes Oil Level Sensor, Less PTO Provision, Less Retarder
13AKL
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 4000_RDS_P} 4th Generation Controls; Close Ratio, 5-Speed, With
Overdrive; Includes Oil Level Sensor, With PTO Provision, Less Retarder
13AKM
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 4000_RDS_P} 4th Generation Controls; Close Ratio, 6-Speed, With
Double Overdrive; Includes Oil Level Sensor, With PTO Provision, Less Retarder
13AKN
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 4500_RDS_P} 4th Generation Controls; Wide Ratio, 5-Speed, With
Overdrive; Includes Oil Level Sensor, With PTO Provision, Less Retarde
13AKP
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 4500_RDS_P} 4th Generation Controls; Wide Ratio, 6-Speed, With
Double Overdrive; Includes Oil Level Sensor, With PTO Provision, Less Retarder
13AKR
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 4000EVS_P} 4th Generation Controls, Close Ratio, 5-Speed; With
Overdrive, Includes Oil Level Sensor, With Provision for PTO, Less Retarder
13AKS
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 4000EVS_P} 4th Generation Controls; Close Ratio, 6-Speed; With
Double Overdrive; Includes Oil Level Sensor, With Provision for PTO, Less Retarder
13AKT
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 4500EVS_P} 4th Generation Controls; Wide Ratio, 5-Speed; With
Overdrive; Includes Oil Level Sensor, With Provision for PTO, Less Retarder
13AKU
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 4500EVS_P} 4th Generation Controls; Wide Ratio, 6-Speed; With
Double Overdrive; Includes Oil Level Sensor, With Provision for PTO, Less Retarder
13ALH
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 3000_SP_P} 4th Generation Controls; Close Ratio, 5-Speed,
Overdrive; Includes Oil Level Sensor, With PTO Provision, Less Retarder, Military Support/Tactical MILITARY
ONLY
SECTION 16 - PAGE 6 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
TRANSMISSION SPARE INPUTS/OUTPUTS
AND TRANSMISSION CODES
13ALJ
TRANSMISSION, AUTOMATIC {ALLISON 4500_SP_P} 4th Generation Controls; Wide Ratio, 5-Speed, With
Overdrive; Includes Oil Level Sensor, With PTO Provision, Less Retarder, Military Support/Tactical
13WDH
WIRING, TRANS BODY BUILDER Installed Wiring for Transmission/PTO Controls, for Allison 2000, 2100,
2200, 2400, 2500 Series Transmission Only
13WUA
ALLISON NEUTRAL Allison WT Transmission Shifts to Neutral When Parking Brake is Engaged and Remains
on Neutral When Park Brake is Disengaged
13WUB
ALLISON SPARE INPUT/OUTPUT for Highway Series (HS); General Purpose Trucks
13WUC
ALLISON SPARE INPUT/OUTPUT for Rugged Duty Series (RDS); General Purpose Trucks, Construction
13WUD
ALLISON SPARE INPUT/OUTPUT for Emergency Vehicle Series (EVS); Rescue, Ambulance
13WUE
ALLISON SPARE INPUT/OUTPUT for Emergency Vehicle Series (EVS); Fire/Pumper, Tank, Aerial/Ladder
13WUG
ALLISON SPARE INPUT/OUTPUT for Truck Recreational Vehicle (TRV)
13WUH
ALLISON SPARE INPUT/OUTPUT for Rugged Duty Series (RDS); Airport Refueler, Sewer Evac
13WUJ
ALLISON SPARE INPUT/OUTPUT for Rugged Duty Series (RDS); Front Loaders, Rear Loaders,
Recycling/Packer Trucks
13WUK
ALLISON SPARE INPUT/OUTPUT for Rugged Duty Series (RDS); Side Loaders
13WUL
ALLISON SPARE INPUT/OUTPUT for Rugged Duty Series (RDS); Street Sweeper
13WUM
ALLISON SPARE INPUT/OUTPUT for Pupil Transportation Series (PTS)
13WUP
ALLISON SPARE INPUT/OUTPUT for Bus Series (B)
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 16 - PAGE 7
TRANSMISSION SPARE INPUTS/OUTPUTS
AND TRANSMISSION CODES
13WUR
ALLISON SPARE INPUT/OUTPUT for Dump/Construction with Two-Speed Axle or Auxiliary Transmission
(RDS)
13WUS
ALLISON SPARE INPUT/OUTPUT for Rugged Duty Series (RDS); General Purpose Trucks Modified for Single
Input Auto Neutral
13WUT
ALLISON SPARE INPUT/OUTPUT for Emergency Vehicle Series (EVS); Without Split Shaft PTO
13WUU
ALLISON SPARE INPUT/OUTPUT for Specialty Transmission Series (SP)
13WUV
ALLISON SPARE INPUT/OUTPUT for Highway Series (HS); General Purpose Trucks Modified for Single Input
Auto Neutral
13WUZ
ALLISON SPARE INPUT/OUTPUT for Emergency Vehicle Series (EVS), 127/198 includes J1939 Based Auto
Neutral; Fire/Pumper, Tank, Aerial/Ladder
13WVB
ALLISON SPARE INPUT/OUTPUT for Emergency Vehicle Series (EVS), 108/174 Includes J1939 Based Auto
Neutral; Rescue, Ambulance
The features listed above describe both Allison transmission sales features as well as Allison vocational
electrical interface sales features. Review each entry carefully, and choose the transmission and optional
electrical interface feature that is right for the particular equipment application. Allison electrical interface
connections are optional equipment on International
harness
connectors. For a complete circuit diagram of the transmission wiring and for connector and terminal part
numbers, see Circuit Diagram Manual S08322, Chapter 11, Transmission.
Table 63
*milliAmpere
NOTE: See Allison technical manual for suggested circuit design.
NOTE: See special features table below for package content.
NOTE: MUST COMPLY WITH FMVSS STANDARD #102.
The Allison 1000/2000 series has a single connector 7205. Connector 7205 has its mating connector
attached and filled with cavity plugs. The interface connections are located in between the radiator pipe and the
engine on the driver side of the engine.
Cavity Circuit Number I/O Maximum Current
Connector Number 7205
A K92B103 -- --
B K92#161 Input --
C K92#157 Input --
D K92#124 Output 500 mAMP*
E K92#122 Input --
F K92#105 Output --
G K92#164 Output 500 mAMP
H K92#162 Input --
Connector Number 7206
A K92#101 Input --
B K92#117 Input --
C K92C103 -- --
D K92#143 Input --
E K92#142 Input --
F K92#145 Output 500 mAMP
G K92#130 Output 500 mAMP
H K92#123 Input --
f_069
SECTION 16 - PAGE 10 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
TRANSMISSION SPARE INPUTS/OUTPUTS
AND TRANSMISSION CODES
To use connector, remove cavity plugs and use the following:
Table 64
The circuit numbers on the harness correspond to the circuit numbers used by Allison. The table below gives
the Allison 1000/2000 circuit number which corresponds to the circuit numbers in the International
harness
connectors. For a complete circuit diagram of the transmission wiring and for connector and terminal part
numbers, see Circuit Diagram Manual S08322, Chapter 11, Transmission.
Table 65
*milliAmpere
NOTE: See Allison technical manual for suggested circuit design.
NOTE: See special features table below for package content.
NOTE: MUST COMPLY WITH FMVSS STANDARD #102.
Connector Connector Lock Cavity Plug
3525874C1 3525875C1 2025431C1
Terminals Wire Gauge
1667742C1 16, 18, 20
Cable Seals Wire Gauge
1661872C1 16, 18, 20
Cavity Circuit Number I/O Maximum Current
Connector Number 7205
A L92C103 -- --
B L92#143 Input --
C L92#150 Output 500 mAMP*
D L47C125 Output --
E L92#101 Input --
F L92#123 Output --
G L92#145 Output 500 mAMP
H L92#105 Input --
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 16 - PAGE 11
TRANSMISSION SPARE INPUTS/OUTPUTS
AND TRANSMISSION CODES
The following tables show the various vocational feature codes that are available. Note the Group and Package
number correspond to Allison Group and Package number.
Table 65
NOTES for the tables below:
M = Mode Button Located on Shift Tower
# = Not Available with Code 13AAZ or 13WUA
@ = Requires Code 13AAZ, Automatic Neutral
% = Requires Code 13WUA, Automatic Neutral
* = Not Activate
Spare
Input/Output
Code 13WU#B 13WUC# 13WUD# 13WUE# 13WUG# 13WUH#
Group 98 99 108 107 110 102
Package Content Package 200 113 174 120 113 150
Other
Highway Series
(HS)
Rugged Duty
Series (RDS)
Emergency
Vehicle Series
(EVS)
Emergency
Vehicle Series
(EVS)
Truck Recreational
Vehicle (TRV)
Rugged Duty Series
(RDS)
Requirements
General Purpose
Trucks
General Purpose
Trucks,
Construction
Rescue,
Ambulance
Fire/Pumper, Tank,
Aerial/Ladder
Airport, Refueler,
Sewer Evac
Function # Function Name
I-A
Secondary Shift
Schedule
M M M M M M
I-C PTO Enable 143 143 142 143
I-D Shift Selection Transition 101*
I-E
Auxiliary Function Range
Inhibit (STD)
101* 101* 101*
I-F
Auxiliary Function Range
Inhibit (Special)
I-G Auxiliary Hold 142 142
I-H
Engine Brake &
Preselect Request
102/157 102/157 102/157 102/157 102/157 102/157
I-J Fire Truck Pump Mode 122/123*
I-L
Auto Neutral for PTO
(STD)
I-Q Two-Speed Axle Enable
I-W Direction Change Enable 122* 122* 122*
I-Y ABS Input 121 121 121 121 121 121
I-Z Retarder Enable 161 161 161 161 161 161
I-AA Service Brake Status 162 162 162 162 162 162
I-AG
Auto Neutral for Refuse
Packer & PTO Enable
I-AJ
4th Gear Lockup for
Pump Mode
122/123*
O-A Engine Brake Enable 104 104 104 104 104 104
O-B
Sump/Retarder
Temperature Indicator
164 164 164 164 164 164
O-C Range Indicator 145 145 113 145 (4th) 145 145 (4th)
O-D Output Speed Indicator A 105 105 105 105 105 105
O-G PTO Enable 130 130 130 130
O-J Two-Speed Axle Enable
O-I
Engine Overspeed
Indicator
130
O-O Service Indicator
O-Q Retarder Indicator 124 124 124 124 124 124
O-S Neutral Indicator for PTO 145
SECTION 16 - PAGE 12 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
TRANSMISSION SPARE INPUTS/OUTPUTS
AND TRANSMISSION CODES
Spare
Input/Output
Code 13WUJ@ 13WUK@ 13WUL# 13WUM# 13WUP#
Group 105 106 103 111 112
Package Content Package 142 170 167 203 1484
Other
Rugged Duty
Series (RDS)
Rugged Duty
Series (RDS)
Rugged Duty
Series (RDS)
Pupil
Transportation
Series (PTS)
Bus Series (B)
Requirements
Front Loaders,
Rear Loaders,
Recycling/Packer
Trucks
Side Loaders Street Sweeper School/Shuttle
Transit and Intercity
Bus
Function # Function Name
I-A
Secondary Shift
Schedule
M 142 M M
I-C PTO Enable 143 M 143
I-D Shift Selection Transition 101*
I-E
Auxiliary Function Range
Inhibit (STD)
101* 101*
I-F
Auxiliary Function Range
Inhibit (Special)
I-G Auxiliary Hold 142 142
I-H
Engine Brake &
Preselect Request
102/157 102/157 102/157 102/157
I-J Fire Truck Pump Mode
I-L
Auto Neutral for PTO
(STD)
117* 117* 117*
I-Q Two-Speed Axle Enable 101
I-W Direction Change Enable
I-Y ABS Input 121 121 121 121
I-Z Retarder Enable 161 161 161 161
I-AA Service Brake Status 162 162 162 162
I-AG
Auto Neutral for Refuse
Packer & PTO Enable
142/117
I-AJ
4th Gear Lockup for
Pump Mode
O-A Engine Brake Enable 104 104 104 104
O-B
Sump/Retarder
Temperature Indicator
164 164 164 164
O-C Range Indicator 113 145 145
O-D Output Speed Indicator A 105 105 105 105
O-G PTO Enable 130 130 130
O-J Two-Speed Axle Enable 145
O-I
Engine Overspeed
Indicator
O-O Service Indicator
O-Q Retarder Indicator 124 124 124 124
O-S Neutral Indicator for PTO 145 145
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 16 - PAGE 13
TRANSMISSION SPARE INPUTS/OUTPUTS
AND TRANSMISSION CODES
Spare
Input/Output
Code 13WUR# 13WUS% 13WUT# 13WUU# 13WUV%
Group 100 99 107 114 98
Package Content Package 146 113 mod 119 163 200
Other
Dump/Constructio
n with Two-Speed
Axle or Auxiliary
Transmission
(RDS)
Rugged Duty
Series (RDS)
Emergency
Vehicle Series
(EVS)
Specialty Series
(SP)
Highway Series (HS)
Requirements
General Purpose
Trucks Modified for
Single Input
Auto Neutral
Fire (not for
Split-Shaft PTO)r
Specialty Vehicles
General Purpose
Trucks Modified for
Single Input
Auto Neutral
Function # Function Name
I-A
Secondary Shift
Schedule
M M M M M
I-C PTO Enable 143 143 143 143
I-D Shift Selection Transition
I-E
Auxiliary Function Range
Inhibit (STD)
101* 101*
I-F
Auxiliary Function Range
Inhibit (Special)
101/142
I-G Auxiliary Hold 142 142
I-H
Engine Brake &
Preselect Request
102/157 102/157 102/157 102/157 102/157
I-J Fire Truck Pump Mode
I-L
Auto Neutral for PTO
(STD)
117
I-Q Two-Speed Axle Enable 142
I-W Direction Change Enable 122*
I-Y ABS Input 121 121 121 121 121
I-Z Retarder Enable 161 161 161 161 161
I-AA Service Brake Status 162 162 162 162 162
I-AG
Auto Neutral for Refuse
Packer & PTO Enable
I-AJ
4th Gear Lockup for
Pump Mode
O-A Engine Brake Enable 104 104 104 104 104
O-B
Sump/Retarder
Temperature Indicator
164 164 164 164 164
O-C Range Indicator 145 145 145
O-D Output Speed Indicator A 145 105 105 105 105
O-G PTO Enable 130 130 130 130
O-J Two-Speed Axle Enable 145
O-I
Engine Overspeed
Indicator
O-O Service Indicator 164
O-Q Retarder Indicator 124 124 124 124 124
O-S Neutral Indicator for PTO 145
SECTION 16 - PAGE 14 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
TRANSMISSION SPARE INPUTS/OUTPUTS
AND TRANSMISSION CODES
Spare
Input/Output
Code 13WUZ# 13WVB%
Group 127 108
Package Content Package 198 174
Other
Emergency
Vehicle Series
(EVS)
Emergency
Vehicle Series
(EVS)
Requirements
Fire/pumper, Tank,
Aerial/Ladder
Ambulance,
Rescue
Function # Function Name
I-A
Secondary Shift
Schedule
M M
I-C PTO Enable 142 143
I-D Shift Selection Transition 101
I-E
Auxiliary Function Range
Inhibit (STD)
I-F
Auxiliary Function Range
Inhibit (Special)
I-G Auxiliary Hold
I-H
Engine Brake &
Preselect Request
102/157 102/157
I-J Fire Truck Pump Mode 122/123
I-L
Auto Neutral for PTO
(STD)
I-Q Two-Speed Axle Enable
I-W Direction Change Enable
I-Y ABS Input 121 121
I-Z Retarder Enable 161 161
I-AA Service Brake Status 162 162
I-AG
Auto Neutral for Refuse
Packer & PTO Enable
I-AJ
4th Gear Lockup for
Pump Mode
O-A Engine Brake Enable 104 104
O-B
Sump/Retarder
Temperature Indicator
164 164
O-C Range Indicator 145 113
O-D Output Speed Indicator A 105 105
O-G PTO Enable 130 130
O-J Two-Speed Axle Enable
O-I
Engine Overspeed
Indicator
O-O Service Indicator
O-Q Retarder Indicator 124 124
O-S Neutral Indicator for PTO 145
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 17 - PAGE 1
GAUGES
GAUGES
This chapter describes the optional gauges that are either installed or can be installed in the instrument cluster.
If the vehicle was ordered without a desired gauge, one or more can be added in the field. Programming of the
Body Controller (BC) and proper placement is critical. Certain gauges will only work in certain locations. Before
adding the gauge to the vehicle, ensure that the vehicle can accept it. The outboard four gauges are the only
ones that can be moved or added. They can be added by using the Diamond Logic
dealer). The following instructions can be followed for any of the four auxiliary gauge positions.
ADDING AND PROGRAMMING THE VEHICLE
a. Using Diamond Logic
Builder, obtain a copy of the electronic vehicle file either by getting it from the
vehicle or from history.
b. Select the proper software feature code for the gauge to be added, and add this code to the configuration.
d. Position the gauge in the desired location in the cluster by clicking and dragging it to an open location
identified by a large blue circle. If the gauge will not move to a particular position, it is not designed to work
in that location.
d. Once the location of the gauge is determined, save the configuration and program the vehicle.
INSTALLING THE GAUGE
NOTE: Refer to the How Do I General Information section of this electrical guide for information on how to
obtain gauge, circuits, and sensor part numbers.
a. Remove the cluster shroud from the Instrument Panel (IP).
b. Remove the four screws which hold the cluster in place.
c. Tilt the cluster forward to gain access to the back of the cluster (use caution not to scratch the face of the
cluster).
d. Remove all the connectors from the back of the cluster, and remove the cluster from the vehicle.
e. Remove the ten screws from the metal panel on the back of the cluster.
f. Remove the proper filler plug. See below.
g. Install the gauge using caution not to move the needle, damage the face, or get the face of the gauge dirty.
h. Connect the jumper wire in the socket directly next to the added gauge.
i. Replace the metal panel, and install in the vehicle in the reverse order of removing it.
SECTION 17 - PAGE 2 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
GAUGES
WIRING INFORMATION
The standard cluster includes:
ODOMETER DISPLAY: Miles, Trip Miles, Engine Hours, Trip Hours, Fault Code Readout (Odometer, trip
odometer, and fault code readout electronic-liquid crystal display)
WARNING SYSTEM: Low Fuel, Low Oil Pressure, High Engine Coolant Temp, and Low Battery Voltage (Visual
and Audible)
GAUGE CLUSTER GAUGES (6): Engine Oil Pressure (Electronic), Water Temperature (Electronic), Fuel
(Electronic), Tachometer (Electronic), Voltmeter, Speedometer
GAUGE, AIR PRESSURE: Air 1 and Air 2 Gauges; Located in Instrument Cluster (Air Chassis only)
TESTING
Use the Diamond Logic
has developed a method of controlling loads on the vehicle, outside the cab, without running
individual wires from each switch to the load. This is accomplished by an electronic device called a Remote
Power Module (RPM). This module is used to distribute and control power to various devices on the vehicle
from switches inside the cab. The RPM is connected to the Body Controller (BC) via the Body Builder J1939
datalink (not the powertrain or ATA datalink). The only wires connected to the RPM are battery power (for
driving the loads), datalink cable (which includes power and Ground (GND) to operate the module), and a wire
for each vehicle device operated by the RPM.
REMOTE POWER MODULES (RPMS)
Refer to the Circuit Diagram Manual S08322, Chapter 10, Chassis Accessories, Remote Power Units, Solenoid
Packs, Remote Engine Speed Controller.
There are several combinations of RPM and switch types available. Listed below are the current configurations
and what types of switches are provided for them:
MOMENTARY SWITCH RPMS
08WSK
SWITCH, BODY CIRCUITS, REAR for Body Builder; With Six Momentary Switches in Instrument Panel (IP);
One Power Module, With Six Channels, 20 Ampere (AMP) per Channel and 80 AMP Max. Output, Switches
Control the Power Modules through Multiplex Wiring, Mounted at Rear on Frame
08WSM
SWITCH, BODY CIRCUITS, MID for Body Builder, With Six Momentary Switches in IP; One Power Module
with Six Channel, 20 AMP Max. per Channel and 80 AMP Max. Output, Switches Control the Power Module
through Multiplex Wiring, Mounted Battery Box, Back of Cab (BOC)
08SAJ
SWITCH, BODY CIRCUITS, MID for Body Builder; 12 Momentary Switches in IP, With Two Power Modules
with Six Channels, 20 AMP Max. per Channel, 80 AMP Max. Output, Switch Control Power Modules through
Multiplex Wiring, Mounted on Battery Box, BOC
08VZR
SWITCH, BODY CIRCUITS, MID for Bodybuilder, 6 Switches in Instrument Panel; One Power Module with 6
Channels, 20 Amp Max. Per Channel, 80 Amp Max Output, Switches Control Power Module Through Multiplex
Wiring, Mounted in Cab Behind Driver Seat
08VZS
SWITCH, BODY CIRCUITS, MID for Bodybuilder, 12 Switches in Instrument Panel; Two Power Modules with 6
Channels, 20 Amp Max. Per Channel, 80 Amp Max Output, Switches Control Power Module Through Multiplex
Wiring, Mounted in Cab Behind Driver Seat
NO SWITCHES PROVIDED RPMS
60AAM
BDY INTG, RPM AUX Mounted on the Drivers Side Frame Rail at Rear of Frame; Up to 6 Outputs and 6
Inputs, Max. 20 AMP per Channel, Max. 80 AMP Total
SECTION 18 - PAGE 2 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
REMOTE POWER MODULES
60AAN
BDY INTG, RPM AUX Mounted Back of Cab; Up to 6 Outputs and Inputs, Max. 20 AMP per Channel, Max. 80
AMP Total, (No switches included)
60AAL
BDY INTG, RPM {SPECIAL} Mounted Inside Cab behind Driver Seat; Max. 20 AMP per Channel, Max. 80 AMP
Total; Includes Three Modules with Hardware Only
LATCHED SWITCH RPMS
60AAA
BDY INTG, RPM Mounted Under Cab; Up to Six Outputs and Six Inputs, Max. 20 AMP per Channel, Max. 80
AMP Total (Includes One Switch Pack with Latched Switches) Mounted on Battery Box, BOC
60AAB
BDY INTG, RPM (2) Mounted Under Cab; Up to Six Outputs and Six Inputs Each, Max. 20 AMP per Channel,
Max. 80 AMP Total per Power Module (Includes Switch Packs with Latched Switches) Mounted on Battery Box,
BOC
08WTJ
SWITCH, BODY CIRCUITS, REAR for Body Builder with Six Switches in IP (2-position Latched Switches), One
Power Module With Six Channels, 20 AMP per Channel and 80 AMP Maximum Output, Switches Control the
Power Modules Through Multiplex Wiring, Mounted at the Rear of the Frame (ROF)
60AAD
BDY INTG, RPM (2) {SPECIAL} Mounted Under Cab or on Battery Box; Max. 20 AMP per Channel, Max. 80
AMP Total per Power Module; Includes One Module with Switch Pack Containing Six Latched Switches and
One Module with Hardware Only
60AAG
BDY INTG, RPM Mounted Inside Cab behind Driver Seat; Max. 20 AMP per Channel, Max. 80 AMP Total;
Includes One Module with Switch Pack Containing Latched Switches
60AAH
BDY INTG, RPM (2) Mounted Inside Cab behind Driver Seat; Max. 20 AMP per Channel, Max. 80 AMP Total;
Includes Two Modules with 2 Switch Packs Containing Latched Switches
60AAJ
BDY INTG, RPM (3) Mounted Inside Cab behind Driver Seat; Max. 20 AMP per Channel, Max. 80 AMP Total;
Includes Three Modules with 3 Switch Packs Containing Latched Switches
60AAK
BDY INTG, RPM (2) {SPECIAL} Mounted Inside Cab behind Driver Seat; Max. 20 AMP per Channel, Max. 80
AMP Total; Includes One Module with Switch Pack Containing Six Latched Switches and One Module with
Hardware Only
60AJL
BDY INTG, REMOTE POWER MODULE Mounted Inside Cab; Up to 6 Outputs & 6 Inputs, Max. 20 AMP per
Channel, Max. 80 AMP Total; (Includes 1 Switch Pack With Latched Switches)
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 18 - PAGE 3
REMOTE POWER MODULES
60AJM
BDY INTG, REMOTE POWER MODULE (2) Mounted Inside Cab; Up to 6 Outputs & 6 Inputs each, Max. 20
AMP per Channel, Max. 80 AMP Total; (Includes Switch Packs With Latched Switches)
FEATURE/BODY FUNCTION
On the DuraStar models, codes 08SAJ, 08WSM, 60AAA, AAD, AAN and 60AAB have the RPMs mounted at
the back of the battery box.
On the WorkStar models, codes 08SAJ, 08WSM, 60AAA, AAD, AAN and 60AAB have the RPMs mounted
under the cab, left rear.
On either the DuraStar or WorkStar models, codes 08WSK, 08WTJ or 60AAM have the RPMs mounted on
the drivers side frame rail at the ROF.
On the DuraStar or WorkStar models, codes 08VZR, 08VZS, 60AAG, 60AAH, 60AAJ, 60AAK, or 60AAL
have the RPMs mounted inside the cab, behind the drivers seat.
On the Workstar models, codes 60AJL and 60AJM have the PRMs mounted inside the cab, behind the
passengers seat. On the DuraStar, codes 60AJL and 60AJM are not available.
On WorkStar models code 60AAN is not compatible with 60AAB
Remote Power Module Internal Mounting Locations
f_071
SECTION 18 - PAGE 4 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
REMOTE POWER MODULES
Feature codes 08WSK, 08WSM, 08SAJ, 08VZR, 08VZS, and 08WTJ each add a 6-pack switch pack in a
one-to- one relationship to the RPM feature code.
60AAA and 60AAB add switches by filling in the first empty switch location. Once the first switch pack is full, a
second will be added filling in from the left to right of the switch pack.
Picture of Sample Mounting in Cab, behind Drivers Seat
f_072
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 18 - PAGE 5
REMOTE POWER MODULES
The table below summarizes the RPM locations and configurations by sales code and model:
Table 81
RPM
Code
# of RPMs
and
Addresses
Used
# of
Switches
Type of
Switches
Switch Configuration Model Location
08SAJ
2
(1, 2)
12 Momentary
Mounted in their own 6 Packs
or 12 Pack Switchpack
DuraStar Back of Battery Box
WorkStar Under Cab Left Rear
08WSK
1
(4) 6 Momentary
Mounted in their own 6 Pack
Switchpack
DuraStar &
WorkStar
Drivers side Rear of
Frame
08WSM
1
(1)
6 Momentary
Mounted in their own 6 Pack
Switchpack
DuraStar Back of Battery Box
WorkStar Under Cab Left Rear
08VZR
1
(1)
6 Momentary
Mounted in their own 6 Pack
Switchpack
DuraStar &
WorkStar
Inside the cab behind
the drivers seat
08VZS
2
(1, 2)
12 Momentary
Mounted in their own 6 Packs
or 12 Pack Switchpack
DuraStar &
WorkStar
Inside the cab behind
the drivers seat
08WTJ
1
(4)
6 Latched
Fills in the next blank switch
location after factory switches
DuraStar &
WorkStar
Drivers side Rear of
Frame
60AAA
1
(1)
6 Latched
Fills in the next blank switch
location after factory switches
DuraStar Back of Battery Box
WorkStar Under Cab Left Rear
60AAB
2
(1, 2)
12 Latched
Fills in the next blank switch
location after factory switches
DuraStar Back of Battery Box
WorkStar Under Cab Left Rear
60AAD
2
(1, 2
6 Latched
Fills in the next blank switch
location after factory switches
DuraStar Back of Battery Box
WorkStar Under Cab Left Rear
60AAG
1
(1)
6 Latched
Fills in the next blank switch
location after factory switches
DuraStar &
WorkStar
Inside the cab behind
the drivers seat
(Extended cab,
mounted outside of cab
60AAH
2
(1,2)
12 Latched
Fills in the next blank switch
location after factory switches
DuraStar &
WorkStarI
Inside the cab behind
the drivers seat
(Extended cab,
mounted outside of cab
60AAJ
3
(1, 2, 4)
18 Latched
Fills in the next blank switch
location after factory switches
DuraStar &
WorkStarI
Inside the cab behind
the drivers seat
(Extended cab,
mounted outside of cab
60AAK
2
(1,2)
6 Latched
Fills in the next blank switch
location after factory switches
DuraStar &
WorkStarI
Inside the cab behind
the drivers seat
(Extended cab,
mounted outside of cab
60AJL (Not
recom-
mended,
use 60AAG)
1 6 Latched
Fills in the next blank switch
location after factory switches
DuraStar Not available
WorkStar
Inside the cab behind
the drivers seat
60AJM
(Not recom-
mended,
use 60AAH)
2 12 Latched
Fills in the next blank switch
location after factory switches
DuraStar Not available
WorkStar
Inside the cab behind
the drivers seat
60AAL
3
(1, 2, 4)
0 None N/A
DuraStar &
WorkStar
Inside the cab behind
the drivers seat
(Extended cab,
mounted outside of cab)
60AAM
1
(5)
0 None N/A
DuraStar &
WorkStar
Drivers side Rear of
Frame
60AAN
1
(3)
0 None N/A WorkStar
Back of Cab (Not
compatible with 60AAB
on WorkStar)
SECTION 18 - PAGE 6 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
REMOTE POWER MODULES
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
08WSK: 595AHB
The PwrMod4_Fuse_Level1_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from Output #1 of RPM #4.
The PwrMod4_Fuse_Level2_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from Output #2 of RPM #4.
The PwrMod4_Fuse_Level3_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from Output #3 of RPM #4.
The PwrMod4_Fuse_Level4_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from Output #4 of RPM #4.
The PwrMod4_Fuse_Level5_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from Output #5 of RPM #4.
The PwrMod4_Fuse_Level6_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from Output #6 of RPM #4.
The PwrMod4_Init_State1_Param parameter determines the initial state of RPM #4, output #1. If the parameter
is set to 1, Output #1 of RPM #4 will be turned ON at ignition (IGN) key-on. If the parameter value is set to 0,
the output will be OFF at key-on.
The PwrMod4_Init_State2_Param parameter determines the initial state of RPM #4, output #2. If the parameter
is set to 1, Output #2 of RPM #4 will be turned ON at ignition (IGN) key-on. If the parameter value is set to 0,
the output will be OFF at key-on.
The PwrMod4_Init_State3_Param parameter determines the initial state of RPM #4, output #3. If the parameter
is set to 1, Output #3 of RPM #4 will be turned ON at ignition (IGN) key on. If the parameter value is set to 0, the
output will be OFF at key-on.
The PwrMod4_Init_State4_Param parameter determines the initial state of RPM #4, output #4. If the parameter
is set to 1, Output #4 of RPM #4 will be turned ON at ignition (IGN) key-on. If the parameter value is set to 0,
the output will be OFF at key-on.
The PwrMod4_Init_State5_Param parameter determines the initial state of RPM #4, output #5. If the parameter
is set to 1, Output #5 of RPM #4 will be turned ON at ignition (IGN) key-on. If the parameter value is set to 0,
the output will be OFF at key-on.
The PwrMod4_Init_State6_Param parameter determines the initial state of RPM #4, output #6. If the parameter
is set to 1, Output #6 of RPM #4 will be turned ON at ignition (IGN) key-on. If the parameter value is set to 0,
the output will be OFF at key-on.
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 18 - PAGE 7
REMOTE POWER MODULES
Table 82
08WSM & 08VZR: 595AHE
The PwrMod1_Fuse_Level1_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from Output #1 of RPM #1.
The PwrMod1_Fuse_Level2_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from Output #2 of RPM #1.
The PwrMod1_Fuse_Level3_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from Output #3 of RPM #1.
The PwrMod1_Fuse_Level4_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from Output #4 of RPM #1.
The PwrMod1_Fuse_Level5_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from Output #5 of RPM #1.
The PwrMod1_Fuse_Level6_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from Output #6 of RPM #1.
Parameter ID Description Default Units Min Max Step
PwrMod4_
Fuse_Level1_
Param
454
Current Limit in amps for
Output #1 of RPM #4
20 A 0 20 0.1
PwrMod4_
Fuse_ Level2_
Param
455
Current Limit in amps for
Output #2 of RPM #4
20 A 0 20 0.1
PwrMod4_
Fuse_ Level3_
Param
456
Current Limit in amps for
Output #3 of RPM #4
20 A 0 20 0.1
PwrMod4_
Fuse_Level4_
Param
457
Current Limit in amps for
Output #4 of RPM #4
20 A 0 20 0.1
PwrMod4_
Fuse_ Level5_
Param
458
Current Limit in amps for
Output #5 of RPM #4
20 A 0 20 0.1
PwrMod4_
Fuse_ Level6_
Param
459
Current Limit in amps for
Output #6 of RPM #4
20 A 0 20 0.1
PwrMod4_
Init_State1_
Param
460
If this parameter is set to 1,
Output #1 of RPM #4 will be
turned on at IGN key-on. If
set to 0, output will be off at
key-on.
OFF No_ Units N/A N/A N/A
PwrMod4_
Init_State2_
Param
461
If this parameter is set to 1,
Output #2 of RPM #4 will be
turned on at ignition key-on.
If set to 0, output will be off at
key-on.
OFF No_ Units N/A N/A N/A
PwrMod4_
Init_State3_
Param
462
If this parameter is set to 1,
Output #3 of RPM #4 will be
turned on at ignition key-on.
If set to 0, output will be off at
key-on.
OFF No_ Units N/A N/A N/A
PwrMod4_
Init_State4_
Param
463
If this parameter is set to 1,
Output #4 of RPM #4 will be
turned on at ignition key-on.
If set to 0, output will be off at
key-on.
OFF No_ Units N/A N/A N/A
PwrMod4_
Init_State5_
Param
464
If this parameter is set to 1,
Output #5 of RPM #4 will be
turned on at ignition key-on.
If set to 0, output will be off at
key-on.
OFF No_ Units N/A N/A N/A
PwrMod4_
Init_State6_
Param
465
If this parameter is set to 1,
Output #6 of RPM #4 will be
turned on at ignition key-on.
If set to 0, output will be off at
key-on
OFF No_ Units N/A N/A N/A
SECTION 18 - PAGE 8 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
REMOTE POWER MODULES
The PwrMod1_Init_State1_Param parameter determines the initial state of RPM #1, output #1. If the parameter
is set to 1, Output #1 of RPM #1 will be turned ON at ignition key-on. If the parameter value is set to 0, the
output will be OFF at key-on.
The PwrMod1_Init_State2_Param parameter determines the initial state of RPM #1, output #2. If the parameter
is set to 1, Output #2 of RPM #1 will be turned ON at IGN key-on. If the parameter value is set to 0, the output
will be OFF at key-on.
The PwrMod1_Init_State3_Param parameter determines the initial state of RPM #1, output #3. If the parameter
is set to 1, Output #3 of RPM #1 will be turned ON at IGN key-on. If the parameter value is set to 0, the output
will be OFF at key-on.
The PwrMod1_Init_State4_Param parameter determines the initial state of RPM #1, output #4. If the parameter
is set to 1, Output #4 of RPM #1 will be turned ON at IGN key-on. If the parameter value is set to 0, the output
will be OFF at key-on.
The PwrMod1_Init_State5_Param parameter determines the initial state of RPM #1, output #5. If the parameter
is set to 1, Output #5 of RPM #1 will be turned ON at IGN key-on. If the parameter value is set to 0, the output
will be OFF at key-on.
The PwrMod1_Init_State6_Param parameter determines the initial state of RPM #1, output #6. If the parameter
is set to 1, Output #6 of RPM #1 will be turned ON at IGN key-on. If the parameter value is set to 0, the output
will be OFF at key-on.
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 18 - PAGE 9
REMOTE POWER MODULES
Table 83
08SAJ & 08VZS: 595AHE and 595AHD
The PwrMod2_Fuse_Level1_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from Output #1 of RPM #2.
The PwrMod2_Fuse_Level2_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from Output #2 of RPM #2.
The PwrMod2_Fuse_Level3_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from Output #3 of RPM #2.
The PwrMod2_Fuse_Level4_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from Output #4 of RPM #2.
The PwrMod2_Fuse_Level5_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from Output #5 of RPM #2.
The PwrMod2_Fuse_Level6_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from Output #6 of RPM #2.
Parameter ID Description Default Units Min Max Step
PwrMod1_
Fuse_Level1_
Param
392
Current Limit in amps for
Output #1 of RPM #1
20 A 1 20 0.1
PwrMod1_
Fuse_ Level2_
Param
393
Current Limit in amps for
Output #2 of RPM #1
20 A 1 20 0.1
PwrMod1_
Fuse_ Level3_
Param
394
Current Limit in amps for
Output #3 of RPM #1
20 A 1 20 0.1
PwrMod1_
Fuse_Level4_
Param
395
Current Limit in amps for
Output #4 of RPM #1
20 A 1 20 0.1
PwrMod1_
Fuse_ Level5_
Param
396
Current Limit in amps for
Output #5 of RPM #1
20 A 1 20 0.1
PwrMod1_
Fuse_ Level6_
Param
397
Current Limit in amps for
Output #6 of RPM #1
20 A 1 20 0.1
PwrMod1_
Init_State1_
Param
398
If this parameter is set to 1,
Output #1 of RPM #1 will be
turned on at ignition key-on. If
set to 0, output will be off at
key-on.
OFF No_ Units N/A N/A N/A
PwrMod1_
Init_State2_
Param
399
If this parameter is set to 1,
Output #2 of RPM #1 will be
turned on at ignition key-on. If
set to 0, output will be off at
key-on.
OFF No_ Units N/A N/A N/A
PwrMod1_
Init_State3_
Param
400
If this parameter is set to 1,
Output #3 of RPM #1 will be
turned on at ignition key-on. If
set to 0, output will be off at
key-on.
OFF No_ Units N/A N/A N/A
PwrMod1_
Init_State4_
Param
401
If this parameter is set to 1,
Output #4 of RPM #1 will be
turned on at ignition key-on. If
set to 0, output will be off at
key-on.
OFF No_ Units N/A N/A N/A
PwrMod1_
Init_State5_
Param
402
If this parameter is set to 1,
Output #5 of RPM #1 will be
turned on at ignition key-on. If
set to 0, output will be off at
key-on.
OFF No_ Units N/A N/A N/A
PwrMod1_
Init_State6_
Param
403
If this parameter is set to 1,
Output #6 of RPM #1 will be
turned on at ignition key-on. If
set to 0, output will be off at
key-on.
OFF No_ Units N/A N/A N/A
SECTION 18 - PAGE 10 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
REMOTE POWER MODULES
The PwrMod2_Init_State1_Param parameter determines the initial state of RPM #2, output #1. If the parameter
is set to 1, Output #1 of RPM #2 will be turned ON at IGN key-on. If the parameter value is set to 0, the output
will be OFF at key-on.
The PwrMod2_Init_State2_Param parameter determines the initial state of RPM #2, output #2. If the parameter
is set to 1, Output #2 of RPM #2 will be turned ON at IGN key-on. If the parameter value is set to 0, the output
will be OFF at key-on.
The PwrMod2_Init_State3_Param parameter determines the initial state of RPM #2, output #3. If the parameter
is set to 1, Output #3 of RPM #2 will be turned ON at IGN key-on. If the parameter value is set to 0, the output
will be OFF at key-on.
The PwrMod2_Init_State4_Param parameter determines the initial state of RPM #2, output #4. If the parameter
is set to 1, Output #4 of RPM #2 will be turned ON at IGN key-on. If the parameter value is set to 0, the output
will be OFF at key-on.
The PwrMod2_Init_State5_Param parameter determines the initial state of RPM #2, output #5. If the parameter
is set to 1, Output #5 of RPM #2 will be turned ON at IGN key-on. If the parameter value is set to 0, the output
will be OFF at key-on.
The PwrMod2_Init_State6_Param parameter determines the initial state of RPM #2, output #6. If the parameter
is set to 1, Output #6 of RPM #2 will be turned ON at IGN key-on. If the parameter value is set to 0, the output
will be OFF at key-on.
The PwrMod1_Fuse_Level1_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from Output #1 of RPM #1.
The PwrMod1_Fuse_Level2_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from Output #2 of RPM #1.
The PwrMod1_Fuse_Level3_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from Output #3 of RPM #1.
The PwrMod1_Fuse_Level4_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from Output #4 of RPM #1.
The PwrMod1_Fuse_Level5_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from Output #5 of RPM #1.
The PwrMod1_Fuse_Level6_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from Output #6 of RPM #1.
The PwrMod1_Init_State1_Param parameter determines the initial state of RPM #1, output #1. If the parameter
is set to 1, Output #1 of RPM #1 will be turned ON at IGN key-on. If the parameter value is set to 0, the output
will be OFF at key-on.
The PwrMod1_Init_State2_Param parameter determines the initial state of RPM #1, output #2. If the parameter
is set to 1, Output #2 of RPM #1 will be turned ON at IGN key-on. If the parameter value is set to 0, the output
will be OFF at key-on.
The PwrMod1_Init_State3_Param parameter determines the initial state of RPM #1, output #3. If the parameter
is set to 1, Output #3 of RPM #1 will be turned ON at IGN key-on. If the parameter value is set to 0, the output
will be OFF at key-on.
The PwrMod1_Init_State4_Param parameter determines the initial state of RPM #1, output #4. If the parameter
is set to 1, Output #4 of RPM #1 will be turned ON at IGN key-on. If the parameter value is set to 0, the output
will be OFF at key-on.
The PwrMod1_Init_State5_Param parameter determines the initial state of RPM #1, output #5. If the parameter
is set to 1, Output #5 of RPM #1 will be turned ON at IGN key-on. If the parameter value is set to 0, the output
will be OFF at key-on.
The PwrMod1_Init_State6_Param parameter determines the initial state of RPM #1, output #6. If the parameter
is set to 1, Output #6 of RPM #1 will be turned ON at IGN key-on. If the parameter value is set to 0, the output
will be OFF at key-on.
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 18 - PAGE 11
REMOTE POWER MODULES
Table 84
Parameter ID Description Default Units Min Max Step
PwrMod2_
Fuse_Level1_
Param
35
Current Limit in amps for
Output #1 of RPM #2
20 A 1 20 0.1
PwrMod2_
Fuse_ Level2_
Param
36
Current Limit in amps for
Output #2 of RPM #2
20 A 1 20 0.1
PwrMod2_
Fuse_ Level3_
Param
37
Current Limit in amps for
Output #3 of RPM #2
20 A 1 20 0.1
PwrMod2_
Fuse_Level4_
Param
38
Current Limit in amps for
Output #4 of RPM #2
20 A 1 20 0.1
PwrMod2_
Fuse_ Level5_
Param
39
Current Limit in amps for
Output #5 of RPM #2
20 A 1 20 0.1
PwrMod2_
Fuse_ Level6_
Param
40
Current Limit in amps for
Output #6 of RPM #2
20 A 1 20 0.1
PwrMod2_
Init_State1_
Param
41
If this parameter is set to 1,
Output #1 of RPM #2 will be
turned on at IGN key-on. If set
to 0, output will be off at
key-on.
OFF No_ Units N/A N/A N/A
PwrMod2_
Init_State2_
Param
42
If this parameter is set to 1,
Output #2 of RPM #2 will be
turned on at IGN key-on. If set
to 0, output will be off at
key-on.
OFF No_ Units N/A N/A N/A
PwrMod2_
Init_State3_
Param
43
If this parameter is set to 1,
Output #3 of RPM #2 will be
turned on at IGN key-on. If set
to 0, output will be off at
key-on.
OFF No_ Units N/A N/A N/A
PwrMod2_
Init_State4_
Param
44
If this parameter is set to 1,
Output #4 of RPM #2 will be
turned on at IGN key-on. If set
to 0, output will be off at
key-on.
OFF No_ Units N/A N/A N/A
PwrMod2_
Init_State5_
Param
45
If this parameter is set to 1,
Output #5 of RPM #2 will be
turned on at IGN key-on. If set
to 0, output will be off at
key-on.
OFF No_ Units N/A N/A N/A
PwrMod2_
Init_State6_
Param
46
If this parameter is set to 1,
Output #5 of RPM #2 will be
turned on at IGN key-on. If set
to 0, output will be off at
key-on.
OFF No_ Units N/A N/A N/A
PwrMod1_
Fuse_Level1_
Param
392
Current Limit in amps for
Output #1 of RPM #1
20 A 1 20 0.1
PwrMod1_
Fuse_ Level2_
Param
393
Current Limit in amps for
Output #2 of RPM #1
20 A 1 20 0.1
PwrMod1_
Fuse_ Level3_
Param
394
Current Limit in amps for
Output #3 of RPM #1
20 A 1 20 0.1
PwrMod1_
Fuse_Level4_
Param
395
Current Limit in amps for
Output #4 of RPM #1
20 A 1 20 0.1
SECTION 18 - PAGE 12 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
REMOTE POWER MODULES
FEATURE BODY FUNCTION
60AAA provides one RPM where 60AAB provides two RPMs. Each RPM provides six load outputs for a
maximum of 20 AMPS per channel and a maximum of 80 total AMPS per module. Each RPM also provides six
inputs that can be either a 12 volt input or a GND active input signal.
60AAD provides two RPMs with only one 6-pack switch pack. This feature is specifically for customers that
wish to use advanced logic to control the outputs of these two RPMs through special customer-created
software.
60AAG provides one RPM, 60AAH provides two RPMs and 60AAJ provides three RPMs. Each RPM provides
six load outputs for a maximum of 20 AMPS per channel and a maximum of 80 total AMPS per module. Each
RPM also provides six inputs that can be either a 12 volt input or a GND active input signal.
60AAK provides two RPMs with one switch a 6-pack switch pack. 60AAL provides three RPMs. These features
are fir customers that wish to use advanced logic to control the outputs of the RPMs through special
customer-created software.
60AJL and 60AJM provide the same functionality as 60AAG and 60AAH respectively. It is recommended that
60AAG or 60AAH be used instead of 60AJL or 60AJM.
* There are other software features that can be ordered such as PTO features that will also use RPM outputs
and inputs. These features will take precedence over the RPM feature code switches and inputs/outputs. For
example, an order for a PTO feature that uses switch location one and RPM input/output one comes with the
PTO switch and five other switches that would control outputs two through six.
PwrMod1_
Fuse_ Level5_
Param
396
Current Limit in amps for
Output #5 of RPM #1
20 A 1 20 0.1
PwrMod1_
Fuse_ Level6_
Param
397
Current Limit in amps for
Output #6 of RPM #1
20 A 1 20 0.1
PwrMod1_
Init_State1_
Param
398
If this parameter is set to 1,
Output #1 of RPM #1 will be
turned on at IGN key-on. If set
to 0, output will be off at
key-on.
OFF No_ Units N/A N/A N/A
PwrMod1_
Init_State2_
Param
399
If this parameter is set to 1,
Output #2 of RPM #1 will be
turned on at IGN key-on. If set
to 0, output will be off at
key-on.
OFF No_ Units N/A N/A N/A
PwrMod1_
Init_State3_
Param
400
If this parameter is set to 1,
Output #3 of RPM #1 will be
turned on at IGN key-on. If set
to 0, output will be off at
key-on
OFF No_ Units N/A N/A N/A
PwrMod1_
Init_State4_
Param
401
If this parameter is set to 1,
Output #4 of RPM #1 will be
turned on at IGN key-on. If set
to 0, output will be off at
key-on.
OFF No_ Units N/A N/A N/A
PwrMod1_
Init_State5_
Param
402
If this parameter is set to 1,
Output #5 of RPM #1 will be
turned on at IGN key-on. If set
to 0, output will be off at
key-on.
OFF No_ Units N/A N/A N/A
PwrMod1_
Init_State6_
Param
403
If this parameter is set to 1,
Output #6 of RPM #1 will be
turned on at IGN key-on. If set
to 0, output will be off at
key-on.
OFF No_ Units N/A N/A N/A
Parameter ID Description Default Units Min Max Step
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 18 - PAGE 13
REMOTE POWER MODULES
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
Feature code 60AAA, 60AAB, 60AAD, 60AAG, 60AAH, 60AAJ, 60AAK, 60AAL, 60AJL or 60AJM are
configured by special unadvertised software feature codes. These codes are determined by the number of
additional features that use the RPM resources. The following codes should be added after all other features
are added to the vehicle.
60ACA = 595AJK This feature should be added if there are features already using five RPM inputs/outputs.
60ACB = 595AJL This feature should be added if there are features already using four RPM inputs/outputs.
60ACC = 595AJM This feature should be added if there are features already using three RPM inputs/outputs.
60ACD = 595AJN This feature should be added if there are features already using two RPM inputs/outputs.
60ACJ = 595AJP This feature should be added if there are features already using one RPM input/output.
60ACK = 595AJR This feature should be added if there no other features using any RPM inputs/outputs.
60ACV = 595AJS This feature should be added to add the second RPM (60AAB).
The following parameters may or may not show up in certain combinations based on which of the above
software feature codes are installed on the vehicle.
The TEM_Aux1_Output_Fuse_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from the output labeled
Aux_Switch_1_Output of RPM #1.
The TEM_Aux2_Output_Fuse_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from the output labeled
Aux_Switch_2_Output of RPM #1.
The TEM_Aux3_Output_Fuse_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from the output labeled
Aux_Switch_3_Output of RPM #1.
The TEM_Aux4_Output_Fuse_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from the output labeled
Aux_Switch_4_Output of RPM #1.
The TEM_Aux5_Output_Fuse_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from the output labeled
Aux_Switch_5_Output of RPM #1.
The TEM_Aux6_Output_Fuse_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from the output labeled
Aux_Switch_6_Output of RPM #1.
The TEM_Aux7_Output_Fuse_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from the output labeled
Aux_Switch_7_Output of RPM #1.
The TEM_Aux8_Output_Fuse_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from the output labeled
Aux_Switch_8_Output of RPM #1.
The TEM_Aux9_Output_Fuse_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from the output labeled
Aux_Switch_9_Output of RPM #1.
The TEM_Aux10_Output_Fuse_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from the output labeled
Aux_Switch_10_Output of RPM #1.
The TEM_Aux11_Output_Fuse_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from the output labeled
Aux_Switch_11_Output of RPM #1.
The TEM_Aux12_Output_Fuse_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from the output labeled
Aux_Switch_12_Output of RPM #1.
SECTION 18 - PAGE 14 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
REMOTE POWER MODULES
Table 85
FEATURE/BODY FUNCTION
08WTJ: 595AJG
Feature 08WTJ adds one RPM to the end of the frame to be used by itself or in combination with 60AAA (one
RPM BOC) or 60AAB (two RPMs BOC). The RPM will have six channels, 20 AMPS per channel, and 80 AMPS
maximum output. There will be six, 2-position, latched switches located in the IP that will control the RPM
through multiplex wiring.
Parameter ID Description Default Units Min Max Step
TEM_Aux1_
Output_Fuse_
Param
1990
This is the maximum current
Aux 1 output is allowed to
source before the virtual fusing
turns the output off.
20 Amps 0 20 0.1
TEM_Aux2_
Output_Fuse_
Param
1991
This is the maximum current
Aux 2 output is allowed to
source before the virtual fusing
turns the output off.
20 Amps 0 20 0.1
TEM_Aux3_
Output_Fuse_
Param
1992
This is the maximum current
Aux 3 output is allowed to
source before the virtual fusing
turns the output off.
20 Amps 0 20 0.1
TEM_Aux4_
Output_Fuse_
Param
1995
This is the maximum current
Aux 4 output is allowed to
source before the virtual fusing
turns the output off.
20 Amps 0 20 0.1
TEM_Aux5_
Output_Fuse_
Param
1999
This is the maximum current
Aux 5 output is allowed to
source before the virtual fusing
turns the output off.
20 Amps 0 20 0.1
TEM_Aux6_
Output_Fuse_
Param
2000
This is the maximum current
Aux 6 output is allowed to
source before the virtual fusing
turns the output off.
20 Amps 0 20 0.1
TEM_Aux7_
Output_Fuse_
Param
2100
This is the maximum current
Aux 7 output is allowed to
source before the virtual fusing
turns the output off.
20 Amps 0 20 0.1
TEM_Aux8_
Output_Fuse_
Param
2101
This is the maximum current
Aux 8 output is allowed to
source before the virtual fusing
turns the output off.
20 Amps 0 20 0.1
TEM_Aux9_
Output_Fuse_
Param
2102
This is the maximum current
Aux 9 output is allowed to
source before the virtual fusing
turns the output off.
20 Amps 0 20 0.1
TEM_Aux10_
Output_Fuse_
Param
2103
This is the maximum current
Aux 10 output is allowed to
source before the virtual fusing
turns the output off.
20 Amps 0 20 0.1
TEM_Aux11_
Output_Fuse_
Param
2104
This is the maximum current
Aux 11output is allowed to
source before the virtual fusing
turns the output off.
20 Amps 0 20 0.1
TEM_Aux12_
Output_Fuse_
Param
2105
This is the maximum current
Aux 12 output is allowed to
source before the virtual fusing
turns the output off.
20 Amps 0 20 0.1
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 18 - PAGE 15
REMOTE POWER MODULES
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
Required software feature code: 595AJG
Conflicts with Software features: 595AHB
The TEM_Aux13_Output_Fuse_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from the output labeled
RPM4_Output1 of RPM #1.
The TEM_Aux14_Output_Fuse_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from the output labeled
RPM4_Output2 of RPM #1.
The TEM_Aux15_Output_Fuse_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from the output labeled
RPM4_Output3 of RPM #1.
The TEM_Aux16_Output_Fuse_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from the output labeled
RPM4_Output4 of RPM #1.
The TEM_Aux17_Output_Fuse_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from the output labeled
RPM4_Output5 of RPM #1.
The TEM_Aux18_Output_Fuse_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from the output labeled
RPM4_Output6 of RPM #1.
Table 86
WIRING INFORMATION
Each module receives power from a 4-gauge cable, protected by a fusible link, connected to the battery stud of
the starter motor or the battery depending on the location of the RPM.
Parameter ID Description Default Units Min Max Step
TEM_Aux13_
Output_Fuse_
Param
2215
This is the maximum current
Aux 13 output is allowed to
source before the virtual fusing
turns the output off.
20 Amps 0 20 0.1
TEM_Aux14_
Output_Fuse_
Param
2216
This is the maximum current
Aux 14 output is allowed to
source before the virtual fusing
turns the output off.
20 Amps 0 20 0.1
TEM_Aux15_
Output_Fuse_
Param
2217
This is the maximum current
Aux 15 output is allowed to
source before the virtual fusing
turns the output off.
20 Amps 0 20 0.1
TEM_Aux16_
Output_Fuse_
Param
2218
This is the maximum current
Aux 16 output is allowed to
source before the virtual fusing
turns the output off.
20 Amps 0 20 0.1
TEM_Aux17_
Output_Fuse_
Param
2219
This is the maximum current
Aux 17 output is allowed to
source before the virtual fusing
turns the output off.
20 Amps 0 20 0.1
TEM_Aux18_
Output_Fuse_
Param
2220
This is the maximum current
Aux 18 output is allowed to
source before the virtual fusing
turns the output off.
20 Amps 0 20 0.1
SECTION 18 - PAGE 16 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
REMOTE POWER MODULES
Each generic RPM has the ability to operate up to six devices of 20 AMPS or less not to exceed 80 AMPS for
the entire module. Each RPM comes with a 6-pack of switches that is inserted into the center section of the IP.
Each generic switch controls one output of the RPM. The switch mapping is one-to-one with the RPM, i.e.
switch one controls output channel one on the RPM. The switch pack is connected to the switch data bus that
communicates switch operation to the BC, which communicates that operation to the RPM. The RPM also has
inputs on the module itself that can be programmed to control the outputs. This means that the RPM functions
like a 3-way lamp switch in a home. Each in-cab switch is a momentary rocker switch that is stable in the center
position. The upper section of each switch has an indicator light to provide the status of each power output
channel. Pressing the upper section of the switch will latch the respective power output channel on and
illuminate the indicator. Pressing the lower section of the switch will latch the power output channel off and turn
the indicator off. Likewise, the output channels may be controlled remotely by using a three-position momentary
single pole, double throw switch on each remote switch input. Applying battery volts to the remote switch input
will turn the output channel on. Applying GND to the remote switch input will turn the output channel off. The
lamp indicator on the IP switch will always display the current status of the output channel as long as the IGN
key is in the IGN or accessory position. Each RPM In-cab switch operates with the key in the IGN or accessory
position. The RPM remote input switches operate at any time. If a conflict exists between the switches, the off
state always wins.
A maximum of three RPMs may be connected to the vehicle from the factory which allows a total of 18 devices
to be controlled as long as the 80 AMPS per module is not exceeded. The modules can be relocated from their
mounting position as long as the datalink cable will reach its new mounting location without the datalink cable
being modified.
ADDRESSING RPMS
All RPMs require jumpers to tell the system controller what RPM it is controlling. Jumpers are to be installed in
a 23-way connector in location J3, shown in the figure below. No two RPMs can have the same address on a
vehicle.
Remote Power Module
f_073
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 18 - PAGE 17
REMOTE POWER MODULES
Switch Labeling: Switch packs provided with the RPM feature are general purpose un-labeled rocker
switches. Since the functions of the rocker switches are unknown at the time of vehicle assembly, un-labeled
rocker switches are provided so the Body Builder can customize the switches to any particular need. For switch
graphic information, see the Switches chapter in this electrical guide.
J3 23Way Connector
f_074
Instrument Panel Mounted Switch Pack
f_075
SECTION 18 - PAGE 18 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
REMOTE POWER MODULES
Example with RPM Output Controlled by Switch Inside Cab
f_076
Example with RPM Output Controlled by Switch Located on Chassis
f_077
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 18 - PAGE 19
REMOTE POWER MODULES
Table 87
Table 88
Pin Signal Name Signal Direction Rating (Amps)
Body Data Link
2 GND GND/Pass-Thru
3
Body Builder
J1939+
Datalink
4
Body Builder
J1939
Datalink
6 Battery Input/Pass-Thru 5
Body Datalink
2 GND GND/Pass-Thru
3
Body Builder
J1939+
Datalink
4
Body Builder
J1939
Datalink
6 Battery Input/Pass-Thru 5
Module Battery Feed
1 Supply Voltage Input 80
Fig_078 _
NOTE: Body datalink output is supplied with the mate to this
connector which is sealed and includes a 120 ohm terminating
resistor.
NOTE: No additional circuits can be added.
Pin Signal Name Signal Direction Rating (Amps)
Signal Connector
1 Module Select Common GND
2 Module Select #1 Digital Input 0.010
3 Module Select Common GND
4 Module Select #2 Digital Input 0.010
5 Module Select Common GND
6 Module Select #3 0.010
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18 Input #1 Switch Input 0.010
19 Input #2 Switch Input 0.010
20 Input #3 Switch Input 0.010
21 Input #4 Switch Input 0.010
22 Input #5 Switch Input 0.010
23 Input #6 Switch Input 0.010
Power Connector
A Output #1 Output 20
B Output #2 Output 20
C Output #3 Output 20
D Output #4 Output 20
E Output #5 Output 20
F
G
H Output #6 Output 20
SECTION 18 - PAGE 20 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
REMOTE POWER MODULES
NOTE: Refer to the Recommended Circuit Protection in the General section when selecting wire gauge and
fusing.
Table 89 Mating Connector Information
Table 90 Mating Connector Information
For Switch Product Graphic Label Kit part numbers, see the Switch chapter in this electrical guide.
Signal Connector 23 Way
Connector Plug
2005482C1 1688285C1
Terminal Cable Gauge
1698937C1 16, 18, 20
Power Connector 8 Way
Connector Lock
3548934C1 3548943C1
Terminal Cable Gauge
3535930C1 16, 18
3534163C1 12
3535931C1 14
Cable Seal Cable Gauge
3535936C1
3535937C1
3548945C1
Plug 2025431C1
f_079
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 18 - PAGE 21
REMOTE POWER MODULES
Here are some facts about the use of the RPM:
Each RPM provides six outputs. The loads on each output are protected by virtual fuses and are
programmable in 100mA (milliAmp) increments, 20 AMP max. per channel, 80 AMP max. per module.
A maximum of three RPMs per vehicle may be factory-installed, and a total of seven can be added after the
vehicle has been built.
Power is fed to the RPM through a fused link from the battery or starter lug (depending on the vehicle model)
that controls lights, mirrors, solenoids, fans, etc.
If higher current capacity is needed, the RPM can control a high current relay and still maintain logic and
diagnostic capability without having to wire to the inside of the cab.
The RPM outputs may be programmed to be on or off with each key-on cycle (assumes a momentary switch
is used in the cab).
There is an input connector for the Body Builder switches.
A 3-way output control may be achieved by using a single pole double throw switch with the RPM inputs. The
respective RPM output may be turned on by the in-cab switch and off by the remote switch, and vice versa.
The in-cab switch indicator displays the status of the RPM output.
The switch input actually goes to the BC so that the program rules can be checked. If all of the rules
checkout, the controller will activate the channel. If the preprogrammed logic rules for this circuit are not met,
the switch will flash until the desired condition is activated.
A 12 volt input will turn a channel on, and a GND input will turn the channel off.
If a latching switch is used by the TEM or Body Builder with the remote switch inputs, the channel cannot be
controlled by the in-cab switch.
RPMs have diagnostic capability.
As mentioned, the fusing current can be programmed. If that current is exceeded, the circuit will be fused
and the RPM will send that message to BC indicating which RPM and what output is over current.
The RPM has two 6-pin connectors.
The last module must have a 120ohm terminating resistor in the datalink connector.
All power, GND, and datalink signals are contained in these connectors.
The two identical connectors located on the power input side of the module are the datalink connectors. They
are pass-thru connectors that allow for the daisy chaining of modules. Only one connector plugs into the
chassis harness.
SECTION 18 - PAGE 22 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
REMOTE POWER MODULES
120ohm Datalink Termination Connector on RPM
f_080
RPM Connectors
f_081
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 18 - PAGE 23
REMOTE POWER MODULES
HOW TO ADD THIS FEATURE
Three RPMs can be added to a vehicle. The RPM kit 2594132C91 contains the RPM, datalink cables, three
foot power cable, 6-pack switch pack, LED indicators for the switches, and six latching switches. If momentary
switches are needed, order part number 3564004C1 in the quantity needed.
Table 91 RPM Kit Contents
This kit is for left-mounted battery box for DuraStar models and under cab for WorkStar models and inside the
cab, for both models. If truck has right-mounted battery box, add 3558936C91. If adding two RPMs, use jumper
harness 3558937C91 from first to second RPM and add 3558934C92 cable for the battery feed.
If RPM brackets are needed, the following part numbers will need to be ordered.
DuraStar models (one or two RPMs)
RPM bracket for inside the cab 3676154C4
Mounted inside the cab behind drivers seat
RPM bracket for second BOC RPM 3558794C1
Mounted under battery box
WorkStar models (one or two RPMs)
RPM bracket for inside the cab 3676154C4
Mounted inside the cab behind drivers seat
Day Cab 3582976C2, Crew/Extended Cab 3582983C2
Mounted under driver side of cab
3558794C1 Mounting Bracket
Attach the mounting bracket to the underside of the vehicle cab on WorkStar models (drivers side) and the
back of the battery box if a second RPM is mounted on a DuraStar series. See figures below.
Attach the RPM to the vehicle-mounting bracket, and securely tighten the fasteners.
Install dash harness and center chassis harness as per the following instructions. The schematic diagram is
provided for assistance in the installation.
Wrap the add-on harnesses to respective dash and center chassis harnesses with electrical tape or other
harness wrap after the installation. Ensure harnesses are routed away from sharp edges and properly clipped
for good wire harness support.
Part Description Quantity
2588909C92 KIT, REMOTE POWER MODULE W/JMPR 1
3804529P93 MM, IP, WRG, J1939 PRIVATE RPM 1
3558934C92 HARNESS, CHASSIS WIRING* SINGLE 1
3611349P93 HARN, CTR CHSS. RPU/RPTO BOC DAT 1
MIN10 FUSE 10A (3534209C1) 1
3519178C91 RESISTOR, ELECT TERMINATING 1
3549776C4 HOUSING, SWITCH*6-PACK DIN MULT 1
3578910C1 SWITCH, BLANK RCKR-2 POS BISTAB 6
3578733C1 LIGHT, IND, LED ON-GREEN, BRIGHT 6
3533928C1 LIGHT, IND, LED AMBER BKLGT 6
3552005C4 KIT, LIGHT* PRODUCT GRAPHIC FOR 1
2585423C91 KIT, RPM TERMINAL/SEAL 14GA 1
2585651C91 KIT, RPM TERMINAL/SEAL 12GA 1
2594135R1 MANUAL, INST RMT PWR MOD/BOC 1
SECTION 18 - PAGE 24 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
REMOTE POWER MODULES
INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS
In-Cab
1. Install A5EB (1939 +) {yellow} into the BC (1602) cavity F6
2. Install A5EB (1939 -) {green} into the BC (1602) cavity F5
5. Insert A20 {lt green} into the fuse panel (1017) cavity E3.
6. Insert a 10 AMP fuse in cavity F3-E3 in the fuse panel (1017).
Engine Compartment
1. Install A5E (1939 +) {yellow} into the IP center chassis (1701) cavity 52
2. Install A5E (1939 -) {green} into the IP center chassis (1701) cavity 53
3. Insert A20 {lt green} into the IP center chassis (1701) cavity 51
4. Install N10-GR {white} into splice pack (8809) cavity C
Install a terminating resistor in the open connector in the cab, and install a terminating resistor in the last
module in the datalink.
DuraStar Single RPM
f_082
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 18 - PAGE 25
REMOTE POWER MODULES
DuraStar with 2 RPMs
f_083
WorkStar Models Under Cab Mounting
f_084
Inside Cab RPMs are located behind the drivers seat on 4000 models.
SECTION 18 - PAGE 26 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
REMOTE POWER MODULES
f_085
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 18 - PAGE 27
REMOTE POWER MODULES
When more than one Remote Power Module (RPM) is installed, the Data Link wire harness must be
daisy-chained using the scheme diagrammed in the figure below. Connect the 6 pin Data Link Harness (J1939)
from the first RPM to either data link connector of the second. Continue connecting the data link jumper
DuraStar Models In Cab Mounting
f_086
f_087
SECTION 18 - PAGE 28 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
REMOTE POWER MODULES
harness of each RPM to the next until the final RPM is reached. The last RPM in the chain will have a
Terminating Resistor inserted into the last remaining open 6 pin data link connector of the remote power
module. Various lengths of data link jumper harnesses and extension harnesses are available from Navistar
Service Parts through any Navistar Dealer.
Connecting Multiple Remote Power Modules
f_089
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 18 - PAGE 29
REMOTE POWER MODULES
To install a switch in the switch pack housing, insert the switch in the proper slot and push in until the switch
locking tabs are fully engaged (switches are keyed and cannot be installed upside down).
Remove the rear cover of the switch pack. It is attached with a snap fit. See the attached pictures to determine
which end is up on the switch pack. Install the LED lamps with the white base (part number 3578733C1) in the
upper section of each switch on the switch pack housing. These are the indication of on lamps and will glow
green when activated. Note that the LED lamps have a keying feature as they are installed in the switch pack
circuit board. If the lamps are forced in against the proper orientation, they will not illuminate.
Install the LED lamps with the black base (part number 3533928C1) in the lower section of each switch on the
switch pack housing. These are the back light lamps and will glow amber when the panel lights are on.
Reattach the rear cover and secure the wire harnesses under the cover hooks.
Locate a free switch pack opening in the central IP.
If no switch packs are present in the vehicle, remove the switch blank below the radio space and locate the
6-pin cab harness for the switch packs. Connect the cab switch harness to the left side switch pack harness (as
viewed from the front). Connectors are keyed to ensure proper connection. Ensure that the switch pack is
installed in the proper orientation. The green indication of on lamps must be on top when viewing the front of
the switch pack.
If one 6-switch pack is already present, locate the new switch pack in the lower left switch pack area.
Installation of Switch Packs and LEDs
f_090
f_092
SECTION 18 - PAGE 30 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
REMOTE POWER MODULES
Connect the second harness of the first switch pack to the input cable harness of the second switch pack.
Install the second switch pack into center IP. It is secured with a snap action.
Determine the function of each of the newly added rocker switches. Locate the set of switch labels in the parts
kit. Place the labels named on in the upper section of each windowed rocker switch. Place the switch name in
the lower portion of the rocker switch.
If an additional switch pack is being installed, it is connected to the multiplex system by daisy chaining its
connectors to the existing switch pack (or to the cab harness if no switch pack is currently installed). It is
important to connect the switch packs in the correct order. Connecting the switch packs together and to the cab
harness in the wrong order will cause switch pack addressing problems.
f_093
f_094
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 18 - PAGE 31
REMOTE POWER MODULES
REMOVAL/REPLACEMENT OF SWITCHES AND SWITCH PACKS
To remove a switch pack from the panel use the DIN radio removal tool part number 2504954C1.
Insert the extraction tools (2) into the two holes on either side of a switch pack housing until the locking tabs are
fully depressed. The switch pack can then be removed from the panel and the extraction tools removed.
To remove individual switches or blanks from a switch pack, squeeze the locking tabs on the rear of the switch
or blank (top and bottom) and push it from the housing.
To install a switch pack in the panel, make the necessary connections then simply push the assembly into place
until the locking tabs are fully engaged.
NOTE: The switch pack can be inadvertently installed upside down. To avoid this when no switches are
present in the housing, make sure the white wire in the lead assemblies on the rear of the housing is towards
the top.
f_095
f_031
f_096
SECTION 18 - PAGE 32 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
REMOTE POWER MODULES
PROGRAMMING THE SYSTEM
The RPM and switch pack system is now installed.
The electrical system must now be programmed to recognize these new components.
With the Diamond Logic
Builder software program, enable the appropriate 595xxx software feature codes
from the beginning of this section.
The system may also be programmed at the nearest International
Builder software to determine pin and switch locations for RPM inputs and
outputs and to set programmable parameters (refer to pin and switch location section)
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
*Software feature codes can be added through the Diamond Logic
Builder software.
Required software feature code: 595AKA
Software features that must be removed: NONE
The TEM_Dual1_Output1_Fuse_Param is programmed to allow a specified amount of current to go to the
RPM output 1. If the current exceeds this specified amount, the virtual fusing shuts the output off.
The TEM_Dual1_Output2_Fuse_Param is programmed to allow a specified amount of current to go to the
RPM output 2. If the current exceeds this specified amount, the virtual fusing shuts the output off.
Table 101
WIRING INFORMATION
This feature requires the customer to supply the wiring that runs from the pins labeled
DUAL_OUTPUT_SWITCH_Output1 and DUAL_OUTPUT_SWITCH_Output2, on the brown 8-pin RPM output
connector, to the customer-installed feature that requires the load.
Parameter ID Description Default Units Min Max Set
TEM_Dual1_
Output1_
Fuse_Param
1988
This is the maximum current
Dual 1 Output 1 is allowed to
source before the virtual fusing
turns the output off.
20 A 0 20 0.1
TEM_Dual1_
Output2_
Fuse_Param
1989
This is the maximum current
Dual 1 Output 2 is allowed to
source before the virtual fusing
turns the output off.
20 A 0 20 0.1
SECTION 20 - PAGE 2 September 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
POWER FEATURES USING REMOTE POWER
MODULES
TESTING
1. Depress the switch.
2. Verify that the desired voltage is being pulled from the RPM outputs labeled
DUAL_OUTPUT_SWITCH_Output1 and DUAL_OUTPUT_SWITCH_Output2 (as programmed by the
Diamond Logic
Builder software).
HOW TO ADD THIS FEATURE
Software feature code 595AKA MUST be enabled using the Diamond Logic
Builder software to determine pin and switch locations for RPM inputs and
outputs and to set programmable parameters (refer to pin and switch location section).
f_105
Electrical Data Body Builder Book September 2012 SECTION 20 - PAGE 3
POWER FEATURES USING REMOTE POWER
MODULES
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
*Software feature codes can be added through the Diamond Logic
Builder software.
Required software feature code: 595AKB
Conflicts with Software features: NONE
* TEM_Aux1_Misc_Interlock_Param
This parameter (TEM_Aux1_Misc_Interlock_Param) is the master parameter for this feature. The setting for
this parameter selects the interlocking condition for the output. The following table indicates which interlocking
condition corresponds to which setting for the parameter. To select the interlocking condition simply set the
value of this parameter to the corresponding setting on the table.
Table 102
Setting Interlocking Condition
0 Apply no interlocks to this output
1 Activate this output when the park brake is set AND the switch is on
2 Activate this output when the park brake is not set AND the switch is on
3 Activate this output when a door is open AND the switch is on
4 Activate this output when all doors are closed AND the switch is on
5 Activate this output when the PTO is engaged AND the switch is on (Requires a PTO feature)
6 Activate this output when the PTO is not engaged AND the switch is on (Requires a PTO feature)
7 Activate this output when the engine is running AND the switch is on
8 Activate this output when the engine is not running AND the switch is on
9 Activate this output when the vehicle speed exceeds the value set in TEM_Aux_1_Speed_Interlock_Param AND the switch is on
10
Activate this output when the vehicle speed is less than the value set in TEM_Aux_1_Speed_Interlock_Param AND the switch is
on
11 Activate this output when the vehicle is stopped AND the switch is on
12 Activate this output when the vehicle is moving AND the switch is on
13
Activate this output when the transmission gear is higher than TEM_Aux1_Gear_Interlock_Param AND the switch is on (Requires
Automatic Transmission)
14
Activate this output when the transmission gear is lower than TEM_Aux1_Gear_Interlock_Param AND the switch is on (Requires
Automatic Transmission)
15 Activate this output when the transmission is in neutral AND the switch is on (Requires Automatic Transmission)
16 Activate this output when the transmission is not in neutral AND the switch is on (Requires Automatic Transmission)
SECTION 20 - PAGE 4 September 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
POWER FEATURES USING REMOTE POWER
MODULES
* TEM_Aux1_Interlock_Latches_Off
Normally, if the output is deactivated because the interlocking condition is not met, the output will re-activate as
soon as the interlocking condition is re-established as long as the switch is still on. If this behavior is not
desirable, the parameter TEM_Aux1_Interlock_Latches_Off parameter can be set. When it is set and the
output is deactivated because the interlocking condition is not met, the output will not reactivate when the
interlocking condition is re-established even if the switch is still on. To re-activate the output in this case, the
switch must be re-cycled (flipped off and then on again).
* TEM_Aux1_Speed_Interlock_Param
If TEM_Aux1_Misc_Interlock_Param is set to 9 or 10, the speed-interlock parameter
(TEM_Aux1_Speed_Interlock_Param) must also be set. This parameter must be set to the actual speed to use
in the condition selected by TEM_Aux1_Misc_Interlock_Param (default unit for this parameter is MPH). The
speed parameter is only used if TEM_Aux1_Misc_Interlock_Param is set to 9 or 10.
Example: If you want the output to only come on when the vehicle is traveling over 15 MPH, you would set
TEM_Aux1_Misc_Interlock_Param to 9 and set TEM_Aux1_Speed_Interlock_Param to 15 MPH.
* TEM_Aux1_Gear_Interlock_Param
If TEM_Aux1_Misc_Interlock_Param is set to 13 or 14 and the vehicle has an automatic transmission, the
gear-interlock parameter (TEM_Aux1_Gear_Interlock_Param) must also be set. This parameter must be set to
the transmission gear to use in the condition selected by TEM_Aux1_Misc_Interlock_Param. The transmission
gear is set as follows:
Drop Down List of Possible Parameters for TEM_Aux1_Misc_Interlock_Param
f_106
Electrical Data Body Builder Book September 2012 SECTION 20 - PAGE 5
POWER FEATURES USING REMOTE POWER
MODULES
Table 103
The transmission gear parameter is only used if TEM_Aux1_Misc_Interlock_Param is set to 13 or 14.
Example: For the output to only come on when the vehicle transmission is in a reverse gear, set
TEM_Aux1_Misc_Interlock_Param to 10 and TEM_Aux1_Gear_Interlock_Param to 125.
* TEM_Aux1_w_Ilocks_Output_Fuse
This parameter is the value at which the output will fuse (shut off). The allowable values are from 1 to 20
Amperes.
Table 104
WIRING INFORMATION
The wiring out of the pin labeled INTERLOCKED_SWITCH_AUX1_Output on the Brown 8-pin RPM output
connector is customer supplied.
Setting Transmission Gear
125 Transmission in Neutral
126 Transmission is in the 1st forward gear
127 Transmission is in the 2nd forward gear
128 Transmission is in the 3rd forward gear
125 + x Transmission is in the xth forward gear
124 Transmission is in the 1st reverse gear
123 Transmission is in the 2nd reverse gear
125 y Transmission is in the yth reverse gear
Parameter ID Description Default Units Min Max Set
TEM_Aux1_
Interlock_
Latches_Off
2006
If this is set, when the output is turned
off due to an interlock, it will remain off
until the switch is recycled.
Off On/Off
TEM_Aux1_
Speed_
Interlock_
Param
2007
The speed parameter for the TEM Aux
#1 with Interlocks feature.
30 Mph 0 100 1
TEM_Aux1_
Gear_
Interlock_
Param
2008
The transmission gear parameter for the
TEM Aux #1 with Interlocks feature (124
is reverse, 125 is neutral, 126 is 1st
gear, 127 is second gear etc.).
0 Number 0 250 1
TEM_Aux1_
w_Ilocks_
Output_Fuse
2009
Fuse parameter for the TEM Single
output with interlocks feature.
20 A 0 20 0.1
TEM_Aux1_
Misc_ Interlock_
Param
2033
Miscellaneous or control parameter
used for setting the interlock for the
auxiliary 1 with interlocks.
10 List
SECTION 20 - PAGE 6 September 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
POWER FEATURES USING REMOTE POWER
MODULES
TESTING
1. Depress switch.
2. Verify that the RPM output labeled INTERLOCKED_SWITCH_AUX1_Output is obtaining the desired
voltage (as programmed by the Diamond Logic
Builder software).
3. Verify the functionality of the 30 Mph interlock by violating the parameter and determine that the output
shuts off.
4. Test all other interlocks by violating the programmable parameters to see if the output shuts off.
HOW TO ADD THIS FEATURE
Software feature code 595AKB MUST be enabled using the Diamond Logic
Builder software to determine pin and switch locations for RPM inputs and
outputs and to set programmable parameters (refer to pin and switch location section)
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
*Software feature codes can be added through the Diamond Logic
Builder software.
Required software feature codes: 595AKB, 595AKC
Conflicts with Software features: NONE
* TEM_Aux1_Misc_Interlock_Param
This parameter (TEM_Aux1_Misc_Interlock_Param) is the master parameter for this feature. The setting for
this parameter selects the interlocking condition for the output. The following table indicates which interlocking
condition corresponds to which setting for the parameter. To select the interlocking condition simply set the
value of this parameter to the corresponding setting on the table.
SECTION 20 - PAGE 8 September 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
POWER FEATURES USING REMOTE POWER
MODULES
Table 105
Setting Interlocking Condition
0 Apply no interlocks to this output
1 Activate this output when the park brake is set AND the switch is on
2 Activate this output when the park brake is not set AND the switch is on
3 Activate this output when a door is open AND the switch is on
4 Activate this output when all doors are closed AND the switch is on
5 Activate this output when the PTO is engaged AND the switch is on (Requires a PTO feature)
6 Activate this output when the PTO is not engaged AND the switch is on (Requires a PTO feature)
7 Activate this output when the engine is running AND the switch is on
8 Activate this output when the engine is not running AND the switch is on
9
Activate this output when the vehicle speed exceeds the value set in
TEM_Aux_1_Speed_Interlock_Param AND the switch is on
10
Activate this output when the vehicle speed is less than the value set in
TEM_Aux_1_Speed_Interlock_Param AND the switch is on
11 Activate this output when the vehicle is stopped AND the switch is on
12 Activate this output when the vehicle is moving AND the switch is on
13
Activate this output when the transmission gear is higher than TEM_Aux1_Gear_Interlock_Param AND
the switch is on (Requires Automatic Transmission)
14
Activate this output when the transmission gear is lower than TEM_Aux1_Gear_Interlock_Param AND
the switch is on (Requires Automatic Transmission)
15
Activate this output when the transmission is in neutral AND the switch is on (Requires Automatic
Transmission)
16
Activate this output when the transmission is not in neutral AND the switch is on (Requires Automatic
Transmission)
Drop Down List of Possible Parameters for TEM_Aux1_Misc_Interlock_Param
f_106
Electrical Data Body Builder Book September 2012 SECTION 20 - PAGE 9
POWER FEATURES USING REMOTE POWER
MODULES
* TEM_Aux1_Interlock_Latches_Off
Normally, if the output is deactivated because the interlocking condition is not met, the output will re-activate as
soon as the interlocking condition is re-established as long as the switch is still on. If this behavior is not
desirable, the parameter TEM_Aux1_Interlock_Latches_Off parameter can be set. When it is set and the
output is deactivated because the interlocking condition is not met, the output will not reactivate when the
interlocking condition is re-established even if the switch is still on. To re-activate the output in this case, the
switch must be re-cycled (flipped off and then on again).
* TEM_Aux1_Speed_Interlock_Param
If TEM_Aux1_Misc_Interlock_Param is set to 9 or 10, the speed-interlock parameter
(TEM_Aux1_Speed_Interlock_Param) must also be set. This parameter must be set to the actual speed to use
in the condition selected by TEM_Aux1_Misc_Interlock_Param (default unit for this parameter is MPH). The
speed parameter is only used if TEM_Aux1_Misc_Interlock_Param is set to 9 or 10.
Example: For the output to only come on when the vehicle is traveling over 15 MPH, set
TEM_Aux1_Misc_Interlock_Param to 9 and set TEM_Aux1_Speed_Interlock_Param to 15 MPH.
* TEM_Aux1_Gear_Interlock_Param
If TEM_Aux1_Misc_Interlock_Param is set to 13 or 14 and the vehicle has an automatic transmission, the
gear-interlock parameter (TEM_Aux1_Gear_Interlock_Param) must also be set. This parameter must be set to
the transmission gear to use in the condition selected by TEM_Aux1_Misc_Interlock_Param. The transmission
gear is set as follows:
Table 106
The transmission gear parameter is only used if TEM_Aux1_Misc_Interlock_Param is set to 13 or 14.
Example: For the output to only come on when the vehicle transmission is in a reverse gear, set
TEM_Aux1_Misc_Interlock_Param to 10 and TEM_Aux1_Gear_Interlock_Param to 125.
* TEM_Aux1_w_Ilocks_Output_Fuse
This parameter is the value at which the output will fuse (shut off). The allowable values are from 1 to 20
Amperes.
* TEM_Aux2_Misc_Interlock_Param
This parameter (TEM_Aux2_Misc_Interlock_Param) is the master parameter for this feature. The setting for
this parameter selects the interlocking condition for the output. The following table indicates which interlocking
condition corresponds to which setting for the parameter. To select the interlocking condition simply set the
value of this parameter to the corresponding setting on the table.
Setting Transmission Gear
125 Transmission in Neutral
126 Transmission is in the 1st forward gear
127 Transmission is in the 2nd forward gear
128 Transmission is in the 3rd forward gear
125 + x Transmission is in the xth forward gear
124 Transmission is in the 1st reverse gear
123 Transmission is in the 2nd reverse gear
125 y Transmission is in the yth reverse gear
SECTION 20 - PAGE 10 September 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
POWER FEATURES USING REMOTE POWER
MODULES
Table 107
Setting Interlocking Condition
0 Apply no interlocks to this output
1 Activate this output when the park brake is set AND the switch is on
2 Activate this output when the park brake is not set AND the switch is on
3 Activate this output when a door is open AND the switch is on
4 Activate this output when all doors are closed AND the switch is on
5
Activate this output when the PTO is engaged AND the switch is on (Requires
a PTO feature)
6
Activate this output when the PTO is not engaged AND the switch is on
(Requires a PTO feature)
7 Activate this output when the engine is running AND the switch is on
8 Activate this output when the engine is not running AND the switch is on
9
Activate this output when the vehicle speed exceeds the value set in
TEM_Aux_1_Speed_Interlock_Param AND the switch is on
10
Activate this output when the vehicle speed is less than the value set in
TEM_Aux_1_Speed_Interlock_Param AND the switch is on
11 Activate this output when the vehicle is stopped AND the switch is on
12 Activate this output when the vehicle is moving AND the switch is on
13
Activate this output when the transmission gear is higher than
TEM_Aux1_Gear_Interlock_Param AND the switch is on (Requires Automatic
Transmission)
14
Activate this output when the transmission gear is lower than
TEM_Aux1_Gear_Interlock_Param AND the switch is on (Requires Automatic
Transmission)
15
Activate this output when the transmission is in neutral AND the switch is on
(Requires Automatic Transmission)
16
Activate this output when the transmission is not in neutral AND the switch is
on (Requires Automatic Transmission)
Drop Down List of Possible Parameters for TEM_Aux2_Misc_Interlock_Param
f_106
Electrical Data Body Builder Book September 2012 SECTION 20 - PAGE 11
POWER FEATURES USING REMOTE POWER
MODULES
* TEM_Aux2_Interlock_Latches_Off
Normally, if the output is deactivated because the interlocking condition is not met, the output will re-activate as
soon as the interlocking condition is re-established as long as the switch is still on. If this behavior is not
desirable, the parameter TEM_Aux2_Interlock_Latches_Off parameter can be set. When it is set and the
output is deactivated because the interlocking condition is not met, the output will not reactivate when the
interlocking condition is re-established even if the switch is still on. To re-activate the output in this case, the
switch must be re-cycled (flipped off and then on again).
* TEM_Aux2_Speed_Interlock_Param
If TEM_Aux2_Misc_Interlock_Param is set to 9 or 10, the speed-interlock parameter
(TEM_Aux2_Speed_Interlock_Param) must also be set. This parameter must be set to the actual speed to use
in the condition selected by TEM_Aux2_Misc_Interlock_Param (default unit for this parameter is MPH). The
speed parameter is only used if TEM_Aux2_Misc_Interlock_Param is set to 9 or 10.
Example: For the output to only come on when the vehicle is traveling over 15 MPH, set
TEM_Aux2_Misc_Interlock_Param to 9 and set TEM_Aux2_Speed_Interlock_Param to 15 MPH.
* TEM_Aux2_Gear_Interlock_Param
If TEM_Aux2_Misc_Interlock_Param is set to 13 or 14 and the vehicle has an automatic transmission, the
gear-interlock parameter (TEM_Aux2_Gear_Interlock_Param) must also be set. This parameter must be set to
the transmission gear to use in the condition selected by TEM_Aux2_Misc_Interlock_Param. The transmission
gear is set as follows:
Table 108
The transmission gear parameter is only used if TEM_Aux2_Misc_Interlock_Param is set to 13 or 14.
Example: For the output to only come on when the vehicle transmission is in a reverse gear, you would set
TEM_Aux2_Misc_Interlock_Param to 10 and TEM_Aux2_Gear_Interlock_Param to 125.
* TEM_Aux2_w_Ilocks_Output_Fuse
This parameter is the value at which the output will fuse (shut off). The allowable values are from 1 to 20
Amperes.
Setting Transmission Gear
125 Transmission in Neutral
126 Transmission is in the 1st forward gear
127 Transmission is in the 2nd forward gear
128 Transmission is in the 3rd forward gear
125 + x Transmission is in the xth forward gear
124 Transmission is in the 1st reverse gear
123 Transmission is in the 2nd reverse gear
125 y Transmission is in the yth reverse gear
SECTION 20 - PAGE 12 September 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
POWER FEATURES USING REMOTE POWER
MODULES
Table 109
WIRING INFORMATION
The wiring out of the pin labeled INTERLOCKED_SWITCH_AUX1_Output on the Brown 8-pin RPM output
connector is customer supplied.
The wiring out of the pin labeled INTERLOCKED_SWITCH_AUX2_Output on the Brown 8-pin RPM output
connector is customer supplied.
Parameter ID Description Default Units Min Max Set
TEM_Aux1_
Interlock_
Latches_Off
2006
If this is set, when the output is turned off due
to an interlock, it will remain off until the switch
is recycled.
Off On/Off
TEM_Aux1_
Speed_
Interlock_
Param
2007
The speed parameter for the TEM Aux #1
with Interlocks feature.
30 Mph 0 100 1
TEM_Aux1_
Gear_
Interlock_
Param
2008
The transmission gear parameter for the TEM
Aux #1 with Interlocks feature (124 is reverse,
125 is neutral, 126 is 1st gear, 127 is second
gear etc.).
0 Number 0 250 1
TEM_Aux1_
w_Ilocks_
Output_Fuse
2009
Fuse parameter for the TEM Single output
with interlocks feature.
20 A 0 20 0.1
TEM_Aux1_
Misc_ Interlock_
Param
2033
Miscellaneous or control parameter used for
setting the interlock for the auxiliary 1 with
interlocks.
10 List
TEM_Aux2_
Interlock_
Latches_Off
2010
If this is set, when the output is turned off due
to an interlock, it will remain off until the switch
is recycled.
Off On/Off
TEM_Aux2_
Speed_
Interlock_
Param
2011
The speed parameter for the TEM Aux #2
with Interlocks feature.
30 Mph 0 100 1
TEM_Aux2_
Gear_
Interlock_
Param
2012
The transmission gear parameter for the TEM
Aux #2 with Interlocks feature (124 is reverse,
125 is neutral, 126 is 1st gear, 127 is second
gear etc.).
0 Number 0 250 1
TEM_Aux2_
w_Ilocks_
Output_Fuse
2013
Fuse parameter for the TEM Single output
with interlocks feature.
20 A 0 20 0.1
TEM_Aux2_
Misc_ Interlock_
Param
2034
Miscellaneous or control parameter used for
setting the interlock for the auxiliary 2 with
interlocks.
10 List
Electrical Data Body Builder Book September 2012 SECTION 20 - PAGE 13
POWER FEATURES USING REMOTE POWER
MODULES
TESTING
1. Depress switch.
2. Verify that the RPM output labeled INTERLOCKED_SWITCH_AUX1_Output is obtaining the desired
voltage (as programmed by the Diamond Logic
Builder software).
3. Verify the functionality of the 30 Mph interlock by violating the parameter and determine that the output
shuts off.
4. Test all other interlocks can by violating the programmable parameters to see if the output shuts off
5. Depress the second switch.
6. Verify that the RPM output labeled INTERLOCKED_SWITCH_AUX2_Output is obtaining the desired
voltage (as programmed by the Diamond Logic Builder software).
7. Verify the functionality of the 30 MPH interlock by violating the parameter and determine that the output
shuts off.
8. Test all other interlocks can by violating the programmable parameters to see if the output shuts off
HOW TO ADD THIS FEATURE
Software feature code 595AKB and 595AKC MUST be enabled using the Diamond Logic
Builder software
(see local dealer).
Programmable parameters must be set using the Diamond Logic
Builder software to determine pin and switch locations for RPM inputs and
outputs and to set programmable parameters (refer to pin and switch location section)
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
*Software feature codes can be added through the Diamond Logic Builder. Programmable parameters are
also programmable through the Diamond Logic
Builder.
Required software feature code: 595AKD
Conflicts with software features: NONE
The TEM_Aux1_w_Ext_Sw_Fuse_Level parameter sets the amount of current that flows through auxiliary
output 1. If current rises above this level, fusing takes place and the RPM output is shut down.
By turning the TEM_Aux1_w_Ext_Switch_Init_State parameter on, the Body Controller (BC) forces the RPM
output to be on whenever the trucks key-state is turned from off to accessory or IGN.
Electrical Data Body Builder Book September 2012 SECTION 20 - PAGE 15
POWER FEATURES USING REMOTE POWER
MODULES
Table 110
WIRING INFORMATION
Customer may mount a switch and install the wiring into the pin labeled 3POS_SWITCH_AUX1_Input in the
black 23-pin RPM input connector. Installation of the remote switch is optional with this feature (see Diamond
Logic
Builder).
6. Deactivate the first remote Body Builder installed switch by providing a momentary switch action to GND.
Parameter ID Description Default Units Min Max Step
TEM_Aux1_
w_Ext_Sw_
Fuse_Level
1998
This is the level above which the RPM
will fuse the TEM Auxiliary output with
external switch.
20 A 0 20 0.1
TEM_Aux1_
w_Ext_Switch_
Init_State
2032
This programmable parameter sets the
initial State of RPM channel used with
TEM Auxiliary with external switch #1.
Off On/Off NA NA NA
f_111
SECTION 20 - PAGE 16 September 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
POWER FEATURES USING REMOTE POWER
MODULES
7. Verify that the RPM output goes OFF.
8. Activate the in-cab switch.
9. Verify that the RPM output labeled 3POS_SWITCH_AUX1_Output is providing the battery volts (as
programmed in Diamond Logic
Builder).
10. Verify that the green switch indicator light comes on.
11. Deactivate the in-cab switch.
HOW TO ADD THIS FEATURE
Select software feature code 595AKD using Diamond Logic
Builder to determine pin and switch locations for RPM inputs and outputs and
to set programmable parameters (refer to pin and switch location section)
Electrical Data Body Builder Book September 2012 SECTION 20 - PAGE 17
POWER FEATURES USING REMOTE POWER
MODULES
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
*Software feature codes can be added through Diamond Logic
Builder).
4. Verify that the green switch indicator light comes on.
5. Verify that the RPM input labeled 3POS_SWITCH_AUX1_Input is receiving battery volts from the
customer-mounted switch (as programmed in Diamond Logic
Builder).
6. Deactivate the first remote Body Builder-installed switch by providing a momentary switch action to GND.
7. Verify that the RPM output goes OFF.
8. Activate the first in-cab switch.
9. Verify that the RPM output labeled 3POS_SWITCH_AUX1_Output is providing the battery volts (as
programmed in Diamond Logic
Builder).
10. Verify that the green switch indicator light comes on.
11. Deactivate the first in-cab switch.
12. Activate the second remote Body Builder installed switch to 12 volts by using a momentary switch action.
13. Verify that the RPM output labeled 3POS_SWITCH_AUX2_Output is providing the battery volts at rated
current levels (as programmed in Diamond Logic
Builder).
14. Verify that the green switch indicator light comes on.
15. Verify that the RPM input labeled 3POS_SWITCH_AUX2_Input is receiving battery volts from the
customer-mounted switch (as programmed in Diamond Logic
Builder).
f_112
Electrical Data Body Builder Book September 2012 SECTION 20 - PAGE 19
POWER FEATURES USING REMOTE POWER
MODULES
16. Deactivate the second remote Body Builder installed switch by providing a momentary switch action to
GND.
17. Verify that the RPM output goes OFF.
18. Activate the second in-cab switch.
19. Verify that the RPM output labeled 3POS_SWITCH_AUX2_Output is providing the battery volts (as
programmed in Diamond Logic
Builder).
20. Verify that the green switch indicator light comes on.
21. Deactivate the second in-cab switch.
HOW TO ADD THIS FEATURE
Select software feature code 595AKE using Diamond Logic
Builder software to determine pin and switch locations for RPM inputs and
outputs and to set programmable parameters (refer to pin and switch location section)
SECTION 20 - PAGE 20 September 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
POWER FEATURES USING REMOTE POWER
MODULES
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
*Software feature codes can be added through theDiamond Logic
Builder.
Required software feature code: 595AKG
Software features that must be removed: NONE
The TEM_Aux1_w_Ext_Sw_Fuse_Level parameter sets the amount of current that flows through Auxiliary
output 1. If current rises above this level, fusing takes place and the RPM output is shut down.
By turning the TEM_Aux1_w_Ext_Switch_Init_State parameter on, the BC forces the RPM auxiliary output 1 to
be on whenever the trucks key-state is turned from off to accessory or IGN.
The TEM_Aux2_w_Ext_Sw_Fuse_Level parameter sets the amount of current that flows through Auxiliary
output 2. If current rises above this level, fusing takes place and the RPM output is shut down.
By turning the TEM_Aux2_w_Ext_Switch_Init_State parameter on, the BC forces the RPM auxiliary output 2 to
be on whenever the trucks key-state is turned from off to accessory or IGN.
The TEM_Aux3_w_Ext_Sw_Fuse_Level parameter sets the amount of current that flows through Auxiliary
output 3. If current rises above this level, fusing takes place and the RPM output is shut down.
By turning the TEM_Aux3_w_Ext_Switch_Init_State parameter on, the BC forces the RPM auxiliary output 3 to
be on whenever the trucks key-state is turned from off to accessory or IGN.
Table 112
WIRING INFORMATION
Customer may mount a switch and install the wiring into the pin labeled 3POS_SWITCH_AUX1_Input in the
black 23-pin RPM input connector. Installation of the remote switch is optional with this feature (see Diamond
Logic
Builder).
4. Verify that the green switch indicator light comes on.
5. Verify that the RPM input labeled 3POS_SWITCH_AUX1_Input is receiving battery volts from the
customer-mounted switch (as programmed in Diamond Logic
Builder).
f_113
SECTION 20 - PAGE 22 September 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
POWER FEATURES USING REMOTE POWER
MODULES
6. Deactivate the first remote Body Builder installed switch by providing a momentary switch action to GND.
7. Verify that the RPM output goes OFF.
8. Activate the first in-cab switch.
9. Verify that the RPM output labeled 3POS_SWITCH_AUX1_Output is providing the battery volts (as
programmed in Diamond Logic
Builder).
10. Verify that the green switch indicator light comes on.
11. Deactivate the first in-cab switch.
12. Activate the second remote Body Builder installed switch to 12 volts by using a momentary switch action.
13. Verify that the RPM output labeled 3POS_SWITCH_AUX2_Output is providing the battery volts at rated
current levels (as programmed in Diamond Logic
Builder).
14. Verify that the green switch indicator light comes on.
15. Verify that the RPM input labeled 3POS_SWITCH_AUX2_Input is receiving battery volts from the
customer-mounted switch (as programmed in Diamond Logic
Builder).
16. Deactivate the second remote Body Builder installed switch by providing a momentary switch action to
GND.
17. Verify that the RPM output goes OFF.
18. Activate the second in-cab switch.
19. Verify that the RPM output labeled 3POS_SWITCH_AUX2_Output is providing the battery volts (as
programmed in Diamond Logic
Builder).
20. Verify that the green switch indicator light comes on.
21. Deactivate the second in-cab switch.
22. Activate the third remote Body Builder installed switch to 12 volts by using a momentary switch action.
23. Verify that the RPM output labeled 3POS_SWITCH_AUX3_Output is providing the battery volts at rated
current levels (as programmed in Diamond Logic
Builder).
24. Verify that the green switch indicator light comes on.
25. Verify that the RPM input labeled 3POS_SWITCH_AUX3_Input is receiving battery volts from the
customer-mounted switch (as programmed in Diamond Logic
Builder).
26. Deactivate the third remote Body Builder installed switch by providing a momentary switch action to GND.
27. Verify that the RPM output goes OFF.
28. Activate the third in-cab switch.
29. Verify that the RPM output labeled 3POS_SWITCH_AUX3_Output is providing the battery volts (as
programmed in Diamond Logic
Builder).
30. Verify that the green switch indicator light comes on.
31. Deactivate the third in-cab switch.
HOW TO ADD THIS FEATURE
Select software feature code 595AKG using Diamond Logic
Builder
software to set programmable parameters.
Rear Alert provides the operator the capability to communicate from the rear of the vehicle to the cab. A
customer-mounted switch is wired into the black 23-pin RPM input connector (See the Diamond Logic
Builder
software for pin location). The ignition (IGN) switch must be in ignition for this feature to function.
Programmable Parameters allow the customer to establish whether the input is active at 12 volts or active at
GND. When the operator activates the customer-mounted switch, the rear alert light in the gauge cluster
illuminates and an audible alarm sounds.
Switch Pack Display of Gate Open and Rear
Alert Indicator Lights
f_114
SECTION 21 - PAGE 2 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
INDICATOR LIGHTS AND ALARMS
PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
Required software feature codes: (595AMD or 595AMC**) and 595AKP
** Software feature code 595AMD should be used with an automatic transmission, whereas software feature
code 595AMC should be used for a truck with a manual transmission.
Software feature codes that must be removed: NONE
The TEM_Tail_Gate_Input_Active_State parameter sets the voltage level that determines when the Gate Open
alert should be active.
0 = Input active when open circuit
1 = Input active when grounded
3 = Input active when at 12V
When the TEM_Tail_Gate_Park_Brake_Inhibit parameter is turned ON, the tailgate alert will only alert when the
Park Brake is released.
The TEM_Tail_Gate_Transmission_Interlock parameter indicates the action of the tailgate alert based on
transmission gear.
0 = Ignores Gear
1 = Alert will only activate if the transmission is NOT in reverse
2 = Alert will only activate if transmission is in reverse
3 = Alert will activate for the tailgate sensor or if the transmission is in reverse
The TEM_Rear_Alert_Input_Active_State parameter sets the voltage level that determines when the rear alert
should be active.
0 = Input active when open circuit
1 = Input active when grounded
3 = Input active when at 12V
The TEM_Tail_Gate_Alarm_Timeout parameter determines the length of time that the audible alarm will beep
continuously after the gate is opened and the park brake is released. If this parameter is set to 0, the audible
alarm will beep continuously as long as the gate open indicator is illuminated. Once the audible alarm has
stopped continuous beeping (as set by the TEM_Tail_Gate_Alarm_Timeout parameter) and the gate open
indicator remains illuminated, the TEM_Tail_Gate_Alarm_Period parameter determines the length of time
between individual beeps of the audible alarm.
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 21 - PAGE 3
INDICATOR LIGHTS AND ALARMS
Table 113
WIRING INFORMATION
**If the truck has a manual transmission, to interlock indicator lights and alarm with the transmission, splice a
wire off of the reverse light circuit and run that wire into a pin on the black 23-pin RPM input connector (see the
Diamond Logic
Builder software for correct pin and switch locations). This wire will indicate to the Body
Controller (BC) that the truck is in reverse. This is only required if the customer wishes to interlock the
functionality of the indicator lights and audible alarm with reverse (and they have a manual transmission).
The customer must run a wire from the tailgate switch to the pin labeled Tail_Gate_Open_Input on the black
23-pin input connector on the RPM (See the Diamond Logic
Builder software).
4. Verify that the red Gate Open indicator light in the switch pack comes on.
5. Release park brake.
6. Verify that indicator light flashes and audible alarm sounds and works according to the set programmable
parameters seen above.
7. Close tail gate.
8. Reset park brake.
9. Activate Rear Alert switch.
10. Verify that the input labeled Rear_Alert_Switch_Input is receiving the correct voltage (as programmed in
the Diamond Logic
Builder software).
11. Verify that the red Rear Alert indicator light in the switch pack comes on and an audible alarm sounds.
f_115
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 21 - PAGE 5
INDICATOR LIGHTS AND ALARMS
HOW TO ADD THIS FEATURE
For an Automatic Transmission
Requires Warning Assy. 3587024C1 and LED 3587031C1 be added to the switch pack if this feature is
added aftermarket
Software feature codes 595AKP and 595AMD must be enabled using the Diamond Logic
Builder software
(see local dealer). NOTE: these features can be added individually in the field.
Set programmable parameters for software feature codes using the Diamond Logic
Builder software
(see local dealer).
Set programmable parameters for software feature codes using the Diamond Logic
Builder
software for correct pin locations).
The customer must run a wire from the customer-mounted Boom out of Stow switch to the pin labeled
Boom_Not_Stow_Input on the black 23-pin input connector on the RPM (see the Diamond Logic
Builder
software for correct pin locations).
Off Indicates a 0 is set in for this parameter
On Indicates a 1 is set for the parameter
Parameter ID Description Default Units Min Max Step
TEM_Boom_
Not_Stowed_
Alarm_Inhibit
2061
If this parameter is set, the audible alarm
for the boom-not- stowed warning light
will be inhibited.
Off On/Off
TEM_Outrig_
Deploy_Alarm_
Inhibit
2074
If this parameter is set, the audible alarm
for the outriggers deployed warning light
will be inhibited.
Off On/Off
TEM_ Consol_
Boom_Not_
Stow_Param
2150
Active state for the RPM input connected
to the boom switch(es)
1 List 0 3
TEM_Consol_
Outrig_
Deployed_
Param
2151
Active state on the RPM input for the
outriggers deployed warning light.
1 List 0 3
SECTION 21 - PAGE 8 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
INDICATOR LIGHTS AND ALARMS
TESTING
1. Set the park brake.
2. Take boom out of stow.
3. Verify that the RPM input labeled Boom_Not_Stow_Input is receiving the correct active state voltage (as
programmed in the Diamond Logic
Builder software).
4. Verify that the boom up indicator light is on constantly.
5. Take off the parking brake (with boom still out of stow).
6. Verify that the boom up indicator light is now flashing and the audible alarm is sounding.
7. Set park brake and put boom back in stow.
8. Put outriggers down.
9. Verify that the RPM input labeled Outrig_Not_Stow_Input is receiving the correct active state voltage (as
programmed or the Diamond Logic
Builder software).
10. Verify that the outrig out indicator light is on constantly.
11. Take off the parking brake (with outriggers still down).
12. Verify that the outrig out indicator light is now flashing and the audible alarm is sounding.
HOW TO ADD THIS FEATURE
Requires Warning Assy. 3587024C1 and LED 3587031C1 be added to the instrument cluster if this feature is
added aftermarket.
Software feature codes 595AKR and 595AKS must be enabled using the Diamond Logic
Builder software
(see local dealer). NOTE: these features can be added individually in the field.
Set the programmable parameters for the required software feature codes using the Diamond Logic
Builder
software (see local dealer).
Customer must install wiring from the customer-mounted boom switch into a pin on the black 23-pin RPM
input connector (see the Diamond Logic
Builder
software to set programmable parameters.
For both the BODY UP and GATE OPEN indications, the associated light will illuminate continuously and the
associated audible alarm (default off) will sound when the corresponding input has entered an active state on
the condition that the park brake is set and the vehicle speed is less than or equal to 10 MPH.
For both the BODY UP and GATE OPEN indications, the associated light will illuminate in a slow flashing
manner and the associated audible alarm (default of five fast beeps) will sound when the corresponding input is
in an active state and either the park brake has been released or the vehicle speed has exceeded 10 MPH.
Both the BODY UP and GATE OPEN lights will be off when the RPM input is inactive.
f_118
SECTION 21 - PAGE 10 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
INDICATOR LIGHTS AND ALARMS
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
Required software feature codes: 595AKT and 595AKU
Software feature codes that must be removed: NONE
The TEM_Body_Up_Input_Active_State parameter indicates the state that the BC will read as active for the
customer-installed switch for the dump body up function (as it goes into the RPM input). This active state will be
used to tell the BC when the dump body has been raised up.
The TEM_Tail_Gate_Input_Active_State parameter indicates the state that the BC will read as active for the
customer-installed switch for the dump gate open function (as it goes into the RPM input). This active state will
be used to tell the BC when the dump body has been raised opened.
The TEM_Body_Up_Alarm_Beeper parameter allows the customer to set the alarm type for the condition when
the dump body has been raised (active) and either the park brake has been released or the vehicle speed has
exceeded 10 MPH. The default alarm type is five fast beeps.
The TEM_Gate_Alarm_Beeper parameter allows the customer to set the alarm type for the condition when the
dump gate has been opened (active) and either the park brake has been released or the vehicle speed has
exceeded 10 MPH. The default alarm type is five fast beeps.
The TEM_Body_Up_Beeper parameter allows the customer to set the alarm type for the condition when the
dump body has been raised (active) and both the park brake is set and the vehicle speed is equal to or less
than 10 MPH. The default alarm type is off.
The TEM_Gate_Open_Beeper parameter allows the customer to set the alarm type for the condition when the
dump gate has been opened (active) and both the park brake is set and the vehicle speed is equal to or less
than 10 MPH. The default alarm type is off.
Table 115
Parameter ID Description Default Units Min Max Step
TEM_Body_
Up_Alarm_
Beeper
2259
Allows the selection of one of four beeper
cadences 0 = Off, 1 = 5 fast beeps, 2 = 3
slow beeps, 3 = continuous beeps
1 List 0 3 1
TEM_Body_
Up_Beeper
2260207
4
Allows the selection of one of four beeper
cadences 0 = Off, 1 = 5 fast beeps, 2 = 3
slow beeps, 3 = continuous beeps
0 List 0 3 1
TEM_Body_
Up_Input_
Active_ State
2261
This parameter selects the active state of
the BODY UP RPM input. 0 = Open, 1 =
GND, 3 = 12 volts
3 List 0 3 1
TEM_Gate_
Alarm_ Beeper
2262
Allows selection of one of four beeper
cadences 0 = Off, 1 = 5 fast beeps, 2 = 3
slow beeps, 3 = continuous beeps
1 List 0 3 1
TEM_Gate_
Open_ Beeper
2263
Allows the selection of one of four beeper
cadences 0 = Off, 1 = 5 fast beeps, 2 = 3
slow beeps, 3 = continuous beeps
0 List 0 3 1
TEM_Tail_
Gate_Input_
Active_State
2160
This parameter is used to set the voltage
level that indicates when the tailgate alert
should be active. 0 = Open, 1 = GND, 3 =
12V
3 List 0 3 1
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 21 - PAGE 11
INDICATOR LIGHTS AND ALARMS
WIRING INFORMATION
The customer must run a wire from the customer-mounted Gate Open switch to the pin labeled
Tail_Gate_Open_Input on the black 23-pin input connector on the RPM (see the Diamond Logic
Builder
software for correct pin locations).
The customer must run a wire from the customer-mounted Body Up switch to the pin labeled
TEM_Body_Up_Signal on the black 23-pin input connector on the RPM (see the Diamond Logic
Builder
software for correct pin locations).
TESTING
1. Set park brake.
2. Open the tailgate.
3. Verify that the input labeled TEM_Tail_Gate_Input_Active_State input is receiving the correct voltage (as
programmed in the Diamond Logic
Builder software).
4. Verify that the Red Gate Open indicator light in the switch pack comes on.
5. Release park brake.
6. Verify that indicator light flashes and audible alarm sounds and works according to the set programmable
parameters seen above.
7. Close tailgate.
8. Reset park brake.
9. Raise the body.
10. Verify that the input labeled TEM_Body_Up_Input_Active_State is receiving the correct voltage (as
programmed in the Diamond Logic
Builder software).
11. Verify that the red Body Up indicator light in the switch pack comes on, and an audible alarm sounds.
12. Reset park brake.
f_119
SECTION 21 - PAGE 12 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
INDICATOR LIGHTS AND ALARMS
HOW TO ADD THIS FEATURE
Requires Warning Assy. 3587024C1 and LED 3587031C1 be added to the instrument cluster if this feature is
added aftermarket.
Software feature codes 595AKT and 595AKU must be enabled using Diamond Logic
switchpacks. They
are not associated with any input or electrical function and must be used with Advanced Logic.
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
Required software feature codes:
Sales code 60AJR 595BHL
Sales code 60AJS 595BHM
Sales code 60AJT 595BHN
Sales code 60AJU 595BHP
Sales code 60AJZ 595BHR
Sales code 60AKA 595BHS
Sales code 60AKB 595BHT
Sales code 60AKC 595BHU
Sales code 60AJV 595BHV
Sales code 60AJW 595BHW
Sales code 60AJX 595BHX
Sales code 60AJY 595BHY
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES THAT MUST BE REMOVED
None
PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS REQUIRED
None
SECTION 21 - PAGE 14 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
INDICATOR LIGHTS AND ALARMS
TESTING
1. Create Advanced Logic in Diamond Logic
Builder to turn each light ON using RPM inputs for each light to
be tested.
2. Use indicator lights as outputs
3. Apply template to vehicle
4. Program the vehicle with the template created
5. Turn on RPM inputs as needed and check indicator lights
HOW TO ADD THIS FEATURE
Software feature codes must be enabled using Diamond Logic
Builder.
When this feature is added to the vehicle, the BC pins will not show up on the connector view of DLB until they
are written to with Advanced Logic. 595AKH must be turned on and the inputs/outputs must be used in
Advanced Logic to show up on the connector view of DLB. The following pins are NOT assigned with 595AKH
Diamond Logic
Builder to verify the pin assignments and connect to these circuits.
BODY BUILDER WIRING
08HAT
BODY BUILDER WIRING Includes Wires Installed through the Dash Panel and End in Engine Compartment, In
Cab Wire Ends Will Have ESC Input Terminals, Engine Compartment Wire Ends will have Sealed Connectors.
Feature code 08HAT provides 8 wires from the cab through the 76 way pass-through connector located on the
left (drivers) side of the dash extending 685 mm into the engine compartment for ease of connecting accessory
equipment in the engine compartment to the ESC. This feature provides these circuits from the ESC without
compromising the cab seal or having to drill additional holes in the cab. The wires are terminated in a sealed
connector in the engine compartment and the other ends have ESC input pin termination inside the cab
compartment. This will significantly reduce labor and material costs for the bodybuilder.
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
None
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 22 - PAGE 3
BODY BUILDER INTEGRATION HARNESS
WIRING INFORMATION
A 76-pin connector is provided inside the cab compartment. The pins in the following table will be used to
connect the 8 auxiliary wires.
Table 116
Terminals for the 76-Way Connector are part no. 3549418C1.
Pin Number Circuit Number Gauge Color
52 RBTEM1 16 Gray
53 RBTEM2 16 Gray
54 RBTEM3 16 Gray
55 RBTEM4 16 Gray
56 RBTEM5 16 Gray
57 RBTEM6 16 Gray
58 RBTEM7 16 Gray
59 RBTEM8 16 Gray
f_190
SECTION 22 - PAGE 4 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
BODY BUILDER INTEGRATION HARNESS
Table 117 12-Way Output Connector
JUNCTION BLOCK STUD
08WZG
JUNCTION BLOCK Stud, 100 Amp Battery Feed, protected by a Fusable Link, Stud to be used for Body
Builder Feeds Inside Cab.
This feature is a battery feed point provided inside the cab. The connection will provide up to 100 amps for body
builder use. The circuit feeds off of the mega fuse on the left side of the dash panel and is protected by a fusible
link connection. A 3/8 stud is provided on the left side of the instrument panel behind the gauge cluster.
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
None
Connector Part No. 3601924C1 1689499C1
Description
Connector, Body, 12Way 16
Socket Deutsch
Connector, Body, 12-Way 16
Pin Deutsch
Terminal Part 1651969R1 16 Gauge N/A
Connector Lock Part 3601925C1 N/A
f_191
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 23 - PAGE 1
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
PTO ACCOMMODATION CABLE SHIFT
60ABA
BDY INTG, PTO ACCOMMODATION for Monitoring Cable Shift Engaged PTO, With Indicator Light and
Audible Alarm in Gauge Cluster (requires one Remote Power Module (RPM) input)
This feature utilizes a customer-mounted PTO feedback switch wired to a RPM input to drive an indicator light
in the gauge cluster that allows the operator to determine that the PTO is engaged. An audible alarm is used to
warn the operator when the PTO is engaged during unsafe vehicle operating conditions such as when the park
brake is released or the engine speed is too high. Operating limits are established through programmable
parameters that are set in the Body Controller (BC). The RPM input also drives a PTO hourmeter to allow the
operator to measure stationary PTO hours for maintenance records and fuel tax purposes. To view the PTO
hourmeter, press the gauge cluster display selector button momentarily until the text portion of the display
indicates PTO Hour.
A Cable-Shifted PTO is a gear-to-gear engagement type mechanism. Very specific transmission operating
modes are required to allow safe engagement of a Cable-Shifted PTO. In essence, the PTO gear in the
transmission must be stopped before engagement of a Cable-Shifted PTO should be attempted. The clutch
must be depressed with the vehicle parked in order to engage the PTO for a manual transmission. An
automatic transmission must be in any driving gear with vehicle parked in order to engage a Cable-Shifted
PTO.
For Hybrid Electric Vehicles only, there is an additional feature code (595BBA) which must be added to make
this type of PTO operable in an Eaton hybrid system.
The PTO alarms are controlled by programmable parameters set in the BC. Factory default settings for these
programmable parameters are listed in the tables below.
Please use the Diamond Logic
Builder software to determine pin locations for RPM inputs (refer to the
CONNECTOR screen view) and to set programmable parameters (refer to the FEATURE screen view).
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
Software feature codes can be added through the Diamond Logic
Builder software) is receiving the correct voltage (12V or Ground (GND)) as specified by the programmable
parameter 2147 in the Diamond Logic
Builder software.
Make certain that the PTO indicator light in the gauge cluster illuminates by engaging the PTO.
The audible alarm can be tested by activating a vehicle condition that will sound the alarm based upon the
settings of the programmable parameters. For example, if the park brake interlock is programmed on, release
the park brake and engage the PTO. The audible alarms should sound with continuous beeps.
HOW TO ADD THIS FEATURE
Software feature codes 595AJT (595BJS or 595BJT on vehicles with 2010 compliant engines) and 595AJU
must be enabled on the vehicle using the Diamond Logic
Builder software to make sure that software feature codes 595ACZ, 595AJV,
595AJW, 595AJX, 595AJY, and 595AMZ are NOT enabled on the vehicle (see local dealer).
Set the desired programmable parameters for each signal using the Diamond Logic
Builder software to determine pin locations for RPM inputs (refer to the
CONNECTOR screen view) and to set programmable parameters (refer to the FEATURE screen view).
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
Required software feature codes: 595AJT (Use 595BJS or 595BJT instead of 595AJT on vehicles with 2010
compliant engines), 595AJU, 595AJV, 595AJZ, 595BBA (Hybrid Electric Vehicles only)
Software feature codes that must be removed: 595AJW, 595AJX, 595AJY, 595AMZ, 595BAM
ENGAGEMENT
These parameters set rules that must be met in order for the PTO to be engaged.
If TEM_PTO_Brake_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the brake pedal must be depressed in order
for the PTO to engage.
If TEM_PTO_Cltch_Engmnt_Inhib parameter turned on, then the clutch pedal must be depressed for the PTO
to engage.
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 23 - PAGE 7
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Run_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the engine has to be running in order for
the PTO to be engaged.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the PTO cannot be engaged if the engine
speed is over a certain threshold, which is defined as a programmable parameter in
TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Engmnt_Limit
If TEM_PTO_Neut_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the PTO can only be engaged if the
transmission is NOT in Neutral or Park
If TEM_PTO_Non_Neut_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the transmission must be in Neutral or
Park for the PTO to be engaged.
If TEM_PTO_Pk_Brake_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the Park Brake must be set in order for the
PTO to be engaged.
If TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the PTO cannot be engaged if the Vehicle
Speed is over the value prescribed by TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Engmnt_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Mast_Switch_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the PTO will not be engaged if the
vehicle master switch is not ON.
SECTION 23 - PAGE 8 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
Table 121
DISENGAGEMENT
These parameters set the conditions under which the PTO will be disengaged.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Run_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the engine is
turned off.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the engine
speed rises above the value set by TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_DisEng_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_ Non_Neut _Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the
transmission is taken out of neutral.
If TEM_PTO_Pk_Brake_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the Park Brake
is released.
If TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the vehicle
speed is over the valued specified by TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_DisEng_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Ext_Input_Disengages is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the external input
designated for this purpose is active.
If TEM_PTO_Mast_Switch_Disengages is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the vehicle master
switch is not ON.
Off Indicates a 0 is set in for this parameter
On Indicates a 1 is set for the parameter
Parameter ID Description Default Min Max Step
TEM_PTO_
Brake_Engmnt_
Inhib
2095
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be
engaged if the brake pedal is not depressed
Off NA NA NA
TEM_PTO_
Cltch_Engmnt_
Inhib
2094
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be
engaged when the clutch pedal is not depressed
Off NA NA NA
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Run_
Engmnt_Inhib
2096
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be
engaged if the engine is not running
Off NA NA NA
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Spd_
Engmnt_Inhib
2092
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be
engaged if the engine speed is over the value set
in TEM_PTO_Eng_ Spd_Engmnt_ Limit
On NA NA NA
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Spd_
Engmnt_Limit
2093 See TEM_PTO_Eng_ Spd_Engmnt_ Inhib 1000 RPM 100 5000 1
TEM_PTO_
Neut_Engmnt_
Inhib
2089
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will only be
engaged if the Transmission is not in Neutral or
Park
On NA NA NA
TEM_PTO_
Non_Neut_
Engmnt_Inhib
2088
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be
engaged if the Transmission is not in Neutral or
Park
Off NA NA NA
TEM_PTO_Pk_
Brake_Engmnt_
Inhib
2087
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be
engaged if the Park Brake is not set.
Off NA NA NA
TEM_PTO_
Veh_Spd_
Engmnt_Inhib
2090
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be
engaged if the vehicle speed is over the value set
in TEM_PTO_Veh_ Spd_Engmnt_ Limit
Off NA NA NA
TEM_PTO_
Veh_Spd_
Engmnt_Limit
2091 See TEM_PTO_Veh_ Spd_Engmnt_ Inhib 0 1 100 1
TEM_PTO_Mast_
Switch_Engmnt_
Inhib
2099
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be
engaged if the vehicle master switch is not ON
Off NA NA NA
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 23 - PAGE 9
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
Table 122
RE-ENGAGEMENT
These parameters set the conditions under which the PTO can be re-engaged.
NOTE: All re-engagement parameters should be set to 0 with Lectra-Shift PTOs to prevent gear grind and
damage to the transmission.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Run_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to engine stopping) when the engine is restarted.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to engine overspeed) when the engine speed falls below
TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Engmnt_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Key_State_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be allowed to reengage when
the key state is returned to run.
If TEM_PTO_Non_Neut_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to transmission out of neutral) when the transmission is placed back into neutral.
If TEM_PTO_Pk_Brake_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to park brake released) when the park brake is reapplied.
If TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to the vehicle being over the vehicle speed value) when the vehicle speed is falls
TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Engmnt_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Mast_Switch_Allow_ReEng is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged after a disengage due
to the master switch being turned off when the master switch is turned on again.
If TEM_PTO_Ext_Input_Allow_ReEng is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged after a disengage due to
the designated external input when the external input is no longer active.
Off Indicates a 0 is set in for this parameter
On Indicates a 1 is set for the parameter
Parameter ID Description Default Min Max Step
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Run_
Disengages
2114
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be disengaged
if the engine is turned off.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Spd_
DisEng_Limit
2113 See TEM_PTO_ Eng_Spd_ Disengages 1400 RPM 0 5000 1
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Spd_
Disengages
2112
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be disengaged
if the engine speed is over the value set in
TEM_PTO_Eng_ Spd_DisEng_ Limit
On N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Non_Neut_
Disengages
2109
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be disengaged
if the transmission is taken out of neutral.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Pk_Brake_
Disengages
2108
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be disengaged
if the Park Brake is released.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Veh_Spd_
Disengages
2110
If this parameter is 1, the PTO will be disengaged
if the vehicle speed is over the value set in
TEM_PTO_Veh_ Spd_DisEng_ Limit.
On N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Veh_Spd_
DisEng_Limit
2111 See TEM_PTO_Veh_ Spd_Disengages 5 MPH 3 100 1
TEM_PTO_Ext_
Input_Disengages
2117
If this Parameter is 1m the PTO will be
disengaged if the external input designated for
this purpose is active
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_Mast_
Switch_Disengages
2118
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be disengaged
if the vehicle master switch is not ON
Off N/A N/A N/A
SECTION 23 - PAGE 10 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
Table 123
ALARMS
These parameters utilize the gauge cluster to sound an alarm to the driver when certain programmable
parameters are violated.
If TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Alarms parameter is turned on, then an alarm will sound if the PTO is engaged and the
air pressure is below the value set by TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Alarm_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Alarms parameter is turned on, then an alarm will sound if the PTO is engaged and the
engine speed is over the value set by TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Alarm_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Non_Neut_Alarms parameter is turned on, then an audible alarm will sound if the PTO is
engaged and the transmission is taken out of neutral.
If TEM_PTO_Pk_Brake_Alarms parameter is turned on, then an audible alarm will sound if the PTO is engaged
and the park brake is released.
If TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Alarms parameter is turned on, then an audible alarm will sound if the PTO is engaged
and the vehicle speed is about the value set by TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Alarm_Limit.
Off Indicates a 0 is set in for this parameter
On Indicates a 1 is set for the parameter
Parameter ID Description Default Min Max Step
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Run_
Allow_ReEng
2122
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after disengagement due to the engine stopping
when the engine is restarted.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Spd_
Allow_ReEng
2120
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after disengagement due to engine overspeed
when the engine speed is below
TEM_PTO_Eng_ Spd_Engmnt_ Limit.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_Key_
State_ Allow_
ReEng
2069
If this parameter is set, the PTO will be allowed to
reengage when the key state is returned to run.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Non_Neut_
Allow_ReEng
2148
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after disengagement due to transmission out of
neutral when the transmission is placed back into
neutral.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Pk_Brake_
Allow_ReEng
2149
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after disengagement due to park brake released
when the park brake is reapplied.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Veh_Spd_
Allow_ReEng
2119
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after disengagement due to vehicle overspeed
when the vehicle speed is below
TEM_PTO_Veh_ Spd_Engmnt_ Limit.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_Mast_
Switch_Allow_ReEn
g
2123
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after a disengage due to the master switch being
turned off when the master switch is turned on
again
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_Ext_
Input_Allow_ReEng
2121
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after a disengage due to the designated external
input when the external input is no longer active
Off N/A N/A N/A
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 23 - PAGE 11
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
Table 124 PTO Alarms
OTHER PARAMETERS
The TEM_PTO_Retaining_Solenoid_Fuse parameter is the fusing value for the Remote Power Module output
feeding the retaining coil that holds the electric solenoid in the engaged position. If current exceeds this value,
the BC will turn off the output.
The TEM_PTO_Lectra_Shift_Max_Retries parameter allows the customer to establish the maximum number of
times that the operator can request a PTO engagement per key cycle.
The TEM_PTO_Lectra_Shift_Retry_Time parameter sets the time between a failed engagement attempt and
the time that the operator can attempt to engage the PTO again.
The TEM_PTO_Allowed_Engagement_Time parameter sets the maximum time allowed for the solenoid to
make one engagement attempt.
The TEM_RPM_PTO_Engaged_Param parameter indicates the state that the BC will read as active for the
TEM PTO feedback switch (as it goes into the RPM input). This active state will be used to tell the BC when the
PTO is engaged.
0 = Input active when open circuit
1 = Input active when grounded
3 = Input active when at 12V
Off Indicates a 0 is set in for this parameter
On Indicates a 1 is set for the parameter
Parameter ID Description Default Min Max Step
TEM_PTO_Air_
Pres_Alarms
2138
If this parameter is 1, an alarm will sound if the
PTO is engaged and the air pressure is below
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_Air_
Pres_Alarm_Limit
2139 SeeTEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Alarms 0 psi 0 500 1
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Run_ Alarms
2137
If this Parameter is 1, an alarm will sound if the
PTO is engaged and the engine is turned off
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Spd_
Alarm_Limit
2136 See TEM_PTO_Eng_ Spd_Alarms 1400 RPM 0 5000 0.1
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Spd_ Alarms
2135
If this Parameter is 1, an alarm will sound if the
PTO is engaged and the engine speed is over
TEM_PTO_Eng_ Spd_Alarm_Limit.
On N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Non_Neut_ Alarms
2132
If this Parameter is 1, an alarm will sound if the
PTO is engaged and transmission is taken out of
neutral.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Pk_Brake_ Alarms
2131
If this Parameter is 1, an alarm will sound if the
PTO is engaged and the park brake is released
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Veh_Spd_ Alarms
2133
If this Parameter is 1, an alarm will sound if the
PTO is engaged and the vehicle speed is over
TEM_PTO_Veh_ Spd_Alarm_Limit.
On N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Veh_Spd_
Alarm_Limit
2134 See TEM_PTO_Veh_ Spd_Alarms 5 mph 3 100 1
SECTION 23 - PAGE 12 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
Table 125
WIRING INFORMATION
Please use the Diamond Logic
Builder software to determine pin locations for RPM inputs (refer to the
CONNECTOR screen view) and to set programmable parameters (refer to the FEATURE screen view).
When a vehicle is ordered from Navistar with this feature, a 3-pin connector is provided which mates with the
connector from the Muncie Lectra-Shift Solenoid. This connector is located in the transmission/engine
harness located above the transmission. The customer is responsible for connecting two wires from this
connector to the RPM connectors.
The white wire is pre-wired from a relay to the Lectra-Shift connector. This wire is for the engagement coil.
The red wire is for the holding coil in the solenoid. The red wire must be connected to the brown 8-pin RPM
output connector pin labeled PTO_Lectra-Shift_Retaining_Solenoid_Output.
The black wire is for the PTO feedback switch. The customer must wire from this pin into the black 23-pin
RPM input connector pin labeled PTO_Feedback_Switch.
When the customer has completed the wiring from the connector, plug the 3-pin connector into the connector
provided by the Muncie Solenoid (See the Figure below).
The customer is responsible for providing GND to the solenoid.
Off Indicates a 0 is set in for this parameter
On Indicates a 1 is set for the parameter
Parameter ID Description Default Min Max Step
TEM_PTO_
Retaining_
Solenoid_Fuse
2022
Fuse value for the TEM PTO Single Polarity
engagement retaining solenoid power.
20 Amps 0 20 0.1
TEM_PTO_
Lectra_Shift_
Max_Retries
2058
The maximum number of times a PTO
engagement request is allowed to be issued in a
key cycle.
0 Retries 0 65535 1
TEM_PTO_
Lectra_Shift_
Retry_Time
2059
Time frame for retry counting in Lectra- Shift
engagement algorithm.
600
Seconds
0 600 1
TEM_PTO_
Allowed_
Engagement_ Time
2057
Time allowed for engagement of the Lectra- Shift
PTO.
3 Seconds 0 10 0.1
TEM_RPM_
PTO_Engaged_
Param
2147
Active State for the TEM PTO engagement
feedback switch.
1 List List List
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 23 - PAGE 13
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
Lectra-Shift PTO Solenoid Connectors
f_124
Navistar Supplied Harness for Lectra-Shift PTO
f_125
SECTION 23 - PAGE 14 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
RPM CONNECTOR INFORMATION
HPV Wire Terminal Kits are REQUIRED to allow Body Builders to create wire harnesses for the RPM
connectors.
HPV terminal kits are pre-made kits that include six power output terminals and seals for the brown 8-way
connector and six terminals for the black 23-way connector.
Table 126
NOTE: The following connectors are optional because they are already provided with the RPMs.
This information is given so that the Body Builder could purchase connectors in the event that the original
connectors were damaged or lost, or so that the Body Builder can pre-fabricate a wire harness.
Table 127 8-Way RPM Output Connector (Brown) and 23-Way RPM Input Connector (Black)
Diagram of Lectra-Shift PTO System
f_126
HPV Kits Part Number
RPM Terminal Kit 12 Gauge 2585651C91
RPM Terminal Kit 14 Gauge 2585423C91
Connector Part No. 3548934C1 2585981C91
Description Connector, Body, Brown 8Way RPM Output Connector, Body, Black 23-Way RPM Input Kit
Terminal Part
3534163C1 12 Gauge
3535931C1 14 Gauge
3535930C1 16 & 18 Gauge
1698937C1
Cable Seal Part
3548945C1 12 & 14 Gauge
3535937C1 16 & 18 Gauge
N/A
Connector Lock Part 3548943C1 N/A
CPA Lock 3573833C1 N/A
Cavity Plug 3535938C1 Built into the connector
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 23 - PAGE 15
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
RPM Mounting Location on a DuraStar Model Truck
f_122
RPM Mounting Location on a WorkStar Model Truck
f_123
SECTION 23 - PAGE 16 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
TESTING
1. Depress the PTO switch in the cab to the ON position. Ensure that all PTO interlock conditions are enabled.
2. Verify that the pin labeled PTO_Lectra-Shift_Retaining_Solenoid_Output of the Brown 8-way Remote
Power Module output connector has battery voltage levels present.
3. Verify that the Remote Power Module Input labeled PTO_Feedback_Switch (Pin position specified by the
Diamond Logic
Builder software) is receiving the correct voltage (12V or GND) as specified by the
customer in the Diamond Logic
Builder software.
4. Make certain that the switch indicator lights are functioning by engaging the PTO and verifying that the
green light in the top section of the switch illuminates.
5. Make certain that the PTO indicator light in the gauge cluster is functioning by engaging the PTO.
6. The audible alarm can be tested by activating a vehicle condition that will sound the alarm based upon the
settings of the programmable parameters. For example, if the park brake interlock is programmed on,
release the park brake and engage the PTO. The audible alarms should sound with continuous beeps.
HOW TO ADD THIS FEATURE
A. If vehicle does not have a Remote Power Module installed, follow the Remote Power Module installation
procedure listed in this document.
B. If the vehicle already has a Remote Power Module, follow the procedure listed below to add specific wiring
for Lectra-Shift.
Please use the Diamond Logic
Builder software to determine pin locations for RPM inputs and outputs (refer
to the CONNECTOR screen view) and to set programmable parameters (refer to the FEATURE screen view).
Software feature codes 595AJT (Use 595BJS or 595BJT instead of 595AJT on vehicles with 2010 compliant
engines), 595AJU, 595AJV, and 595AJZ must be enabled on the vehicle using the Diamond Logic
Builder
software (see local dealer).
Use the Diamond Logic
Builder software to make sure that software feature codes 595AJW, 595AJX,
595AJY, and 595AMZ are NOT enabled on the vehicle (see local dealer).
Set the desired programmable parameters for each signal using the Diamond Logic
Builder software to determine pin locations for RPM inputs (refer to the
CONNECTOR screen view) and to set programmable parameters (refer to the FEATURE screen view).
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
Software feature codes can be added through the Diamond Logic
Builder software to determine pin locations for RPM inputs (refer to the
CONNECTOR screen view) and to set programmable parameters (refer to the FEATURE screen view).
All wiring to RPM inputs and outputs is customer supplied.
One wire must be connected from the pin labeled PTO_Output in the brown 8-pin RPM output connector to
the coil on the hydraulic solenoid. This wire drives the engagement and disengagement of the solenoid. The
customer supplies a GND wire for the hydraulic solenoid.
A second wire must be connected from the Body Builder-installed PTO feedback switch (GND active) to the
pin labeled PTO_Feedback_Switch in the black 23-pin RPM input connector. This feedback switch is used to
determine whether or not the PTO is engaged by determining if the switch is in the active state. If the switch
is indeed in the active state and the PTO is running, then an indicator light in the gauge cluster will be on.
When the switch is not in the active state, the indicator light will not be on.
The switch provided is labeled PTO.
Off Indicates a 0 is set in for this parameter
On Indicates a 1 is set for the parameter
Parameter ID Description Default Min Max Step
TEM_RPM_PTO_
Engaged_ Param
2147
Active State for the TEM PTO engagement
feedback switch.
1 List List List
TEM_Hyd_PTO_
Engagement_
Out_Param
1993
This is the fuse level of the Hydraulic PTO FET
(Field Effect Transistor).
20 Amps 0 20 0.1
SECTION 23 - PAGE 24 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
RPM CONNECTOR INFORMATION
HPV Wire Terminal Kits are REQUIRED to allow Body Builders to create wire harnesses for the RPM
connectors.
HPV terminal kits are pre-made kits that include six power output terminals and seals for the brown 8-way
connector and six terminals for the black 23-way connector.
Table 133
NOTE: The following connectors are optional because they are already provided with the RPMs.
This information is given so that the Body Builder can purchase connectors in the event that the original
connectors are damaged or lost, or so that the Body Builder can pre-fabricate a wire harness.
Table 134 8-Way RPM Output Connector (Brown) and 23-Way RPM Input Connector (Black)
Overview of Electric Over Hydraulic PTO System
f_130
HPV Terminal Kits Part Number
RPM Terminal Kit 12 Gauge 2585651C91
RPM Terminal Kit 14 Gauge 2585423C91
Connector Part No. 3548934C1 2585981C91
Description Connector, Body, Brown 8Way RPM Output Connector, Body, Black 23-Way RPM Input Kit
Terminal Part
3534163C1 12 Gauge
3535931C1 14 Gauge
3535930C1 16 & 18 Gauge
1698937C1
Cable Seal Part
3548945C1 12 & 14 Gauge
3535937C1 16 & 18 Gauge
N/A
Connector Lock Part 3548943C1 N/A
CPA Lock 3573833C1 N/A
Cavity Plug 3535938C1 Built into the connector
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 23 - PAGE 25
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
RPM Mounting Location on a DuraStar Model Truck
f_127
RPM Mounting Location on a WorkStar Model Truck
f_123
SECTION 23 - PAGE 26 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
TESTING
1. To determine if the PTO is working, depress the PTO switch in the cab to the on position. Ensure that all
interlock conditions are enabled.
2. Verify that the pin labeled PTO_Output of the brown 8-way Remote Power Module output connector has
the battery voltage levels present.
3. Verify that the RPM input labeled PTO_Feedback_Switch (pin position specified by the Diamond Logic
Builder software) is receiving the correct voltage (12V or GND) as specified by the programmable
parameter in the Diamond Logic
Builder software.
4. Make certain that the indicator light in the top section of the PTO switch illuminates by engaging the PTO.
5. Make certain that the PTO indicator light in the gauge cluster illuminates by engaging the PTO.
6. The Audible Alarm can be tested by violating the set programmable parameters and determining if the
Alarm sounds. For example: If the park brake interlock is programmed ON, release the park brake and
engage the PTO. The audible alarm should sound with continuous beeps.
HOW TO ADD THIS FEATURE
Software feature codes 595AJT (Use 595BJS or 595BJT instead of 595AJT on vehicles with 2010 compliant
engines), 595AJU, 595AJW, and 595AJZ must be enabled on the vehicle using the Diamond Logic
Builder
software (see local dealer).
Use the Diamond Logic
Builder software to make sure that software feature codes 595AJV, 595AJX,
595AJY, and 595AMZ are NOT enabled on the vehicle (see local dealer).
Set the desired programmable parameters for each signal using the Diamond Logic
Builder software to determine pin and switch locations for RPM inputs and
outputs and to set programmable parameters (refer to pin and switch location section).
All re-engagement parameters for Non-Clutched PTOs are defaulted OFF. These parameters are defaulted to
OFF because reengaging a Non-Clutched PTO automatically (after it has disengaged) could cause the gears to
grind and damage the PTO.
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
Software feature codes can be added through the Diamond Logic
Builder software to determine pin and switch locations for RPM inputs and
outputs and to set programmable parameters (refer to pin and switch location section).
All wiring to RPM inputs and outputs is customer supplied.
One wire must be connected from the pin labeled PTO_Output in the Brown 8-pin RPM output connector, to
the coil on the air solenoid. This wire drives the engagement and disengagement of the solenoid. The
customer supplies a GND wire for the air solenoid.
A second wire must be connected from the Body Builder-installed PTO feedback switch (GND active) to the
pin labeled PTO_Feedback_Switch in the black 23-pin RPM input connector. This switch is used to
determine whether or not the PTO is engaged by determining if the switch is in the active state. If the switch
is indeed in the active state and the PTO is running, then an indicator light in the gauge cluster will be on.
When the switch is not in the active state, the indicator light will not be on.
The switch provided is not labeled; therefore the customer will have to install a PTO label for the switch from
the bag of switch labels provided with the vehicle. The customer should use the Diamond Logic
Builder
software to determine the location of the in-cab switch.
Off Indicates a 0 is set in for this parameter
On Indicates a 1 is set for the parameter
Parameter ID Description Default Min Max Step
TEM_RPM_
PTO_Engaged_
Param
2147
Active State for the TEM PTO engagement
feedback switch.
1 List List List
TEM_Hyd_ PTO_
Engagement_
Out_Param
1993 This is the fuse level of the Hydraulic PTO FET. 20 Amps 0 20 0.1
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 23 - PAGE 33
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
RPM CONNECTOR INFORMATION
HPV kits are REQUIRED to allow Body Builders to wire in and out of the RPM connectors.
HPV kits are pre-made kits that include terminals and seals for BOTH RPM connectors.
Table 140
NOTE: The following connectors are optional because they are already provided with the RPMs.
This information is given so that the Body Builder can purchase connectors in the event that the original
connectors are damaged or lost, or so that the Body Builder can pre-fabricate a harness.
Table 141 8-Way RPM Output Connector (Brown) and 23-Way RPM Input Connector (Black)
Diagram of Electric Over Air (Non-Clutched) PTO System
f_131
HPV Kits Part Number
RPM Terminal Kit 12 Gauge 2585651C91
RPM Terminal Kit 14 Gauge 2585423C91
Connector Part No. 3548934C1 2585981C91
Description Connector, Body, Brown 8Way RPM Output Connector, Body, Black 23-Way RPM Input Kit
Terminal Part
3534163C1 12 Gauge
3535931C1 14 Gauge
3535930C1 16 & 18 Gauge
1698937C1
Cable Seal Part
3548945C1 12 & 14 Gauge
3535937C1 16 & 18 Gauge
N/A
Connector Lock Part 3548943C1 N/A
CPA Lock 3573833C1 N/A
Cavity Plug 3535938C1 Included
SECTION 23 - PAGE 34 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
RPM Mounting Location on a DuraStar Model Truck
f_127
RPM Mounting Location on a WorkStar Model Truck
f_123
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 23 - PAGE 35
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
TESTING
1. To determine if the PTO is working, depress the PTO switch in the cab to the on position. Ensure that all
interlock conditions are enabled.
2. Verify that the pin labeled PTO_Output of the brown 8-way RPM output connector has the battery voltage
levels present.
3. Verify that the RPM input labeled PTO_Feedback_Switch (Pin position specified by the Diamond Logic
Builder software) is receiving the correct voltage (12V or GND) as specified by the customer in the
Diamond Logic
Builder software.
4. Make certain that the indicator light in the top section of the PTO switch illuminates by engaging the PTO.
5. Make certain that the PTO indicator light in the gauge cluster illuminates by engaging the PTO.
6. The audible alarm can be tested by violating the set programmable parameters and determining if the
alarm sounds. For example: If the park brake interlock is programmed ON, release the park brake and
engage the PTO. The audible alarm should sound with continuous beeps.
HOW TO ADD THIS FEATURE
Software feature codes 595AJT (Use 595BJS or 595BJT instead of 595AJT on vehicles with 2010 compliant
engines), 595AJU, 595AJX, 595AJZ and 595BBA (for Hybrids only) must be enabled on the vehicle using
the Diamond Logic
Builder software to make sure that software feature codes 595AJV, 595AJW,
595AJY, and 595AMZ are NOT enabled on the vehicle (see Local Dealer)
Set the desired programmable parameters for each signal using the Diamond Logic
Builder software to determine pin and switch locations for RPM inputs and
outputs and to set programmable parameters (refer to pin and switch location section).
SECTION 23 - PAGE 36 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
Software feature codes can be added through the Diamond Logic
Builder software to determine pin and switch locations for RPM inputs and
outputs and to set programmable parameters (refer to pin and switch location section).
All wiring to RPM inputs and outputs is customer supplied.
One wire must be connected from the pin labeled PTO_Output in the Brown 8-pin RPM output connector to
the coil on the air solenoid. This wire drives the engagement and disengagement of the solenoid. The
customer supplies a GND wire for the air solenoid.
A second wire must be connected from the Body Builder-installed PTO feedback switch (GND active) to the
pin labeled PTO_Feedback_Switch in the Black 23-pin RPM input connector. This switch used to determine
whether or not the PTO is engaged by checking if the switch is in the active state. If the switch is indeed in
the active state and the PTO is running, then an indicator light in the gauge cluster will be on. When the
switch is not in the active state, the indicator light will not be on.
The switch provided is labeled PTO.
RPM CONNECTOR INFORMATION
HPV kits are REQUIRED to allow Body Builders to wire in and out of the RPM connectors.
HPV kits are pre-made kits that include terminals and seals for BOTH RPM connectors.
Off Indicates a 0 is set in for this parameter
On Indicates a 1 is set for the parameter
Parameter ID Description Default Min Max Step
TEM_RPM_
PTO_Engaged_
Param
2147
Active State for the TEM PTO engagement
feedback switch.
1 List List List
TEM_Hyd_ PTO_
Engagement_
Out_Param
1993 This is the fuse level of the Hydraulic PTO FET. 20 Amps 0 20 0.1
Diagram of Electric Over Air (Clutched) PTO System
f_132
SECTION 23 - PAGE 42 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
Table 147
NOTE: The following connectors are optional because they are already provided with the RPMs.
This information is given so that the Body Builder can purchase connectors in the event that the original
connectors are damaged or lost, or so that the Body Builder can pre-fabricate a harness.
Table 148 8-Way RPM Output Connector (Brown) and 23-Way RPM Input Connector (Black)
HPV Kits Part Number
RPM Terminal Kit 12 Gauge 2585651C91
RPM Terminal Kit 14 Gauge 2585423C91
Connector Part No. 3548934C1 2585981C91
Description Connector, Body, Brown 8Way RPM Output Connector, Body, Black 23-Way RPM Input Kit
Terminal Part
3534163C1 12 Gauge
3535931C1 14 Gauge
3535930C1 16 & 18 Gauge
1698937C1
Cable Seal Part
3548945C1 12 & 14 Gauge
3535937C1 16 & 18 Gauge
N/A
Connector Lock Part 3548943C1 N/A
CPA Lock 3573833C1 N/A
Cavity Plug 3535938C1 Included
RPM Mounting Location on a DuraStar Model Truck
f_127
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 23 - PAGE 43
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
TESTING
1. To determine if the PTO is working, depress the PTO switch in the cab to the on position. Ensure that all
interlock conditions are enabled.
2. Verify that the pin labeled PTO_Output of the Brown 8-way Remote Power Module output connector has
the battery voltage levels present.
3. Verify that the Remote Power Module Input labeled PTO_Feedback_Switch (Pin position specified by the
Diamond Logic
Builder software) is receiving the correct voltage (12V or GND) as specified by the
customer in the Diamond Logic
Builder software.
4. Make certain that the indicator light in the top section of the PTO switch illuminates by engaging the PTO.
5. Make certain that the PTO indicator light in the gauge cluster illuminates by engaging the PTO.
6. The audible alarm can be tested by violating the set programmable parameters and determining if the
alarm sounds. For example, if the park brake interlock is programmed ON, release the park brake and
engage the PTO. The audible alarm should sound with continuous beeps.
HOW TO ADD THIS FEATURE
Software feature codes 595AJT (Use 595BJS or 595BJT instead of 595AJT on vehicles with 2010 compliant
engines), 595AJU, 595AJY, 595AJZ and 595BBA (for Hybrids only) must be enabled on the vehicle using the
Diamond Logic
Builder software to make sure that software feature codes 595AJV, 595AJW,
595AJX, and 595AMZ are NOT enabled on the vehicle (see Local Dealer)
Set the desired programmable parameters for each signal using the Diamond Logic
Builder software to determine pin and switch locations for RPM inputs and
outputs and to set programmable parameters (refer to pin and switch location section)
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
Software feature codes can be added through the Diamond Logic
Builder software.
REQUIRED SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES
595BHZ, 595BKY, 595AJZ
Conflicts with Software features: 595 AKB, 595AKC, 595AJV, 595AJW, 595AJX, and 595AJY
TEM_Aux1_Misc_Interlock_Param
This parameter (TEM_Aux1_Misc_Interlock_Param) is the master parameter for this feature. The setting for
this parameter selects the interlocking condition for the output. The following table indicates which interlocking
condition corresponds to which setting for the parameter. To select the interlocking condition simply set the
value of this parameter to the corresponding setting on the table.
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 23 - PAGE 45
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
Table 149
* TEM_Aux1_Interlock_Latches_Off
Setting Interlocking Condition
0 Apply no interlocks to this output
1 Activate this output when the park brake is set AND the switch is on
2 Activate this output when the park brake is not set AND the switch is on
3 Activate this output when a door is open AND the switch is on
4 Activate this output when all doors are closed AND the switch is on
5 Activate this output when the PTO is engaged AND the switch is on (Requires a PTO feature)
6
Activate this output when the PTO is not engaged AND the switch is on (Requires a PTO
feature)
7 Activate this output when the engine is running AND the switch is on
8 Activate this output when the engine is not running AND the switch is on
9
Activate this output when the vehicle speed exceeds the value set in
TEM_Aux_1_Speed_Interlock_Param AND the switch is on
10
Activate this output when the vehicle speed is less than the value set in
TEM_Aux_1_Speed_Interlock_Param AND the switch is on
11 Activate this output when the vehicle is stopped AND the switch is on
12 Activate this output when the vehicle is moving AND the switch is on
13
Activate this output when the transmission gear is higher than
TEM_Aux1_Gear_Interlock_Param AND the switch is on (Requires Automatic Transmission)
14
Activate this output when the transmission gear is lower than
TEM_Aux1_Gear_Interlock_Param AND the switch is on (Requires Automatic Transmission)
15
Activate this output when the transmission is in neutral AND the switch is on (Requires
Automatic Transmission)
16
Activate this output when the transmission is not in neutral AND the switch is on (Requires
Automatic Transmission)
Drop Down List of Possible Parameters for TEM_Aux1_Misc_Interlock_Param
f_106
SECTION 23 - PAGE 46 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
Normally, if the output is deactivated because the interlocking condition is not met, the output will re-activate as
soon as the interlocking condition is re-established as long as the switch is still on. If this behavior is not
desirable, the parameter TEM_Aux1_Interlock_Latches_Off parameter can be set. When it is set and the
output is deactivated because the interlocking condition is not met, the output will not reactivate when the
interlocking condition is re-established even if the switch is still on. To re-activate the output in this case, the
switch must be re-cycled (flipped off and then on again).
* TEM_Aux1_Speed_Interlock_Param
If TEM_Aux1_Misc_Interlock_Param is set to 9 or 10, the speed-interlock parameter
(TEM_Aux1_Speed_Interlock_Param) must also be set. This parameter must be set to the actual speed to use
in the condition selected by TEM_Aux1_Misc_Interlock_Param (default unit for this parameter is MPH). The
speed parameter is only used if TEM_Aux1_Misc_Interlock_Param is set to 9 or 10.
Example: For the output to only come on when the vehicle is traveling over 15 MPH, set
TEM_Aux1_Misc_Interlock_Param to 9 and set TEM_Aux1_Speed_Interlock_Param to 15 MPH.
* TEM_Aux1_Gear_Interlock_Param
If TEM_Aux1_Misc_Interlock_Param is set to 13 or 14 and the vehicle has an automatic transmission, the
gear-interlock parameter (TEM_Aux1_Gear_Interlock_Param) must also be set. This parameter must be set to
the transmission gear to use in the condition selected by TEM_Aux1_Misc_Interlock_Param. The transmission
gear is set as follows:
Table 150
Example: For the output to only come on when the vehicle transmission is in a reverse gear, set
TEM_Aux1_Misc_Interlock_Param to 10 and TEM_Aux1_Gear_Interlock_Param to 125.
* TEM_Aux2_Misc_Interlock_Param
This parameter (TEM_Aux2_Misc_Interlock_Param) is the master parameter for this feature. The setting for
this parameter selects the interlocking condition for the output. The following table indicates which interlocking
condition corresponds to which setting for the parameter. To select the interlocking condition simply set the
value of this parameter to the corresponding setting on the table.
Setting Transmission Gear
125 Transmission in Neutral
126 Transmission is in the 1st forward gear
127 Transmission is in the 2nd forward gear
128 Transmission is in the 3rd forward gear
125 + x Transmission is in the xth forward gear
124 Transmission is in the 1st reverse gear
123 Transmission is in the 2nd reverse gear
125 y Transmission is in the yth reverse gear
The transmission gear parameter is only used if
TEM_Aux1_Misc_Interlock_Param is set to 13 or 14.
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 23 - PAGE 47
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
Table 151
Setting Interlocking Condition
0 Apply no interlocks to this output
1 Activate this output when the park brake is set AND the switch is on
2 Activate this output when the park brake is not set AND the switch is on
3 Activate this output when a door is open AND the switch is on
4 Activate this output when all doors are closed AND the switch is on
5 Activate this output when the PTO is engaged AND the switch is on (Requires a PTO feature)
6
Activate this output when the PTO is not engaged AND the switch is on (Requires a PTO
feature)
7 Activate this output when the engine is running AND the switch is on
8 Activate this output when the engine is not running AND the switch is on
9
Activate this output when the vehicle speed exceeds the value set in
TEM_Aux_2_Speed_Interlock_Param AND the switch is on
10
Activate this output when the vehicle speed is less than the value set in
TEM_Aux_2_Speed_Interlock_Param AND the switch is on
11 Activate this output when the vehicle is stopped AND the switch is on
12 Activate this output when the vehicle is moving AND the switch is on
13
Activate this output when the transmission gear is higher than
TEM_Aux2_Gear_Interlock_Param AND the switch is on (Requires Automatic Transmission)
14
Activate this output when the transmission gear is lower than
TEM_Aux2_Gear_Interlock_Param AND the switch is on (Requires Automatic Transmission)
15
Activate this output when the transmission is in neutral AND the switch is on (Requires
Automatic Transmission)
16
Activate this output when the transmission is not in neutral AND the switch is on (Requires
Automatic Transmission)
Drop Down List of Possible Parameters for TEM_Aux2_Misc_Interlock_Param
f_106
SECTION 23 - PAGE 48 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
* TEM_Aux2_Interlock_Latches_Off
Normally, if the output is deactivated because the interlocking condition is not met, the output will re-activate as
soon as the interlocking condition is re-established as long as the switch is still on. If this behavior is not
desirable, the parameter TEM_Aux2_Interlock_Latches_Off parameter can be set. When it is set and the
output is deactivated because the interlocking condition is not met, the output will not reactivate when the
interlocking condition is re-established even if the switch is still on. To re-activate the output in this case, the
switch must be re-cycled (flipped off and then on again).
* TEM_Aux2_Speed_Interlock_Param
If TEM_Aux2_Misc_Interlock_Param is set to 9 or 10, the speed-interlock parameter
(TEM_Aux2_Speed_Interlock_Param) must also be set. This parameter must be set to the actual speed to use
in the condition selected by TEM_Aux2_Misc_Interlock_Param (default unit for this parameter is MPH). The
speed parameter is only used if TEM_Aux2_Misc_Interlock_Param is set to 9 or 10.
Example: For the output to only come on when the vehicle is traveling over 15 MPH, set
TEM_Aux2_Misc_Interlock_Param to 9 and set TEM_Aux2_Speed_Interlock_Param to 15 MPH.
* TEM_Aux2_Gear_Interlock_Param
If TEM_Aux2_Misc_Interlock_Param is set to 13 or 14 and the vehicle has an automatic transmission, the
gear-interlock parameter (TEM_Aux2_Gear_Interlock_Param) must also be set. This parameter must be set to
the transmission gear to use in the condition selected by TEM_Aux2_Misc_Interlock_Param. The transmission
gear is set as follows:
Table 152
Example: For the output to only come on when the vehicle transmission is in a reverse gear, you would set
TEM_Aux2_Misc_Interlock_Param to 10 and TEM_Aux2_Gear_Interlock_Param to 125.
Setting Transmission Gear
125 Transmission in Neutral
126 Transmission is in the 1st forward gear
127 Transmission is in the 2nd forward gear
128 Transmission is in the 3rd forward gear
125 + x Transmission is in the xth forward gear
124 Transmission is in the 1st reverse gear
123 Transmission is in the 2nd reverse gear
125 y Transmission is in the yth reverse gear
The transmission gear parameter is only used if
TEM_Aux1_Misc_Interlock_Param is set to 13 or 14.
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 23 - PAGE 49
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
Table 153
ENGAGEMENT
*These parameters set rules that must be met in order for the PTO to be engaged.
If TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, the PTO cannot be engaged if the primary
vehicle air pressure is below the programmable parameter set by TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Engmnt_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Brake_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the brake pedal must be depressed in order
for the PTO to engage.
If TEM_PTO_Cltch_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the clutch pedal must be depressed for the
PTO to engage.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Run_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the engine has to be running in order for
the PTO to be engaged.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the PTO cannot be engaged if the engine
speed is over a certain threshold, which is defined as a programmable parameter in
TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Engmnt_Limit
If TEM_PTO_Neut_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the PTO can only be engaged if the
transmission is NOT in Neutral or Park.
If TEM_PTO_Non_Neut_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the transmission must be in Neutral or
Park for the PTO to be engaged.
If TEM_PTO_Pk_Brake_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the park brake must be set in order for the
PTO to be engaged.
If TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the PTO cannot be engaged if the vehicle
speed is over the value prescribed by TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Engmnt_Limit.
Off Indicates a 0 is set in for this parameter
On Indicates a 1 is set for the parameter
Parameter ID Description Default Min Max Step
TEM_Aux1_
Interlock_
Latches_Off
2006
If this is set, when the output is turned off due to
an interlock, it will remain off until the switch is
recycled.
Off On/Off
TEM_Aux1_
Speed_ Interlock_
Param
2007
The speed parameter for the TEM Aux #1 with
Interlocks feature.
30 Mph 0 100
TEM_Aux1_ Gear_
Interlock_ Param
2008
The transmission gear parameter for the TEM
Aux #1 with Interlocks feature (124 is reverse,
125 is neutral, 126 is 1st gear, 127 is second gear
etc.).
0 Number 0 250
TEM_Aux1_ Misc_
Interlock_ Param
2033
Miscellaneous or control parameter used for
setting the interlock for the auxiliary 1 with
interlocks.
10 List
TEM_Aux2_
Interlock_
Latches_Off
2010
If this is set, when the output is turned off due to
an interlock, it will remain off until the switch is
recycled.
Off On/Off
TEM_Aux2_
Speed_ Interlock_
Param
2011
The speed parameter for the TEM Aux #2 with
Interlocks feature.
30 Mph 0 100
TEM_Aux2_ Gear_
Interlock_ Param
2012
The transmission gear parameter for the TEM
Aux #2 with Interlocks feature (124 is reverse,
125 is neutral, 126 is 1st gear, 127 is second gear
etc.).
0 Number 0 250
TEM_Aux2_ Misc_
Interlock_ Param
2034
Miscellaneous or control parameter used for
setting the interlock for the auxiliary 2 with
interlocks.
10 List
SECTION 23 - PAGE 50 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
Table 154
DISENGAGEMENT
These parameters set the conditions under which the PTO will be disengaged.
If TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the primary air
pressure is below the value set in TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_DisEng_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Run_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the engine is
turned off.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the engine
speed rises above the value set by TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_DisEng_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_ Non_Neut _Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the
transmission is taken out of neutral.
If TEM_PTO_Pk_Brake_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the Park Brake
is released.
If TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the vehicle
speed is over the valued specified by TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_DisEng_Limit.
Off Indicates a 0 is set in for this parameter
On Indicates a 1 is set for the parameter
Parameter ID Description Default Min Max Step
TEM_PTO_
Air_Pres_
Engmnt_Inhib
2097
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be
engaged if the primary vehicle air pressure is
below TEM_PTO_Air_ Pres_Engmnt_ Limit
On N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Air_Pres_
Engmnt_Limit
2098 See TEM_PTO_Air_ Pres_Engmnt_ Inhib 90 psi 1 500 1
TEM_PTO_
Brake_Engmnt_
Inhib
2095
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be
engaged if the brake pedal is not depressed
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Cltch_Engmnt_
Inhib
2094
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be
engaged when the clutch pedal is not depressed
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Run_
Engmnt_Inhib
2096
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be
engaged if the engine is not running
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Spd_
Engmnt_Inhib
2092
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be
engaged if the engine speed is over the value set
in TEM_PTO_Eng_ Spd_Engmnt_ Limit
On N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Spd_
Engmnt_Limit
2093 See TEM_PTO_Eng_ Spd_Engmnt_ Inhib 1000 RPM 100 5000 1
TEM_PTO_
Neut_Engmnt_
Inhib
2089
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will only be
engaged if the Transmission is not in Neutral or
Park
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Non_Neut_
Engmnt_Inhib
2088
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be
engaged if the Transmission is not in Neutral or
Park
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_Pk_
Brake_Engmnt_
Inhib
2087
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be
engaged if the Park Brake is not set.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Veh_Spd_
Engmnt_Inhib
2090
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be
engaged if the vehicle speed is over the value set
in TEM_PTO_Veh_ Spd_Engmnt_ Limit
On N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Veh_Spd_
Engmnt_Limit
2091 See TEM_PTO_Veh_ Spd_Engmnt_ Inhib 3 MPH 1 100 1
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 23 - PAGE 51
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
Table 155
RE-ENGAGEMENT
These parameters set the conditions under which the PTO can be reengaged.
If TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to low air pressure) when the primary air pressure rises about the value specified by
TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Engmnt_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Run_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to engine stopping) when the engine is restarted.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to engine overspeed) when the engine speed falls below
TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Engmnt_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Key_State_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be allowed to reengage when
the key state is returned to run.
If TEM_PTO_Non_Neut_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to transmission out of neutral) when the transmission is placed back into neutral.
If TEM_PTO_Pk_Brake_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to park brake released) when the park brake is reapplied.
If TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to the vehicle being over the vehicle speed value) when the vehicle speed falls below
TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Engmnt_Limit.
Off Indicates a 0 is set in for this parameter
On Indicates a 1 is set for the parameter
Parameter ID Description Default Min Max Step
TEM_PTO_
Air_Pres_
DisEng_Limit
2116 See TEM_PTO_Air_ Pres_Disengages 80 psi 0 500 1
TEM_PTO_
Air_Pres_
Disengages
2115
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be disengaged
if the primary air pressure is below the value set
in TEM_PTO_Air_ Pres_DisEng_ Limit.
On N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Run_
Disengages
2114
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be disengaged
if the engine is turned off.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Spd_
DisEng_Limit
2113 See TEM_PTO_ Eng_Spd_ Disengages 1800 RPM 0 5000 1
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Spd_
Disengages
2112
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be disengaged
if the engine speed is over the value set in
TEM_PTO_Eng_ Spd_DisEng_ Limit
On N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Non_Neut_
Disengages
2109
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be disengaged
if the transmission is taken out of neutral.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Pk_Brake_
Disengages
2108
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be disengaged
if the Park Brake is released.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Veh_Spd_
Disengages
2110
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be disengaged
if the vehicle speed is over the value set in
TEM_PTO_Veh_ Spd_DisEng_ Limit.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Veh_Spd_
DisEng_Limit
2111 See TEM_PTO_Veh_ Spd_Disengages 0 MPH 3 100 1
SECTION 23 - PAGE 52 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
Table 156
ALARMS
This feature does not provide any PTO feedback indications or alarms. If this functionality is required, add the
feature described in the chapter for 16WLM PTO Feedback and Alarms.
WIRING INFORMATION
The wiring out of the pin labeled TEM_PTO_Relay_Driver_Command should be connected to the F2 pin on the
J4 (1601) connector.
The wiring out of the pin labeled Interlocked_switch_relay1_output should be connected to the F6 pin on the J4
(1601) connector.
The wiring out of the pin labeled Interlocked_switch_relay2_output should be connected to the F7 pin on the J4
(1601) connector.
Off Indicates a 0 is set in for this parameter
On Indicates a 1 is set for the parameter
Parameter ID Description Default Min Max Step
TEM_PTO_
Air_Pres_
Allow_ReEng
2124
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after disengagement due to low vehicle air
pressure when the primary air pressure is over
TEM_PTO_Air_ Pres_Engmnt_ Limit.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Run_
Allow_ReEng
2122
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after disengagement due to the engine stopping
when the engine is restarted.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Spd_
Allow_ReEng
2120
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after disengagement due to engine overspeed
when the engine speed is below
TEM_PTO_Eng_ Spd_Engmnt_ Limit.
On N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Key_State_
Allow_ReEng
2069
If this parameter is set, the PTO will be allowed to
reengage when the key state is returned to run.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Non_Neut_
Allow_ReEng
2148
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after disengagement due to transmission out of
neutral when the transmission is placed back into
neutral.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Pk_Brake_
Allow_ReEng
2149
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after disengagement due to park brake released
when the park brake is reapplied.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Veh_Spd_
Allow_ReEng
2119
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after disengagement due to vehicle overspeed
when the vehicle speed is below
TEM_PTO_Veh_ Spd_Engmnt_ Limit.
Off N/A N/A N/A
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 23 - PAGE 53
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
TESTING
1. Depress switch.
2. Verify that the output labeled Interlocked_switch_relay1_output is obtaining the desired voltage (as
programmed by the Diamond Logic
Builder software).
3. Verify the functionality of the 30 Mph interlock by violating the parameter and determine that the output
shuts off.
4. Test all other interlocks can by violating the programmable parameters to see if the output shuts off
5. Depress the second switch.
6. Verify that the RPM output labeled Interlocked_switch_relay2_output is obtaining the desired voltage (as
programmed by the Diamond Logic
Builder software).
7. Verify the functionality of the 30 MPH interlock by violating the parameter and determine that the output
shuts off.
8. Test all other interlocks can by violating the programmable parameters to see if the output shuts off
9. Depress the In-cab PTO switch to the ON position.
10. Verify that all enabled interlock conditions are met.
f_135
SECTION 23 - PAGE 54 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
HOW TO ADD THIS FEATURE
Software feature codes 595BHZ, 595BKY and 595AJZ MUST be enabled using the Diamond Logic
Builder
software (see local dealer).
Software feature codes 595AJU, 595AJV, 595AJW, 595AJX, and 595AJY must NOT be enabled on the
truck.
Three (3) 2-position latched rocker switches (P/N 3578910C1) must be installed in the in-cab switch pack in
the position specified by the Diamond Logic
Builder software.
Three (3) green LED indicator lights (P/N 3578733C1) must be installed behind the upper portion of each
switch.
Three (3) amber LED indicator lights (P/N 3533928C1) must be installed behind the lower portion of each
switch.
Three (3) relays, gen. control, 4-pin micro (P/N 3600329C1) must be installed with the proper pin
connections to the J4 connector described above.
Programmable parameters must be set using the Diamond Logic
Builder
software.
Software feature codes 595AJU, 595AJV, 595AJW, 595AJX, and 595AJY must NOT be enabled on the
truck.
Set desired Engagement, Disengagement, and Re-engagement programmable parameters.
Add a latched switch (P/N 3578910C1) in the in-cab switch pack in the position specified by the Diamond
Logic
Builder software.
If the truck does not already have a 4-pack solenoid base, the customer should order a 4-pack base (part
number 2505594C1) and an air solenoid (part number 2506711C91).
Add wiring as per the Electrical Circuit Diagram Manual S08322, Chapter 10, Chassis Accessories, Air
Solenoid.
f_136
SECTION 23 - PAGE 60 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
PTO CONTROL ONLY FOR LINE HAUL AND PROSTAR MODELS, DASH MOUNTED FOR
CUSTOMER PROVIDED PTO; INCLUDES SWITCH, ELECTRIC/AIR SOLENOID, PIPING
AND WIRING
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
REQUIRED SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES
595ADD for post 2007 clusters and pre 2010 clusters 595BKJ or 595BNP is required to be added for 2010
clusters.
Software feature 595BNP is similar to 595BKJ, but has 42 parameters available.
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES THAT MUST BE REMOVED
595AEB for post 2007 clusters and pre 2010 clusters 595BKK or 595BNN is required to be removed for 2010
clusters.
These parameters set the conditions under which the PTO will be engaged and disengaged.
Software Feature Codes: 595ADD or 595BKJ
PARAMETERS
PTOa_Vehicle_Speed_Enable Set to 0 to ignore the vehicle speed. Set to 1 to require the vehicle to be below
a specified vehicle speed for the PTO to engage. Please use PTOa_Vehicle_Speed_Range to specify the
appropriate vehicle speed if this parameter is set to 1.
PTOa_Engine_Speed_Enable Set to 0 to ignore the engine speed. Set to 1 to require the vehicle to be below
a specified engine speed for the PTO to be engaged. Please use PTOa_Engine_Speed_Range to specify the
appropriate engine speed if this parameter is set to 1.
PTOa_Engine_Speed_Alarm_Enable Set to 0 to not have an alarm based on engine speed. Set to 1 to have
a speed that an alarm will sound when the PTO is engaged and the engine speed is greater than the set value.
Please use PTOa_Engine_Speed_Alarm_Range to specify the appropriate engine speed if this parameter is
set to 1.
Vehicle_Speed_Alarm_Enable PTOa_ Set to 0 to not have an alarm based on vehicle speed. Set to 1 to have
a speed limit that an alarm will sound when the PTO is engaged and the vehicle speed is greater than the set
value. Please use PTOa_Vehicle_Speed_Alarm_Range to specify the appropriate vehicle speed if this
parameter is set to 1.
PTOa_Clutch_Pedal Set to 0 to ignore the clutch pedal or if the vehicle does not have a clutch pedal. Set to 1
to ensure that the clutch pedal is depressed for engagement.
PTOa_Engine_Running Set to 0 to ignore the engine. Set to 1 to ensure that the engine is running to engage
and disengage if the engine stops running.
PTOa_Engine_Speed_Range Set to a speed that the engine has to be below for the PTO to engage. The
PTO will disengage if the engine speed becomes greater than the set value. If engine speed is required for
PTO operation, please use PTOa_Engine_Speed_Enable to enable this interlock.
PTOa_Park_Brake Set to 0 to ignore the park brake. Set to 1 to ensure that the park brake is set for engage
and disengage if the park brake is released.
PTOa_Engine_Speed_Alarm_Range Set to the speed that the vehicle has to be below for the PTO to
engage. The PTO will disengage if the vehicle speed becomes greater than the set value. If vehicle speed is
required for PTO operation, please use PTOa_Vehicle_Speed_Enable parameter to enable this interlock.
PTOa_Vehicle_Speed_Alarm_Range.
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 23 - PAGE 61
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
PTOa_Transmission_Neutral NOTE: this parameter will only work for vehicles with automated manual
transmissions. Set to 0 to ignore the transmission state. Set to 1 to ensure that the transmission is in neutral for
engagement.
Table 160
Off Indicates a 0 is set in for this parameter
On Indicates a 1 is set for the parameter
Parameter ID Description Default Min Max Step
PTOa_Vehicle_
Speed_Enable
2242
Set to 1 to require the vehicle to be below a specified
vehicle speed for the PTO to engage. Please use
PTOa_Vehicle_Speed_Range to specify the
appropriate vehicle speed if this parameter is set to 1..
On N/A N/A N/A
PTOa_Engine_
Speed_Enable
2243
Set to 1 to require the vehicle to be below a specified
engine speed for the PTO to be engaged. Please use
PTOa_Engine_Speed_Range to specify the
appropriate engine speed if this parameter is set to 1.
Off N/A N/A N/A
PTOa_Engine_
Speed_Alarm_
Enable
2244
Set to 1 to have a speed that an alarm will sound when
the PTO is engaged and the engine speed is greater
than the set value. Please use
PTOa_Engine_Speed_Alarm_Range to specify the
appropriate engine speed if this parameter is set to 1.
Off N/A N/A N/A
Vehicle_Speed_
Alarm_Enable
PTOa
2267
Set to 1 to have a speed limit that an alarm will sound
when the PTO is engaged and the vehicle speed is
greater than the set value. Please use
PTOa_Vehicle_Speed_Alarm_Range to specify the
appropriate vehicle speed if this parameter is set to 1.
Off N/A N/A N/A
PTOa_Clutch_
Pedal
2333
Set to 1 to ensure that the clutch pedal is depressed for
engagement.
Off N/A N/A N/A
PTOa_Engine_
Running
2334
Set to 1 to ensure that the engine is running to engage
and disengage if the engine stops running.
Off N/A N/A N/A
PTOa_Engine_
Speed_Range
2336
Set to a speed that the engine has to be below for the
PTO to engage. The PTO will disengage if the engine
speed becomes greater than the set value. If engine
speed is required for PTO operation, please use
PTOa_Engine_Speed_Enable to enable this interlock.
300 300 3000 10
PTOa_Park_Brake 2338
Set to 1 to ensure that the park brake is set for engage
and disengage if the park brake is released.
On N/A N/A N/A
PTOa_Vehicle_
Speed_Range
2339
Set to the speed that the vehicle has to be below for
the PTO to engage. The PTO will disengage if the
vehicle speed becomes greater than the set value. If
vehicle speed is required for PTO operation, please
use PTOa_Vehicle_Speed_Enable parameter to
enable this interlock.
3 3 100 1
PTOa_Engine_
Speed_Alarm_
Range
2340
If an engine speed alarm is required for PTO operation,
please use PTOa_Engine_Speed_Alarm_Enable
parameter to enable this alarm.
300 300 3000 10
PTOa_Vehicle_
Speed_Alarm_
Range
2342
Set to a speed limit that an alarm will sound when the
PTO is engaged and the vehicle speed is greater than
the set value. If the vehicle alarm is required for PTO
operation, please use
PTOa_Vehicle_Speed_Alarm_Enable to enable this
alarm.
3 3 100 1
PTOa_
Transmission_
Neutral
2355
NOTE, this parameter will only work for vehicles with
automated manual transmissions. Set to 1 to ensure
that the transmission is in neutral for engagement.
On N/A N/A N/A
SECTION 23 - PAGE 62 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES
595BNP (2010 Clusters, 42 Parameters)
PARAMETERS
ENGAGEMENT
These parameters set rules that must be met in order for the PTO to be engaged.
If TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, the PTO cannot be engaged if the primary
vehicle air pressure is below the programmable parameter set by TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Engmnt_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Brake_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the brake pedal must be depressed in order
for the PTO to engage.
If TEM_PTO_Cltch_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the clutch pedal must be depressed for the
PTO to engage.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Run_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the engine has to be running in order for
the PTO to be engaged.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the PTO cannot be engaged if the engine
speed is over a certain threshold, which is defined as a programmable parameter in
TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Engmnt_Limit
If TEM_PTO_Neut_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the PTO can only be engaged if the
transmission is NOT in Neutral or Park.
If TEM_PTO_Non_Neut_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the transmission must be in Neutral or
Park for the PTO to be engaged.
If TEM_PTO_Pk_Brake_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the park brake must be set in order for the
PTO to be engaged.
If TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the PTO cannot be engaged if the vehicle
speed is over the value prescribed by TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Engmnt_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Mast_Switch_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the PTO will not be engaged if the
vehicle master switch is not ON.
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 23 - PAGE 63
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
Table 161
DISENGAGEMENT
These parameters set the conditions under which the PTO will be disengaged.
If TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the primary air
pressure is below the value set in TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_DisEng_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Run_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the engine is
turned off.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the engine
speed rises above the value set by TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_DisEng_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_ Non_Neut _Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the
transmission is taken out of neutral.
If TEM_PTO_Pk_Brake_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the Park Brake
is released.
Off Indicates a 0 is set in for this parameter
On Indicates a 1 is set for the parameter
Parameter ID Description Default Min Max Step
TEM_PTO_
Air_Pres_
Engmnt_Inhib
2097
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be engaged if
the primary vehicle air pressure is below
TEM_PTO_Air_ Pres_Engmnt_ Limit
On N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Air_Pres_
Engmnt_Limit
2098 See TEM_PTO_Air_ Pres_Engmnt_ Inhib 90 psi 1 500 1
TEM_PTO_
Brake_Engmnt_
Inhib
2095
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be engaged if
the brake pedal is not depressed
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Cltch_Engmnt_
Inhib
2094
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be engaged
when the clutch pedal is not depressed
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Run_
Engmnt_Inhib
2096
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be engaged if
the engine is not running
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Spd_
Engmnt_Inhib
2092
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be engaged if
the engine speed is over the value set in
TEM_PTO_Eng_ Spd_Engmnt_ Limit
On N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Spd_
Engmnt_Limit
2093 See TEM_PTO_Eng_ Spd_Engmnt_ Inhib 1000 RPM 100 5000 1
TEM_PTO_
Neut_Engmnt_
Inhib
2089
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will only be engaged if
the Transmission is not in Neutral or Park
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Non_Neut_
Engmnt_Inhib
2088
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be engaged if
the Transmission is not in Neutral or Park
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_Pk_
Brake_Engmnt_
Inhib
2087
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be engaged if
the Park Brake is not set.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Veh_Spd_
Engmnt_Inhib
2090
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be engaged if
the vehicle speed is over the value set in
TEM_PTO_Veh_ Spd_Engmnt_ Limit
On N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Veh_Spd_
Engmnt_Limit
2091 See TEM_PTO_Veh_ Spd_Engmnt_ Inhib 3 MPH 1 100 1
TEM_PTO_Mast_
Switch_Engmnt_
Inhib
2099
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be engaged if
the vehicle master switch is not ON
Off N/A N/A N/A
SECTION 23 - PAGE 64 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
If TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the vehicle
speed is over the valued specified by TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_DisEng_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Ext_Input_Disengages is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the external input
designated for this purpose is active.
If TEM_PTO_Mast_Switch_Disengages is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the vehicle master
switch is not ON.
Table 162
RE-ENGAGEMENT
These parameters set the conditions under which the PTO can be reengaged.
If TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to low air pressure) when the primary air pressure rises about the value specified by
TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Engmnt_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Run_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to engine stopping) when the engine is restarted.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to engine overspeed) when the engine speed falls below
TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Engmnt_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Key_State_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be allowed to reengage when
the key state is returned to run.
Off Indicates a 0 is set in for this parameter
On Indicates a 1 is set for the parameter
Parameter ID Description Default Min Max Step
TEM_PTO_
Air_Pres_
DisEng_Limit
2116 See TEM_PTO_Air_ Pres_Disengages 80 psi 0 500 1
TEM_PTO_
Air_Pres_
Disengages
2115
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be disengaged if the
primary air pressure is below the value set in
TEM_PTO_Air_ Pres_DisEng_ Limit.
On N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Run_
Disengages
2114
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be disengaged if the
engine is turned off.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Spd_
DisEng_Limit
2113 See TEM_PTO_ Eng_Spd_ Disengages 1800 RPM 0 5000 1
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Spd_
Disengages
2112
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be disengaged if the
engine speed is over the value set in TEM_PTO_Eng_
Spd_DisEng_ Limit
On N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Non_Neut_
Disengages
2109
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be disengaged if the
transmission is taken out of neutral.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Pk_Brake_
Disengages
2108
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be disengaged if the
Park Brake is released.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Veh_Spd_
Disengages
2110
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be disengaged if the
vehicle speed is over the value set in TEM_PTO_Veh_
Spd_DisEng_ Limit.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Veh_Spd_
DisEng_Limit
2111 See TEM_PTO_Veh_ Spd_Disengages 0 MPH 3 100 1
TEM_PTO_Ext_
Input_Disengages
2117
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be disengaged if the
external input designated for this purpose is active
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_Mast_
Switch_Disengages
2118
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be disengaged if the
vehicle master switch is not ON
Off N/A N/A N/A
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 23 - PAGE 65
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
If TEM_PTO_Non_Neut_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to transmission out of neutral) when the transmission is placed back into neutral.
If TEM_PTO_Pk_Brake_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to park brake released) when the park brake is reapplied.
If TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to the vehicle being over the vehicle speed value) when the vehicle speed falls below
TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Engmnt_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Ext_Input_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after a
disengage due to the designated external input being in active state) when the external input is no longer in
active state.
If TEM_PTO_Mast_Switch_Allow_ReEng is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged after a disengage due
to the master switch being turned off when the master switch is turned on again.
Table 163
ALARMS
These parameters utilize the gauge cluster to sound an alarm to the driver when certain programmable
parameters are violated.
If TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Alarms parameter is turned on, then an audible alarm will sound in the cab if the
primary air pressure drops below the value specified by TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Alarm_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Run_Alarms parameter is turned on, then an audible alarm will sound in the cab if the PTO
is engaged and the engine is turned off.
Off Indicates a 0 is set in for this parameter
On Indicates a 1 is set for the parameter
Parameter ID Description Default Min Max Step
TEM_PTO_
Air_Pres_
Allow_ReEng
2124
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged after
disengagement due to low vehicle air pressure when
the primary air pressure is over TEM_PTO_Air_
Pres_Engmnt_ Limit.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Run_
Allow_ReEng
2122
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged after
disengagement due to the engine stopping when the
engine is restarted.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Spd_
Allow_ReEng
2120
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged after
disengagement due to engine overspeed when the
engine speed is below TEM_PTO_Eng_ Spd_Engmnt_
Limit.
On N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Key_State_
Allow_ReEng
2069
If this parameter is set, the PTO will be allowed to
reengage when the key state is returned to run.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Non_Neut_
Allow_ReEng
2148
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged after
disengagement due to transmission out of neutral
when the transmission is placed back into neutral.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Pk_Brake_
Allow_ReEng
2149
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged after
disengagement due to park brake released when the
park brake is reapplied.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Veh_Spd_
Allow_ReEng
2119
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged after
disengagement due to vehicle overspeed when the
vehicle speed is below TEM_PTO_Veh_ Spd_Engmnt_
Limit.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_Ext_
Input_Allow_ReEng
2121
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged after
a disengage due to the designated external input when
the external input is no longer active
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_Mast_
Switch_Allow_
ReEng
2123
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged after
a disengage due to the master switch being turned off
when the master switch is turned on again
Off N/A N/A N/A
SECTION 23 - PAGE 66 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Alarms parameter is turned on, then an alarm will sound in the cab if the PTO is
engaged and the engine speed is over the value set by TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Alarm_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Non_Neut_Alarms parameter is turned on, then an audible alarm will sound in the cab if the PTO
is engaged and the transmission is taken out of neutral.
If TEM_PTO_Pk_Brake_Alarms parameter is turned on, then an audible alarm will sound in the cab if the PTO
is engaged and the park brake is released
If TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Alarms parameter is turned on, then an audible alarm will sound in the cab if the PTO is
engaged and the vehicle speed is about the value set by TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Alarm_Limit.
Table 164
WIRING INFORMATION
Customer must supply and route air plumbing from the Navistar-provided air solenoid (Located inside the
drivers side frame rail, adjacent to the Transmission) to the PTO.
Off Indicates a 0 is set in for this parameter
On Indicates a 1 is set for the parameter
Parameter ID Description Default Min Max Step
TEM_PTO_
Air_Pres_Alarms
2138
If this Parameter is 1, an alarm will sound if the primary
air pressure is below TEM_PTO_Air_
Pres_Alarm_Limit.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_Air_
Pres_Alarm_Limit
2139 See TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Alarms 0 psi 0 500 1
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Run_ Alarms
2137
If this Parameter is 1, an alarm will sound if the PTO is
engaged and the engine is turned off.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Spd_ Alarms
2135
If this Parameter is 1, an alarm will sound if the PTO is
engaged and the engine speed is over
TEM_PTO_Eng_ Spd_Alarm_Limit.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEMP_PTO_Eng_
Spd_Alarm_Limit
2136 See TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Alarms 1400 RPM 0 5000 0.1
TEM_PTO_
Non_Neut_ Alarms
2132
If this Parameter is 1, an alarm will sound if the PTO is
engaged and transmission is taken out of neutral.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Pk_Brake_ Alarms
2131
If this Parameter is 1, an alarm will sound if the PTO is
engaged and the park brake is released
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Veh_Spd_ Alarms
2133
If this Parameter is 1, an alarm will sound if the PTO is
engaged and the vehicle speed is over
TEM_PTO_Veh_ Spd_Alarm_Limit.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_Veh_
Spd_Alarm_Limit
2134 See TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Alarms 5 mph 3 100 1
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 23 - PAGE 67
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
TESTING
1. Depress the In-cab PTO switch to the ON position.
2. Verify that all enabled interlock conditions are met.
3. Verify that the Navistar-provided air solenoid is supplying air pressure at the solenoid output.
HOW TO ADD THIS FEATURE
Software feature codes 595ADD must be added to the truck using the Diamond Logic
Builder software.
If the truck does not already have a 4-pack solenoid base, the customer should order a 4-pack base (part
number 2505594C1) and an air solenoid (part number 2506711C91).
Add wiring as per the Electrical Circuit Diagram Manual S08322, Chapter 10, Chassis Accessories, Air
Solenoid.
13WDN - PTO CONTROL Only for Line Haul and ProStar models, DASH MOUNTED For Customer Provided
PTO; Includes Switch, Electric/Air Solenoid, Piping and Wiring.
REQUIRED SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES
595AEB for post 2007 and pre 2010 clusters - 595BKK or 595BNN is required to be added for 2010 clusters.
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES THAT MUST BE REMOVED
595ADD for post 2007 and pre 2010 clusters 595BKJ or 595BNP is required to be removed for 2010 clusters
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES 595AEB OR 595BKK - PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
* These parameters set the conditions under which the PTO will be engaged and disengaged.
f_136
SECTION 23 - PAGE 68 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
PTOb_Clutch_Pedal Set to 0 to ignore the clutch pedal or if the vehicle does not have a clutch pedal. Set to 1
to ensure that the clutch pedal is depressed for engagement.
PTOb _Engine_Running Set to 0 to ignore the engine. Set to 1 to ensure that the engine is running to
engage and disengage if the engine stops running.
PTOb_Engine_Speed_Range Set to a speed that the engine has to be below for the PTO to engage. The
PTO will disengage if the engine speed becomes greater than the set value. If engine speed is required for
PTO operation, please use PTOb_Engine_Speed_Enable to enable this interlock.
PTOb_Transmission_Neutral NOTE: this parameter will only work for vehicles with automated manual
transmissions. Set to 0 to ignore the transmission state. Set to 1 to ensure that the transmission is in neutral for
engagement.
PTOb_Park_Brake Set to 0 to ignore the park brake. Set to 1 to ensure that the park brake is set for engage
and disengage if the park brake is released.
PTOb_Vehicle_Speed_Range Set to the speed that the vehicle has to be below for the PTO to engage. The
PTO will disengage if the vehicle speed becomes greater than the set value. If vehicle speed is required for
PTO operation, please use PTOb_Vehicle_Speed_Enable parameter to enable this interlock.
PTOb_Engine_Speed_Enable Set to 0 to ignore the engine speed. Set to 1 to require the vehicle to be below
a specified engine speed for the PTO to be engaged. Please use PTOa_Engine_Speed_Range to specify the
appropriate engine speed if this parameter is set to 1.
PTOb_Engine_Speed_Alarm_Enable Set to 0 to not have an alarm based on engine speed. Set to 1 to have
a speed that an alarm will sound when the PTO is engaged and the engine speed is greater than the set value.
Please use PTOa_Engine_Speed_Alarm_Range to specify the appropriate engine speed if this parameter is
set to 1.
PTOb_Vehicle_Speed_Enable Set to 0 to ignore the vehicle speed. Set to 1 to require the vehicle to be below
a specified vehicle speed for the PTO to engage. Please use PTOa_Vehicle_Speed_Range to specify the
appropriate vehicle speed if this parameter is set to 1.
PTOb_Vehicle_Speed_Alarm_Enable _ Set to 0 to not have an alarm based on vehicle speed. Set to 1 to
have a speed limit that an alarm will sound when the PTO is engaged and the vehicle speed is greater than the
set value. Please use PTOb _Vehicle_Speed_Alarm_Range to specify the appropriate vehicle speed if this
parameter is set to 1.
PTOb_Engine_Speed_Alarm_Range Set to the speed that the vehicle has to be below for the PTO to
engage. The PTO will disengage if the vehicle speed becomes greater than the set value. If vehicle speed is
required for PTO operation, please use PTOb_Vehicle_Speed_Enable parameter to enable this interlock.
PTOb_Vehicle_Speed_Alarm_Range - Set to a speed limit that an alarm will sound when the PTO is engaged
and the vehicle speed is greater than the set value. If the vehicle alarm is required for PTO operation, please
use PTOb_Vehicle_Speed_Alarm_Enable to enable this alarm.
PTOa_Vehicle_Speed_Enable Set to 0 to ignore the vehicle speed. Set to 1 to require the vehicle to be below
a specified vehicle speed for the PTO to engage. Please use PTOa_Vehicle_Speed_Range to specify the
appropriate vehicle speed if this parameter is set to 1.
PTOa_Engine_Speed_Enable Set to 0 to ignore the engine speed. Set to 1 to require the vehicle to be below
a specified engine speed for the PTO to be engaged. Please use PTOa_Engine_Speed_Range to specify the
appropriate engine speed if this parameter is set to 1.
PTOa_Engine_Speed_Alarm_Enable Set to 0 to not have an alarm based on engine speed. Set to 1 to have
a speed that an alarm will sound when the PTO is engaged and the engine speed is greater than the set value.
Please use PTOa_Engine_Speed_Alarm_Range to specify the appropriate engine speed if this parameter is
set to 1.
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 23 - PAGE 69
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
PTOa_Vehicle_Speed_Alarm_Enable _ Set to 0 to not have an alarm based on vehicle speed. Set to 1 to
have a speed limit that an alarm will sound when the PTO is engaged and the vehicle speed is greater than the
set value. Please use PTOa_Vehicle_Speed_Alarm_Range to specify the appropriate vehicle speed if this
parameter is set to 1.
PTOa_Clutch_Pedal Set to 0 to ignore the clutch pedal or if the vehicle does not have a clutch pedal. Set to 1
to ensure that the clutch pedal is depressed for engagement.
PTOa_Engine_Running Set to 0 to ignore the engine. Set to 1 to ensure that the engine is running to engage
and disengage if the engine stops running.
PTOa_Engine_Speed_Range Set to a speed that the engine has to be below for the PTO to engage. The
PTO will disengage if the engine speed becomes greater than the set value. If engine speed is required for
PTO operation, please use PTOa_Engine_Speed_Enable to enable this interlock.
PTOa_Park_Brake Set to 0 to ignore the park brake. Set to 1 to ensure that the park brake is set for engage
and disengage if the park brake is released.
PTOa_Vehicle_Speed_Range - Set to the speed that the vehicle has to be below for the PTO to engage. The
PTO will disengage if the vehicle speed becomes greater than the set value. If vehicle speed is required for
PTO operation, please use PTOa_Vehicle_Speed_Enable parameter to enable this interlock.
PTOa_Engine_Speed_Alarm_Range Set to the speed that the vehicle has to be below for the PTO to
engage. The PTO will disengage if the vehicle speed becomes greater than the set value. If vehicle speed is
required for PTO operation, please use PTOa_Vehicle_Speed_Enable parameter to enable this interlock.
PTOa_Vehicle_Speed_Alarm_Range - Set to a speed limit that an alarm will sound when the PTO is engaged
and the vehicle speed is greater than the set value. If the vehicle alarm is required for PTO operation, please
use PTOa_Vehicle_Speed_Alarm_Enable to enable this alarm.
PTOa_Transmission_Neutral NOTE: this parameter will only work for vehicles with automated manual
transmissions. Set to 0 to ignore the transmission state. Set to 1 to ensure that the transmission is in neutral for
engagement.
SECTION 23 - PAGE 70 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
Table 165
Off Indicates a 0 is set in for this parameter
On Indicates a 1 is set for the parameter
Parameter ID Description Default Min Max Step
PTOb_Clutch_Pedal 2017
Set to 1 to ensure that the clutch pedal is
depressed for engagement.
Off N/A N/A N/A
PTOb_Engine_
Running
2018
Set to 1 to ensure that the engine is
running to engage and disengage if the
engine stops running.
On N/A N/A N/A
PTOb_Engine_
Speed_Range
2019
Set to a speed that the engine has to be
below for the PTO to engage. The PTO
will disengage if the engine speed
becomes greater than the set value. If
engine speed is required for PTO
operation, please use
PTOb_Engine_Speed_Enable to enable
this interlock.
300 300 3000 10
PTOb_Transmission
_Neutral
2020
NOTE, this parameter will only work for
vehicles with automated manual
transmissions. Set to 1 to ensure that the
transmission is in neutral for
engagement.
Off N/A N/A N/A
PTOb_Park_Brake 2021
Set to 1 to ensure that the park brake is
set for engage and disengage if the park
brake is released.
On N/A N/A N/A
PTOb_Vehicle_
Speed_Range
2031
Set to the speed that the vehicle has to
be below for the PTO to engage. The
PTO will disengage if the vehicle speed
becomes greater than the set value. If
vehicle speed is required for PTO
operation, please use
PTOb_Vehicle_Speed_Enable parameter
to enable this interlock.
3 3 100 1
PTOb_Engine_
Speed_Enable
2050
Set to 1 to require the vehicle to be below
a specified engine speed for the PTO to
be engaged. Please use
PTOb_Engine_Speed_Range to specify
the appropriate engine speed if this
parameter is set to 1.
On N/A N/A N/A
PTOb_Engine_
Speed_Alarm
2051
Set to 1 to have a speed that an alarm
will sound when the PTO is engaged and
the engine speed is greater than the set
value. Please use
PTOb_Engine_Speed_Alarm_Range to
specify the appropriate engine speed if
this parameter is set to 1.
Off N/A N/A N/A
PTOb_Vehicle_
Speed_Enable
2052
Set to 1 to require the vehicle to be below
a specified vehicle speed for the PTO to
engage. Please use
PTOb_Vehicle_Speed_Range to specify
the appropriate vehicle speed if this
parameter is set to 1.
On N/A N/A N/A
PTOb_Vehicle_
Speed_Alarm_
Enable
2053
Set to 1 to have a speed limit that an
alarm will sound when the PTO is
engaged and the vehicle speed is greater
than the set value. Please use
PTOb_Vehicle_Speed_Alarm_Range to
specify the appropriate vehicle speed if
this parameter is set to 1.
Off N/A N/A N/A
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 23 - PAGE 71
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
PTOb_Engine_
Speed_Alarm_
Range
2140
Set to a speed that an alarm will sound
when the PTO is engaged and the engine
speed is greater than the set value. If an
engine speed alarm is required for PTO
operation, please use
PTOb_Engine_Speed_Alarm_Enable
parameter to enable this alarm.
300 300 3000 10
PTOb_Vehicle_
Speed_Alarm_
Range
2141
Set to a speed limit that an alarm will
sound when the PTO is engaged and the
vehicle speed is greater than the set
value. If the vehicle alarm is required for
PTO operation, please use
PTOb_Vehicle_Speed_Alarm_Enable to
enable this alarm.
3 3 100 1
PTOa_Vehicle_
Speed_Enable
2242
Set to 1 to require the vehicle to be below
a specified vehicle speed for the PTO to
engage. Please use
PTOa_Vehicle_Speed_Range to specify
the appropriate vehicle speed if this
parameter is set to 1..
On N/A N/A N/A
PTOa_Engine_
Speed_Enable
2243
Set to 1 to require the vehicle to be below
a specified engine speed for the PTO to
be engaged. Please use
PTOa_Engine_Speed_Range to specify
the appropriate engine speed if this
parameter is set to 1.
Off N/A N/A N/A
PTOa_Engine_
Speed_Alarm_
Enable
2244
Set to 1 to have a speed that an alarm
will sound when the PTO is engaged and
the engine speed is greater than the set
value. Please use
PTOa_Engine_Speed_Alarm_Range to
specify the appropriate engine speed if
this parameter is set to 1.
Off N/A N/A N/A
Vehicle_Speed_
Alarm_Enable PTOa
2267
Set to 1 to have a speed limit that an
alarm will sound when the PTO is
engaged and the vehicle speed is greater
than the set value. Please use
PTOa_Vehicle_Speed_Alarm_Range to
specify the appropriate vehicle speed if
this parameter is set to 1.
Off N/A N/A N/A
PTOa_Clutch_
Pedal
2333
Set to 1 to ensure that the clutch pedal is
depressed for engagement.
Off N/A N/A N/A
PTOa_Engine_
Running
2334
Set to 1 to ensure that the engine is
running to engage and disengage if the
engine stops running.
Off N/A N/A N/A
PTOa_Engine_
Speed_Range
2336
Set to a speed that the engine has to be
below for the PTO to engage. The PTO
will disengage if the engine speed
becomes greater than the set value. If
engine speed is required for PTO
operation, please use
PTOa_Engine_Speed_Enable to enable
this interlock.
300 300 3000 10
PTOa_Park_Brake 2338
Set to 1 to ensure that the park brake is
set for engage and disengage if the park
brake is released.
On N/A N/A N/A
Off Indicates a 0 is set in for this parameter
On Indicates a 1 is set for the parameter
Parameter ID Description Default Min Max Step
SECTION 23 - PAGE 72 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES
595BNN (2010 Clusters, 42 Parameters)
PARAMETERS
ENGAGEMENT
These parameters set rules that must be met in order for the PTO to be engaged.
If TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, the PTO cannot be engaged if the primary
vehicle air pressure is below the programmable parameter set by TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Engmnt_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Brake_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the brake pedal must be depressed in order
for the PTO to engage.
If TEM_PTO_Cltch_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the clutch pedal must be depressed for the
PTO to engage.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Run_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the engine has to be running in order for
the PTO to be engaged.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the PTO cannot be engaged if the engine
speed is over a certain threshold, which is defined as a programmable parameter in
TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Engmnt_Limit
If TEM_PTO_Neut_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the PTO can only be engaged if the
transmission is NOT in Neutral or Park.
If TEM_PTO_Non_Neut_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the transmission must be in Neutral or
Park for the PTO to be engaged.
If TEM_PTO_Pk_Brake_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the park brake must be set in order for the
PTO to be engaged.
If TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the PTO cannot be engaged if the vehicle
speed is over the value prescribed by TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Engmnt_Limit.
PTOa_Vehicle_
Speed_Range
2339
Set to the speed that the vehicle has to
be below for the PTO to engage. The
PTO will disengage if the vehicle speed
becomes greater than the set value. If
vehicle speed is required for PTO
operation, please use
PTOa_Vehicle_Speed_Enable parameter
to enable this interlock.
3 3 100 1
PTOa_Engine_
Speed_Alarm_
Range
2340
If an engine speed alarm is required for
PTO operation, please use
PTOa_Engine_Speed_Alarm_Enable
parameter to enable this alarm.
300 300 3000 10
PTOa_Vehicle_
Speed_Alarm_
Range
2342
Set to a speed limit that an alarm will
sound when the PTO is engaged and the
vehicle speed is greater than the set
value. If the vehicle alarm is required for
PTO operation, please use
PTOa_Vehicle_Speed_Alarm_Enable to
enable this alarm.
3 3 100 1
PTOa_
Transmission_
Neutral
2355
NOTE, this parameter will only work for
vehicles with automated manual
transmissions. Set to 1 to ensure that
the transmission is in neutral for
engagement.
On N/A N/A N/A
Off Indicates a 0 is set in for this parameter
On Indicates a 1 is set for the parameter
Parameter ID Description Default Min Max Step
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 23 - PAGE 73
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
If TEM_PTO_Mast_Switch_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the PTO will not be engaged if the
vehicle master switch is not ON.
If TEM_PTOb_Air_Pres_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, the PTO cannot be engaged if the primary
vehicle air pressure is below the programmable parameter set by TEM_PTOb_Air_Pres_Engmnt_Limit.
If TEM_PTOb_Brake_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the brake pedal must be depressed in order
for the PTO to engage.
If TEM_PTOb_Cltch_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the clutch pedal must be depressed for the
PTO to engage.
If TEM_PTOb_Eng_Run_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the engine has to be running in order for
the PTO to be engaged.
If TEM_PTOb_Eng_Spd_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the PTO cannot be engaged if the engine
speed is over a certain threshold, which is defined as a programmable parameter in
TEM_PTOb_Eng_Spd_Engmnt_Limit
If TEM_PTOb_Neut_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the PTO can only be engaged if the
transmission is NOT in Neutral or Park.
If TEM_PTOb_Non_Neut_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the transmission must be in Neutral or
Park for the PTO to be engaged.
If TEM_PTOb_Pk_Brake_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the park brake must be set in order for
the PTO to be engaged.
If TEM_PTOb_Veh_Spd_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the PTO cannot be engaged if the vehicle
speed is over the value prescribed by TEM_PTOb_Veh_Spd_Engmnt_Limit.
If TEM_PTOb_Mast_Switch_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the PTO will not be engaged if the
vehicle master switch is not ON.
SECTION 23 - PAGE 74 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
Table 166
Off Indicates a 0 is set in for this parameter
On Indicates a 1 is set for the parameter
Parameter ID Description Default Min Max Step
TEM_PTO_
Air_Pres_
Engmnt_Inhib
2097
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be
engaged if the primary vehicle air
pressure is below TEM_PTO_Air_
Pres_Engmnt_ Limit
On N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Air_Pres_
Engmnt_Limit
2098
See TEM_PTO_Air_ Pres_Engmnt_
Inhib
90 psi 1 500 1
TEM_PTO_
Brake_Engmnt_
Inhib
2095
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be
engaged if the brake pedal is not
depressed
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Cltch_Engmnt_
Inhib
2094
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be
engaged when the clutch pedal is not
depressed
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Run_
Engmnt_Inhib
2096
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be
engaged if the engine is not running
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Spd_
Engmnt_Inhib
2092
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be
engaged if the engine speed is over the
value set in TEM_PTO_Eng_
Spd_Engmnt_ Limit
On N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Spd_
Engmnt_Limit
2093
See TEM_PTO_Eng_ Spd_Engmnt_
Inhib
1000 RPM 100 5000 1
TEM_PTO_
Neut_Engmnt_ Inhib
2089
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will only
be engaged if the Transmission is not in
Neutral or Park
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Non_Neut_
Engmnt_Inhib
2088
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be
engaged if the Transmission is not in
Neutral or Park
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_Pk_
Brake_Engmnt_
Inhib
2087
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be
engaged if the Park Brake is not set.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Veh_Spd_
Engmnt_Inhib
2090
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be
engaged if the vehicle speed is over the
value set in TEM_PTO_Veh_
Spd_Engmnt_ Limit
On N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Veh_Spd_
Engmnt_Limit
2091
See TEM_PTO_Veh_ Spd_Engmnt_
Inhib
3 MPH 1 100 1
TEM_PTO_Mast_
Switch_Engmnt_
Inhib
2099
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be
engaged if the vehicle master switch is
not ON
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTOb_
Air_Pres_
Engmnt_Inhib
2711
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be
engaged if the primary vehicle air
pressure is below TEM_PTO_Air_
Pres_Engmnt_ Limit
On N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTOb_
Air_Pres_
Engmnt_Limit
2712
See TEM_PTO_Air_ Pres_Engmnt_
Inhib
90 psi 1 500 1
TEM_PTO_
Brake_Engmnt_
Inhib
2676
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be
engaged if the brake pedal is not
depressed
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTOb_
Cltch_Engmnt_
Inhib
2677
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be
engaged when the clutch pedal is not
depressed
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTOb_
Eng_Run_
Engmnt_Inhib
2678
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be
engaged if the engine is not running
Off N/A N/A N/A
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 23 - PAGE 75
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
DISENGAGEMENT
These parameters set the conditions under which the PTO will be disengaged.
If TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the primary air
pressure is below the value set in TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_DisEng_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Run_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the engine is
turned off.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the engine
speed rises above the value set by TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_DisEng_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_ Non_Neut _Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the
transmission is taken out of neutral.
If TEM_PTO_Pk_Brake_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the Park Brake
is released.
If TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the vehicle
speed is over the valued specified by TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_DisEng_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Ext_Input_Disengages is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the external input
designated for this purpose is active.
If TEM_PTO_Mast_Switch_Disengages is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the vehicle master
switch is not ON.
If TEM_PTOb_Air_Pres_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the primary air
pressure is below the value set in TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_DisEng_Limit.
If TEM_PTOb_Eng_Run_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the engine is
turned off.
TEM_PTOb_
Eng_Spd_
Engmnt_Inhib
2679
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be
engaged if the engine speed is over the
value set in TEM_PTO_Eng_
Spd_Engmnt_ Limit
On N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTOb_
Eng_Spd_
Engmnt_Limit
2680
See TEM_PTO_Eng_ Spd_Engmnt_
Inhib
1000 RPM 100 5000 1
TEM_PTOb_
Neut_Engmnt_
Inhib
2681
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will only
be engaged if the Transmission is not in
Neutral or Park
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTOb_
Non_Neut_
Engmnt_Inhib
2682
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be
engaged if the Transmission is not in
Neutral or Park
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTOb_Pk_
Brake_Engmnt_
Inhib
2683
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be
engaged if the Park Brake is not set.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTOb_
Veh_Spd_
Engmnt_Inhib
2684
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be
engaged if the vehicle speed is over the
value set in TEM_PTO_Veh_
Spd_Engmnt_ Limit
On N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTOb_
Veh_Spd_
Engmnt_Limit
2685
See TEM_PTO_Veh_ Spd_Engmnt_
Inhib
3 MPH 1 100 1
TEM_PTOb_Mast_
Switch_Engmnt_
Inhib
2714
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be
engaged if the vehicle master switch is
not ON
Off N/A N/A N/A
Off Indicates a 0 is set in for this parameter
On Indicates a 1 is set for the parameter
Parameter ID Description Default Min Max Step
SECTION 23 - PAGE 76 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
If TEM_PTOb_Eng_Spd_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the engine
speed rises above the value set by TEM_PTOb_Eng_Spd_DisEng_Limit.
If TEM_PTOb_ Non_Neut _Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the
transmission is taken out of neutral.
If TEM_PTOb_Pk_Brake_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the Park
Brake is released.
If TEM_PTOb_Veh_Spd_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the vehicle
speed is over the valued specified by TEM_PTOb_Veh_Spd_DisEng_Limit.
If TEM_PTOb_Ext_Input_Disengages is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the external input
designated for this purpose is active.
If TEM_PTOb_Mast_Switch_Disengages is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the vehicle master
switch is not ON.
Table 167
Off Indicates a 0 is set in for this parameter
On Indicates a 1 is set for the parameter
Parameter ID Description Default Min Max Step
TEM_PTO_
Air_Pres_
DisEng_Limit
2116 See TEM_PTO_Air_ Pres_Disengages 80 psi 0 500 1
TEM_PTO_
Air_Pres_
Disengages
2115
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
disengaged if the primary air pressure is
below the value set in TEM_PTO_Air_
Pres_DisEng_ Limit.
On N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Run_
Disengages
2114
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
disengaged if the engine is turned off.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Spd_
DisEng_Limit
2113 See TEM_PTO_ Eng_Spd_ Disengages 1800 RPM 0 5000 1
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Spd_
Disengages
2112
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
disengaged if the engine speed is over
the value set in TEM_PTO_Eng_
Spd_DisEng_ Limit
On N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Non_Neut_
Disengages
2109
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
disengaged if the transmission is taken
out of neutral.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Pk_Brake_
Disengages
2108
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
disengaged if the Park Brake is released.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Veh_Spd_
Disengages
2110
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
disengaged if the vehicle speed is over
the value set in TEM_PTO_Veh_
Spd_DisEng_ Limit.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Veh_Spd_
DisEng_Limit
2111 See TEM_PTO_Veh_ Spd_Disengages 0 MPH 3 100 1
TEM_PTO_Ext_
Input_Disengages
2117
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
disengaged if the external input
designated for this purpose is active
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_Mast_
Switch_Disengages
2118
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
disengaged if the vehicle master switch is
not ON
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTOb_
Air_Pres_
DisEng_Limit
2719 See TEM_PTO_Air_ Pres_Disengages 80 psi 0 500 1
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 23 - PAGE 77
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
RE-ENGAGEMENT
These parameters set the conditions under which the PTO can be reengaged.
If TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to low air pressure) when the primary air pressure rises about the value specified by
TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Engmnt_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Run_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to engine stopping) when the engine is restarted.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to engine overspeed) when the engine speed falls below
TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Engmnt_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Key_State_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be allowed to reengage when
the key state is returned to run.
If TEM_PTO_Non_Neut_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to transmission out of neutral) when the transmission is placed back into neutral.
If TEM_PTO_Pk_Brake_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to park brake released) when the park brake is reapplied.
TEM_PTOb_
Air_Pres_
Disengages
2716
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
disengaged if the primary air pressure is
below the value set in TEM_PTO_Air_
Pres_DisEng_ Limit.
On N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTOb_
Eng_Run_
Disengages
2686
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
disengaged if the engine is turned off.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTOb_
Eng_Spd_
DisEng_Limit
2687 See TEM_PTO_ Eng_Spd_ Disengages 1800 RPM 0 5000 1
TEM_PTOb_
Eng_Spd_
Disengages
2688
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
disengaged if the engine speed is over
the value set in TEM_PTO_Eng_
Spd_DisEng_ Limit
On N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTOb_
Non_Neut_
Disengages
2689
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
disengaged if the transmission is taken
out of neutral.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTOb_
Pk_Brake_
Disengages
2690
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
disengaged if the Park Brake is released.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTOb_
Veh_Spd_
Disengages
2691
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
disengaged if the vehicle speed is over
the value set in TEM_PTO_Veh_
Spd_DisEng_ Limit.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTOb_
Veh_Spd_
DisEng_Limit
2692 See TEM_PTO_Veh_ Spd_Disengages 0 MPH 3 100 1
TEM_PTOb_Ext_
Input_Disengages
2772
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
disengaged if the external input
designated for this purpose is active
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTOb_Mast_
Switch_Disengages
2718
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
disengaged if the vehicle master switch is
not ON
Off N/A N/A N/A
Off Indicates a 0 is set in for this parameter
On Indicates a 1 is set for the parameter
Parameter ID Description Default Min Max Step
SECTION 23 - PAGE 78 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
If TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to the vehicle being over the vehicle speed value) when the vehicle speed falls below
TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Engmnt_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Ext_Input_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after a
disengage due to the designated external input being in active state) when the external input is no longer in
active state.
If TEM_PTO_Mast_Switch_Allow_ReEng is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged after a disengage due
to the master switch being turned off when the master switch is turned on again.
If TEM_PTOb_Air_Pres_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to low air pressure) when the primary air pressure rises about the value specified by
TEM_PTOb_Air_Pres_Engmnt_Limit.
If TEM_PTOb_Eng_Run_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to engine stopping) when the engine is restarted.
If TEM_PTOb_Eng_Spd_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to engine overspeed) when the engine speed falls below
TEM_PTOb_Eng_Spd_Engmnt_Limit.
If TEM_PTOb_Key_State_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be allowed to reengage
when the key state is returned to run.
If TEM_PTOb_Non_Neut_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to transmission out of neutral) when the transmission is placed back into neutral.
If TEM_PTOb_Pk_Brake_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to park brake released) when the park brake is reapplied.
If TEM_PTOb_Veh_Spd_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to the vehicle being over the vehicle speed value) when the vehicle speed falls below
TEM_PTOb_Veh_Spd_Engmnt_Limit.
If TEM_PTOb_Ext_Input_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after a
disengage due to the designated external input being in active state) when the external input is no longer in
active state.
If TEM_PTOb_Mast_Switch_Allow_ReEng is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged after a disengage due
to the master switch being turned off when the master switch is turned on again.
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 23 - PAGE 79
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
Table 168
Off Indicates a 0 is set in for this parameter
On Indicates a 1 is set for the parameter
Parameter ID Description Default Min Max Step
TEM_PTO_
Air_Pres_
Allow_ReEng
2124
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
reengaged after disengagement due to
low vehicle air pressure when the primary
air pressure is over TEM_PTO_Air_
Pres_Engmnt_ Limit.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Run_
Allow_ReEng
2122
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
reengaged after disengagement due to
the engine stopping when the engine is
restarted.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Spd_
Allow_ReEng
2120
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
reengaged after disengagement due to
engine overspeed when the engine
speed is below TEM_PTO_Eng_
Spd_Engmnt_ Limit.
On N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Key_State_
Allow_ReEng
2069
If this parameter is set, the PTO will be
allowed to reengage when the key state
is returned to run.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Non_Neut_
Allow_ReEng
2148
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
reengaged after disengagement due to
transmission out of neutral when the
transmission is placed back into neutral.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Pk_Brake_
Allow_ReEng
2149
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
reengaged after disengagement due to
park brake released when the park brake
is reapplied.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Veh_Spd_
Allow_ReEng
2119
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
reengaged after disengagement due to
vehicle overspeed when the vehicle
speed is below TEM_PTO_Veh_
Spd_Engmnt_ Limit.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_Ext_
Input_Allow_ReEng
2121
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
reengaged after a disengage due to the
designated external input when the
external input is no longer active
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_Mast_
Switch_Allow_
ReEng
2123
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
reengaged after a disengage due to the
master switch being turned off when the
master switch is turned on again
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTOb_
Air_Pres_
Allow_ReEng
2713
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
reengaged after disengagement due to
low vehicle air pressure when the primary
air pressure is over TEM_PTO_Air_
Pres_Engmnt_ Limit.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTOb_
Eng_Run_
Allow_ReEng
2693
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
reengaged after disengagement due to
the engine stopping when the engine is
restarted.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTOb_
Eng_Spd_
Allow_ReEng
2694
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
reengaged after disengagement due to
engine overspeed when the engine
speed is below TEM_PTO_Eng_
Spd_Engmnt_ Limit.
On N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTOb_
Key_State_
Allow_ReEng
2696
If this parameter is set, the PTO will be
allowed to reengage when the key state
is returned to run.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTOb_
Non_Neut_
Allow_ReEng
2697
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
reengaged after disengagement due to
transmission out of neutral when the
transmission is placed back into neutral.
Off N/A N/A N/A
SECTION 23 - PAGE 80 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
ALARMS
These parameters utilize the gauge cluster to sound an alarm to the driver when certain programmable
parameters are violated.
If TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Alarms parameter is turned on, then an audible alarm will sound in the cab if the
primary air pressure drops below the value specified by TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Alarm_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Run_Alarms parameter is turned on, then an audible alarm will sound in the cab if the PTO
is engaged and the engine is turned off.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Alarms parameter is turned on, then an alarm will sound in the cab if the PTO is
engaged and the engine speed is over the value set by TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Alarm_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Non_Neut_Alarms parameter is turned on, then an audible alarm will sound in the cab if the PTO
is engaged and the transmission is taken out of neutral.
If TEM_PTO_Pk_Brake_Alarms parameter is turned on, then an audible alarm will sound in the cab if the PTO
is engaged and the park brake is released
If TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Alarms parameter is turned on, then an audible alarm will sound in the cab if the PTO is
engaged and the vehicle speed is about the value set by TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Alarm_Limit.
If TEM_PTOb_Air_Pres_Alarms parameter is turned on, then an audible alarm will sound in the cab if the
primary air pressure drops below the value specified by TEM_PTOb_Air_Pres_Alarm_Limit.
If TEM_PTOb_Eng_Run_Alarms parameter is turned on, then an audible alarm will sound in the cab if the PTO
is engaged and the engine is turned off.
If TEM_PTOb_Eng_Spd_Alarms parameter is turned on, then an alarm will sound in the cab if the PTO is
engaged and the engine speed is over the value set by TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Alarm_Limit.
If TEM_PTOb_Non_Neut_Alarms parameter is turned on, then an audible alarm will sound in the cab if the
PTO is engaged and the transmission is taken out of neutral.
If TEM_PTOb_Pk_Brake_Alarms parameter is turned on, then an audible alarm will sound in the cab if the PTO
is engaged and the park brake is released
If TEM_PTOb_Veh_Spd_Alarms parameter is turned on, then an audible alarm will sound in the cab if the PTO
is engaged and the vehicle speed is about the value set by TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Alarm_Limit.
TEM_PTOb_
Pk_Brake_
Allow_ReEng
2698
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
reengaged after disengagement due to
park brake released when the park brake
is reapplied.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTOb_
Veh_Spd_
Allow_ReEng
2699
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
reengaged after disengagement due to
vehicle overspeed when the vehicle
speed is below TEM_PTO_Veh_
Spd_Engmnt_ Limit.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTOb_Ext_
Input_Allow_ReEng
2771
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
reengaged after a disengage due to the
designated external input when the
external input is no longer active
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTOb_Mast_
Switch_Allow_
ReEng
2715
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
reengaged after a disengage due to the
master switch being turned off when the
master switch is turned on again
Off N/A N/A N/A
Off Indicates a 0 is set in for this parameter
On Indicates a 1 is set for the parameter
Parameter ID Description Default Min Max Step
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 23 - PAGE 81
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
Table 169
WIRING INFORMATION
Customer must supply and route air plumbing from the Navistar-provided air solenoid (Located inside the
drivers side frame rail, adjacent to the Transmission) to the PTO.
Off Indicates a 0 is set in for this parameter
On Indicates a 1 is set for the parameter
Parameter ID Description Default Min Max Step
TEM_PTO_
Air_Pres_ Alarms
2138
If this Parameter is 1, an alarm will sound
if the primary air pressure is below
TEM_PTO_Air_ Pres_Alarm_Limit.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_Air_Pres
_Alarm_Limit
2139 See TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Alarms 0 psi 0 500 1
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Run_ Alarms
2137
If this Parameter is 1, an alarm will sound
if the PTO is engaged and the engine is
turned off.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Spd_ Alarms
2135
If this Parameter is 1, an alarm will sound
if the PTO is engaged and the engine
speed is over TEM_PTO_Eng_
Spd_Alarm_Limit.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEMP_PTO_Eng_
Spd_Alarm_Limit
2136 See TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Alarms 1400 RPM 0 5000 0.1
TEM_PTO_
Non_Neut_ Alarms
2132
If this Parameter is 1, an alarm will sound
if the PTO is engaged and transmission
is taken out of neutral.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Pk_Brake_ Alarms
2131
If this Parameter is 1, an alarm will sound
if the PTO is engaged and the park brake
is released
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_
Veh_Spd_ Alarms
2133
If this Parameter is 1, an alarm will sound
if the PTO is engaged and the vehicle
speed is over TEM_PTO_Veh_
Spd_Alarm_Limit.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTO_Veh_
Spd_Alarm_Limit
2134 See TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Alarms 5 mph 3 100 1
TEM_PTOb_
Air_Pres_ Alarms
2700
If this Parameter is 1, an alarm will sound
if the primary air pressure is below
TEM_PTO_Air_ Pres_Alarm_Limit.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTOb_Air_
Pres_Alarm_Limit
2701 See TEM_PTOb_Air_Pres_Alarms 0 psi 0 500 1
TEM_PTOb_
Eng_Run_ Alarms
2702
If this Parameter is 1, an alarm will sound
if the PTO is engaged and the engine is
turned off.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTOb_
Eng_Spd_ Alarms
2704
If this Parameter is 1, an alarm will sound
if the PTO is engaged and the engine
speed is over TEM_PTO_Eng_
Spd_Alarm_Limit.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEMP_PTOb_Eng_
Spd_Alarm_Limit
2703 See TEM_PTOb_Eng_Spd_Alarms 1400 RPM 0 5000 0.1
TEM_PTOb_
Non_Neut_ Alarms
2705
If this Parameter is 1, an alarm will sound
if the PTO is engaged and transmission
is taken out of neutral.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTOb_
Pk_Brake_ Alarms
2706
If this Parameter is 1, an alarm will sound
if the PTO is engaged and the park brake
is released
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTOb_
Veh_Spd_ Alarms
2708
If this Parameter is 1, an alarm will sound
if the PTO is engaged and the vehicle
speed is over TEM_PTO_Veh_
Spd_Alarm_Limit.
Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_PTOb_Veh_
Spd_Alarm_Limit
2709 See TEM_PTOb_Veh_Spd_Alarms 5 mph 3 100 1
SECTION 23 - PAGE 82 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
TESTING
1. Depress the In-cab PTO 1 or PTO 2 switch to the ON position.
2. Verify that all enabled interlock conditions are met.
3. Verify that the Navistar-provided air solenoid is supplying air pressure at the solenoid output.
HOW TO ADD THIS FEATURE
Software feature codes 595AEB must be added to the truck using the Diamond Logic
Builder software.
If the truck does not already have a 4-pack solenoid base, the customer should order a 4-pack base (part
number 2505594C1) and two air solenoids (part number 2506711C91).
Add wiring as per the Electrical Circuit Diagram Manual S08322, Chapter 10, Chassis Accessories, Air
Solenoid.
f_137
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 23 - PAGE 83
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
PTO HOURMETER
16WLM
HOURMETER, PTO for Customer Provided PTO; Indicator Light and Hourmeter in Gauge Cluster Includes
Return Wire for PTO Feedback Switch
This feature provides the customer with a wire (Circuit K88B 14 gauge, light green cut blunt located in the
transmission harness) to be wired into a PTO body builder-installed feedback switch. Also included in this
feature is a PTO indicator light in the gauge cluster and a PTO hourmeter, which allows the operator to
measure stationary PTO hours for maintenance records and fuel tax purposes. To view the hourmeter, press
the gauge cluster selection button momentarily until the text portion of the display indicates PTO Hour.
This feature cannot be used if 16HGJ (Optional Transmission Oil Temperature Gauge for a MANUAL
Transmission) is utilized.
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES THAT MUST BE ADDED
595AJU and (595AYN, for pre-2010 OR 595BJT for post-2010)
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES THAT MUST NOT BE ENABLED
595AEW
The BC_PTO_Engaged_Param parameter defines the voltage that will be read as the active state for the PTO
engagement feedback switch.
0 = Input active when open circuit
1 = Input active when grounded
3 = Input active when at 12V
Table 170
WIRING INFORMATION
The customer must wire the Navistar-provided PTO engagement feedback return wire (14 gauge, Light Green)
into the PTO feedback switch which should be a GND active switch.
Off Indicates a 0 is set in for this parameter
On Indicates a 1 is set for the parameter
Parameter ID Description Default Min Max Step
BC_PTO_
Engaged_ Param
2199 Active State for the PTO engagement feedback switch. No_Units N/A NA NA
SECTION 23 - PAGE 84 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
(PTO) POWER TAKE OFF
TESTING
1. Customer should apply the correct active state voltage (as programmed in the Diamond Logic
Builder
software) to the Navistar-provided PTO engagement feedback wire.
2. Verify that the PTO indicator light in the gauge cluster comes on and stays on as long as the active state
voltage is applied.
HOW TO ADD THIS FEATURE
The customer must enable software feature code 595AJU and 595AYN using the Diamond Logic
Builder
software.
The customer must make sure that software feature code 595AEW is NOT enabled using the Diamond
Logic
Builder software.
The customer must set BC_PTO_Engaged_Param to desired active state for the PTO feedback switch.
When adding this feature to a vehicle, alternate wiring methods must be performed. It is not possible to add
a wire to connector 1702 pin 13 as described by the electrical circuit diagram manual. The dash panel
grommet is sealed, and additional wires may not be added.
In order to add this feature, connect an 18 gauge wire to the PTO feedback switch, and terminate it in an
open wire terminal cavity in connector 1700 or 1701.
Add another 18 gauge wire in the corresponding cavity on the cab harness connector, and terminate it in the
BC Connector 1600 terminal pin B7.
f_138
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 24 - PAGE 1
REMOTE ENGINE SPEED CONTROL
FEATURES
REMOTE ENGINE SPEED CONTROL FEATURES
REMOTE MOUNTED ENGINE CONTROL
12VXY
ENGINE CONTROL, REMOTE MOUNTED Provisions for: Includes module and connector for Body Builder
installation of remote engine speed control with SAE J1939 communication with MaxxForce electronic engines.
12VZA
ENGINE CONTROL, REMOTE MOUNTED Provision for, Includes Wiring for Body Builder Installation of PTO
Controls, With Ignition Switch Control for International
post 2007 emission electronic engines. This feature provides 13 blunt-cut wires on the V8 and 2
connectors on the I6 in the engine compartment above the steering shaft. These wires can be spliced to Body
Builder-supplied switches and throttle control devices to control the engine speed.
There are no programmable Body Controller (BC) parameters that are used by this function. The
programmable parameters are located in the ECM of the engine.
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
No BC features
For proper ECM parameter programming, see the Body Builder book CT-471 PBB-71000.
WIRING INFORMATION
The new connector associated with sales feature code 12VZA is illustrated below. The connector can be
located in the engine compartment near the megafuse above the driver side wheel well.
SECTION 24 - PAGE 14 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
REMOTE ENGINE SPEED CONTROL
FEATURES
TESTING
12VZA & 12VZB is tested and programmable parameters are set via the Master Diagnostics or ServiceMaxx
Software package.
If the Engine Harness is not provided, the following diagrams show how to hard-wire this feature.
ECM Engine Harness
f_150
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 24 - PAGE 15
REMOTE ENGINE SPEED CONTROL
FEATURES
12VZA & 12VZB WIRING INFORMATION
12VZA & 12VZB Hard Wire ECM Engine Control Overview
Diagram
f_151
SECTION 24 - PAGE 16 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
REMOTE ENGINE SPEED CONTROL
FEATURES
12VZA AND 12VZB CIRCUIT DIAGRAM AND PIN LOCATIONS
12VZA and 12VZB Circuit Diagram and Pin Locations
(Reference Table for Preset Throttle, Variable Throttle,
Split Shft Operations, and Remote Throttle)
f_152
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 24 - PAGE 17
REMOTE ENGINE SPEED CONTROL
FEATURES
PRESET THROTTLE INFORMATION
Remote Installation for Preset Engine Control Using the Hard Wired ECM
Inputs
f_153
SECTION 24 - PAGE 18 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
REMOTE ENGINE SPEED CONTROL
FEATURES
VARIABLE THROTTLE INFORMATION
Remote Installation for Engine Control Using the Hard Wired ECM
Inputs
f_154
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 24 - PAGE 19
REMOTE ENGINE SPEED CONTROL
FEATURES
SPLIT SHAFT OPERATION WITH VARIABLE THROTTLE
Remote Throttle Installation for Split Shaft Control Using the
Hard Wire ECM Inputs
f_155
SECTION 24 - PAGE 20 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
REMOTE ENGINE SPEED CONTROL
FEATURES
REMOTE THROTTLE PEDAL
Remote Throttle Installation with a Remote Throttle Pedal
Cotnrol Using the Hard Wire ECM Inputs
f_156
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 24 - PAGE 21
REMOTE ENGINE SPEED CONTROL
FEATURES
REMOTE THROTTLE CONTROL INTERLOCKED TO PARK BRAKE APPLIED
RECOMMENDED APPLICATION: RECOVERY
60AJA
BDY INTG, THROTTLE CONTROL Accommodation for Single Customer-Mounted External Engine Speed
Control Switch, Programmable Mode for Various Switch Actions and Engine Speed Control Option; Useable
Only While Vehicle is Stopped and the Park Brake is Applied (requires one Remote Power Module (RPM)
input)
Truck Equipment Manufacturer (TEM) or customer-mounted single remote center stable, momentary switch;
when the operator moves the switch to the up position, the switch supplies 12 volts to the RPM input to activate
Remote engine speed control preset-1; when the operator returns the switch to the center position or stable
position, the engine will remain at preset-1 until the operator moves the switch to the down position; in the down
position, the switch then supplies a Ground (GND) to the RPM input to deactivate Remote engine speed control
preset-1; when the operator returns the switch to the center position or stable position, the engine will remain at
idle.
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
REQUIRED SOFTWARE FEATURE CODE
595AKJ
CONFLICTS WITH SOFTWARE FEATURES
595AKK, 595AKL, 595AKM, 595AKN
ACTIVATION PARAMETERS:
1. Momentary 12 volt input to RPM
2. Park brake applied
3. Transmission in neutral or park or clutch pedal not depressed
4. Vehicle speed is less than one MPH
5. Engine running and at idle
6. Optional PTO feedback is true.
DEACTIVATION PARAMETERS:
1. Momentary GND input to RPM
2. Park brake not applied
3. Transmission not in neutral or park or clutch pedal depressed
4. Vehicle speed is greater than one MPH.
5. Engine not running
6. Service brake depressed
7. Optional PTO feedback not true
FEATURE ORDERING NOTES
1. This feature requires one RPM input.
2. If 60AJA is ordered, 12VXU must also be ordered which requires entering TEM or customer-requested
Remote engine speed control preset-1 RPMs.
3. TEM or customer must supply single pull, double throw, center stable, momentary switch and all associated
wiring from switch to RPM.
SECTION 24 - PAGE 22 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
REMOTE ENGINE SPEED CONTROL
FEATURES
4. The optional PTO interlock is defaulted off; this interlock only works with International
pre-engineered
PTO features. If the TEM or customer has one of the International
Builder to install Body Controller (BC) software feature code 595AKJ, and set the
feature code parameters to the following settings:
a. 595AKJ Set parameter 2035 to 1. Reference feature configuration programmable parameters.
b. 595AKJ Set parameter 2158 to 3. Reference feature configuration programmable parameters.
c. 595AKJ Set parameter 2036 to on for optional PTO interlock. Reference feature configuration
programmable parameters.
2. Use Diamond Logic
pre-engineered
PTO features that use a center panel switch. This means that the remote engine speed control will only be
allowed to operate if the PTO is being requested to engage. If this parameter is not set, the engine speed
control will operate regardless of the PTO request.
a. On
b. Off
2. 2035 TEM_Ext_Eng_Spd_Control_Mode; This parameter sets the mode of operation for the TEM external
engine speed control feature and should be set to 1.
a. 1, 12 volts on the engine speed control input causes engine to ramp to preset-1. GND on the same input
causes the engine to return to idle.
3. 2158 TEM_Ext_ Eng_Spd_ Ctrl_Active_State; This is the active state for the external engine speed control
switch input to the RPM and should be set to 3.
a. 3, 12 volts The input is connected to 12 volts through a switch.
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 24 - PAGE 23
REMOTE ENGINE SPEED CONTROL
FEATURES
Table 162
HARDWARE INSTALLATION
1. Reference the connectors tab within Diamond Logic
Builder to force
the RPM input pin to the 12 volt state.
2. Verify the RPM input labeled Remote_Engine_Speed_Sw_Input (pin position specified Diamond Logic
Builder software) is receiving GND as long as the switch is closed.
3. Verify that the engine ramps to the first preset speed.
4. If engine does not ramp to the first preset speed, check engine programming to verify that the correct
engine speed control parameters are set.
5. Deactivate the remote engine speed control switch (release GND).
6. Verify the RPM input labeled Remote_Engine_Speed_Sw_Input (pin position specified Diamond Logic
Builder software) is an open circuit when switch is in the center stable position.
7. Verify that the engine returns to idle.
f_157
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 24 - PAGE 25
REMOTE ENGINE SPEED CONTROL
FEATURES
REMOTE THROTTLE CONTROL INTERLOCKED TO PARK BRAKE APPLIED
RECOMMENDED APPLICATION: VARIOUS
60AJE
BDY INTG, THROTTLE CONTROL Accommodation for On Demand Engine Speed for Single
Customer-Mounted Pressure Switch, Programmable Mode for Various Switch Actions, Useable Only While
Vehicle is Stopped and the Park Brake is Applied (requires one RPM input)
TEM or customer-mounted single remote momentary, latched switch or normally open pressure switch; when
the operator moves the switch to the up position or the switch closes, the switch supplies GND or 12 volts to the
RPM input which starts ramping the engine to Engine Speed Preset-1, the engine will continue to ramp to the
Engine Speed Preset-1 as long as the switch continues to supply either GND or 12 volts to the RPM input;
when the operator moves the switch to the down position or the switch opens, the switch removes the GND or
12 volt RPM input to deactivate Remote engine speed control preset-1 returning the engine to idle.
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
REQUIRED SOFTWARE FEATURE CODE
595AKK
CONFLICTS WITH SOFTWARE FEATURES
595AKJ, 595AKL, 595AKM, 595AKN
ACTIVATION PARAMETERS:
1. Momentary or latched GND or 12 volt input to RPM
2. Park brake applied
3. Transmission in neutral or park or clutch pedal not depressed
4. Vehicle speed is less than one MPH
5. Engine running and at idle
6. Optional PTO feedback is true.
DEACTIVATION PARAMETERS:
1. No GND or 12 volt input to RPM
2. Park brake not applied
3. Transmission not in neutral or park or clutch pedal depressed
4. Vehicle speed is greater than one MPH.
5. Engine not running
6. Service brake depressed
7. Optional PTO feedback not true
FEATURE ORDERING NOTES
1. This feature requires one RPM input.
2. If 60AJE is ordered, 12VXU must also be ordered which requires entering TEM or customer-requested
Remote engine speed control preset-1 RPMs.
3. TEM or customer must supply single momentary, latched or normally open pressure switch and all
associated wiring from switch to RPM.
4. The optional PTO interlock is defaulted off; this interlock only works with International
pre-engineered
PTO features. If the TEM or customer has one of the International
Builder to install Body Controller (BC) software feature code 595AKK, and set the
feature code parameters to the following settings:
a. 595AKK Set parameter 2035 to 3. Reference feature configuration programmable parameters.
b. 595AKK Set parameter 2158 to 3 for 12 volt input or 1 for GND input. Reference feature configuration
programmable parameters.
c. 595AKK Set parameter 2036 to on for optional PTO interlock. Reference feature configuration
programmable parameters.
2. Use Diamond Logic
pre-engineered
PTO features that use a center panel switch. This means that the remote engine speed control will only be
allowed to operate if the PTO is being requested to engage. If this parameter is not set, the engine speed
control will operate regardless of the PTO request.
a. On
b. Off
2. 2035 TEM_Ext_Eng_Spd_Control_Mode; This parameter sets the mode of operation for the TEM external
engine speed control feature and should be set to 3.
a. 3, Engine will ramp for only as long as the engine speed control input is held in its active state.
3. 2158 TEM_Ext_ Eng_Spd_ Ctrl_Active_State; This is the active state for the external engine speed control
switch input to the RPM and should be set to 3 or 1.
a. 3, 12 volts The input is connected to 12 volts through a switch.
b. 1, GND The input is connected to GND through a switch.
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 24 - PAGE 27
REMOTE ENGINE SPEED CONTROL
FEATURES
Table 163
HARDWARE INSTALLATION
1. Reference the connectors tab within Diamond Logic
Builder to force the RPM input pin to the 12 volt or GND state.
2. Verify the RPM input labeled Remote_Engine_Speed_Sw_Input (pin position specified Diamond Logic
software) is receiving GND or 12 volts as long as the switch is closed.
3. Verify that the engine ramps to the first preset speed.
4. If engine does not ramp to the first preset speed, check engine programming to verify that the correct
engine speed control parameters are set.
5. Deactivate the remote engine speed control switch (release GND).
6. Verify the RPM input labeled Remote_Engine_Speed_Sw_Input (pin position specified Diamond Logic
Builder software) is an open circuit when switch is in the down or open position.
7. Verify that the engine returns to idle.
f_156
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 24 - PAGE 29
REMOTE ENGINE SPEED CONTROL
FEATURES
REMOTE THROTTLE CONTROL INTERLOCKED TO PARK BRAKE APPLIED
RECOMMENDED APPLICATION: UTILITY
60AJG
BDY INTG, THROTTLE CONTROL Accommodation for Single Customer-Mounted External Engine Speed
Control Switch, for Utility Applications, Programmable Mode for Various Switch Actions and Engine Speed
Control Option, Only with Vehicle Stopped and Park Brake is Applied (requires one RPM input)
TEM or customer-mounted single remote, momentary switch; when the operator moves the switch to the up
position or the switch closes for the first time, the switch supplies the GND or 12 volts to the RPM input which
activates Engine Speed Preset-1; when the operator moves the switch to the down position or the switch
opens, the engine will remain at Engine Speed Preset-1; when the operator moves the switch to the up position
or the switch closes for the second time, Remote engine speed control preset-1 is deactivated returning the
engine to idle.
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
REQUIRED SOFTWARE FEATURE CODE
595AKL
CONFLICTS WITH SOFTWARE FEATURES
595AKJ, 595AKK, 595AKM, 595AKN
ACTIVATION PARAMETERS
1. First momentary GND or 12 volt input to RPM
2. Park brake applied
3. Transmission in neutral or park or clutch pedal not depressed
4. Vehicle speed is less than one MPH
5. Engine running and at idle
6. Optional PTO feedback is true.
DEACTIVATION PARAMETERS:
1. Second momentary GND or 12 volt input to RPM
2. Park brake not applied
3. Transmission not in neutral or park or clutch pedal depressed
4. Vehicle speed is greater than one MPH.
5. Engine not running
6. Service brake depressed
7. Optional PTO feedback not true
FEATURE ORDERING NOTES
1. This feature requires one RPM input.
2. If 60AJG is ordered, 12VXU must also be ordered which requires entering TEM or customer-requested
Remote engine speed control preset-1 RPMs.
3. TEM or customer must supply single momentary switch and all associated wiring from switch to RPM.
4. The optional PTO interlock is defaulted off; this interlock only works with International
pre-engineered
PTO features. If the TEM or customer has one of the International
to install Body Controller (BC) software feature code 595AKL, and set the feature
code parameters to the following settings:
a. 595AKL Set parameter 2035 to 2. Reference feature configuration programmable parameters.
b. 595AKL Set parameter 2158 to 3 for 12 volt input or 1 for GND input. Reference feature configuration
programmable parameters.
c. 595AKL Set parameter 2036 to on for optional PTO interlock. Reference feature configuration
programmable parameters.
2. Use Diamond Logic
pre-engineered
PTO features that use a center panel switch. This means that the remote engine speed control will only be
allowed to operate if the PTO is being requested to engage. If this parameter is not set, the engine speed
control will operate regardless of the PTO request.
a. On
b. Off
2. 2035 TEM_Ext_Eng_Spd_Control_Mode; This parameter sets the mode of operation for the TEM external
engine speed control feature and should be set to 3.
a. 3, Pulling the engine speed control input momentarily to its active state causes the engine to ramp to
preset-1; another momentary active state causes the engine to return to idle.
3. 2158 TEM_Ext_ Eng_Spd_ Ctrl_Active_State; This is the active state for the external engine speed control
switch input to the RPM and should be set to 3 or 1.
a. 3, 12 volts The input is connected to 12 volts through a switch.
b. 1, GND The input is connected to GND through a switch.
Table 164
Parameter ID Description Default Units Min Max Step
TEM_Ext_
Eng_Spd_
Ctrl_PTO_ Ilock
2036
If this parameter is a one, external
engine speed controls will be
interlocked to PTO request.
0 On/Off 0 1 1
TEM_Ext_
Eng_Speed_
Control_ Mode
2035
This parameter sets the mode of
operation for the TEM external
engine speed control feature.
2 List 0 3 1
TEM_Ext_
Eng_Spd_
Ctrl_Active_
State
2158
This is the active state for the
external engine speed control switch.
1 List 0 1 3
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 24 - PAGE 31
REMOTE ENGINE SPEED CONTROL
FEATURES
HARDWARE INSTALLATION
1. Reference the connectors tab within Diamond Logic
Builder to force the RPM input pin to the 12 volt or GND state.
2. Verify the RPM input labeled Remote_Engine_Speed_Sw_Input (pin position specified Diamond Logic
Builder software) is receiving GND or 12 volts as long as the switch is closed.
3. Verify that the engine ramps to the first preset speed.
4. If engine does not ramp to the first preset speed, check engine programming to verify that the correct
engine speed control parameters are set.
f_156
SECTION 24 - PAGE 32 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
REMOTE ENGINE SPEED CONTROL
FEATURES
5. Deactivate the remote engine speed control switch (release GND).
6. Verify the RPM input labeled Remote_Engine_Speed_Sw_Input (pin position specified Diamond Logic
software) is an open circuit when switch is in the down or open position.
7. Verify that the engine returns to idle.
REMOTE THROTTLE CONTROL INTERLOCKED TO PARK BRAKE APPLIED
RECOMMENDED APPLICATION: UTILITY
60AJH
BDY INTG, THROTTLE CONTROL for Dual Function Input, for Utility Applications, Remote Throttle Control
When Engine is Running, and Activating Output for Emergency Power When the Engine is Not Engaged;
Useable Only When Vehicle is Stopped and Park Brake is Applied (requires one RPM input and output)
Stationary Remote engine speed control preset-1 interlocked to park brake and transmission in neutral or park
and vehicle speed and engine running or optional PTO interlock; when engine is not running, the GND input will
turn on a 12 volt, 20 Ampere (AMP) RPM out used to control emergency pump.
TEM or customer-mounted single remote, momentary or normally open pressure switch; when the operator
moves the switch to the up position or the switch closes for the first time, the switch supplies a GND to the RPM
input which activates Engine Speed Preset-1; when the operator moves the switch to the down position or the
switch opens, the engine will remain at Engine Speed Preset-1; when the operator moves the switch to the up
position or the switch closes for the second time, the switch supplies a GND to the RPM input which
deactivates Remote engine speed control preset-1 returning the engine to idle; when the engine is not running
and the operator moves the switch to the up position and holds or the switch closes and holds, the switch will
supply a GND signal to the RPM input which then turns on a 12 volt, 20 AMP RPM output used for emergency
pump control.
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
REQUIRED SOFTWARE FEATURE CODE
595AKM
CONFLICTS WITH SOFTWARE FEATURES
595AKJ, 595AKK, 595AKL, 595AKN
ACTIVATION PARAMETERS, PRESET-1
1. First momentary GND input to RPM
2. Park brake applied
3. Transmission in neutral or park or clutch pedal not depressed
4. Vehicle speed is less than one MPH
5. Engine running and at idle
6. Optional PTO feedback is true.
DEACTIVATION PARAMETERS, PRESET-1:
1. Second momentary GND input to RPM
2. Park brake not applied
3. Transmission not in neutral or park or clutch pedal depressed
4. Vehicle speed is greater than one MPH.
5. Engine not running
6. Service brake depressed
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 24 - PAGE 33
REMOTE ENGINE SPEED CONTROL
FEATURES
7. Optional PTO feedback not true
ACTIVATION PARAMETERS, EMERGENCY PUMP:
1. Hold GND input to RPM
2. Park brake applied
3. Transmission in neutral or park or clutch pedal not depressed
4. Vehicle speed is less than one MPH.
5. Engine not running
6. Optional PTO feedback is true
FEATURE ORDERING NOTES
1. This feature requires one RPM input, one 12 volt, 20 AMP RPM output.
2. If 60AJH is ordered, 12VXU must also be ordered which requires entering TEM or customer-requested
Remote engine speed control preset-1 RPMs.
3. TEM or customer must supply single momentary or normally open pressure switch and all associated
wiring from switch to RPM.
HOW TO INSTALL THIS FEATURE
Software Installation
1. Use Diamond Logic
to install Body Controller (BC) software feature code 595AKM, and set the feature
code parameters to the following settings:
a. 595AKM Set Parameter 2060, fusing value for the output driving the emergency pump in the
combination remote engine speed control emergency pump feature.
b. 595AKM Set parameter 2035 to 2. Reference feature configuration programmable parameters.
c. 595AKM Set parameter 2158 to 1 for GND input. Reference feature configuration programmable
parameters.
d. 595AKM Set parameter 2036 to on for optional PTO interlock. Reference feature configuration
programmable parameters.
2. Use Diamond Logic
pre-engineered
PTO features that use a center panel switch. This means that the remote engine speed control will only be
allowed to operate if the PTO is being requested to engage. If this parameter is not set, the engine speed
control will operate regardless of the PTO request.
a. On
b. Off
SECTION 24 - PAGE 34 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
REMOTE ENGINE SPEED CONTROL
FEATURES
3. 2035 TEM_Ext_Eng_Spd_Control_Mode; This parameter sets the mode of operation for the TEM external
engine speed control feature and should be set to 1.
a. 2, Pulling the engine speed control momentarily to its active state causes engine to ramp to preset-1;
another momentary active state causes the engine to return to idle.
4. 2158 TEM_Ext_ Eng_Spd_ Ctrl_Active_State; This is the active state for the external engine speed control
switch input to the RPM and should be set to 1.
a. 1, GND The input is connected to GND through a switch.
Table 165
HARDWARE INSTALLATION
1. Reference the connectors tab within Diamond Logic
software) is receiving GND as long as the switch is closed.
2. Verify that the engine ramps to the first preset speed.
3. If engine does not ramp to the first preset speed, check engine programming to verify that the correct
engine speed control parameters are set.
4. Deactivate the remote engine speed control switch (release GND).
5. Verify the RPM input labeled Remote_Engine_Speed_Sw_Input (pin position specified Diamond Logic
Builder software) is an open circuit when switch is in the down or open position.
6. Verify that the engine returns to idle.
7. Verify 12 volts 20 AMPS on RPM output connector labeled Utility_Emergency_Pump_Output.
f_160
SECTION 24 - PAGE 36 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
REMOTE ENGINE SPEED CONTROL
FEATURES
REMOTE THROTTLE CONTROL INTERLOCKED TO PARK BRAKE APPLIED
RECOMMENDED APPLICATION: REFUSE
60AJJ
BDY INTG, THROTTLE CONTROL Accommodation for Single Customer-Mounted Momentary Switch, for
Refuse Applications, Programmable Mode Various Switch Actions, Useable Only While Vehicle is Stopped and
the Park Brake is Applied (requires one RPM input)
TEM or customer-mounted single remote, latched switch; when the operator moves the switch to the up
position or the switch closes, the switch supplies 12 volts to the RPM input which activates Engine Speed
Preset-1, the engine will stay at Engine Speed Preset-1 as long as the switch continues to supply 12 volts to the
RPM input; when the operator moves the switch to the down position or the switch opens, the switch removes
the 12 volt RPM input to deactivate Remote engine speed control preset-1 returning the engine to idle.
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
REQUIRED SOFTWARE FEATURE CODE
595AKN
CONFLICTS WITH SOFTWARE FEATURES
595AKJ, 595AKK, 595AKL, 595AKM
ACTIVATION PARAMETERS:
1. Latched switch that supplies 12 volt input to RPM
2. Park brake applied
3. Transmission in neutral or park or clutch pedal not depressed
4. Vehicle speed is less than one MPH
5. Engine running and at idle
6. Optional PTO feedback is true.
DEACTIVATION PARAMETERS:
1. No 12 volt input to RPM
2. Park brake not applied
3. Transmission not in neutral or park or clutch pedal depressed
4. Vehicle speed is greater than one MPH.
5. Engine not running
6. Service brake depressed
7. Optional PTO feedback not true
FEATURE ORDERING NOTES
1. This feature requires one RPM input.
2. If 60AJJ is ordered, 12VXU must also be ordered which requires entering TEM or customer-requested
Remote engine speed control preset-1 RPMs.
3. TEM or customer must supply single latched switch and all associated wiring from switch to RPM.
4. The optional PTO interlock is defaulted off; this interlock only works with International
pre-engineered
PTO features. If the TEM or customer has one of the International
Level 2 or 3 certified.
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 24 - PAGE 37
REMOTE ENGINE SPEED CONTROL
FEATURES
HOW TO INSTALL FEATURE
Software Installation
1. Use Diamond Logic
Builder to install Body Controller (BC) software feature code 595AKN, and set the
feature code parameters to the following settings:
a. 595AKN Set parameter 2035 to 3. Reference feature configuration programmable parameters.
b. 595AKN Set parameter 2158 to 3 for 12 volt input. Reference feature configuration programmable
parameters.
c. 595AKN Set parameter 2036 to on for optional PTO interlock. Reference feature configuration
programmable parameters.
2. Use Diamond Logic
pre-engineered
PTO features that use a center panel switch. This means that the remote engine speed control will only be
allowed to operate if the PTO is being requested to engage. If this parameter is not set, the engine speed
control will operate regardless of the PTO request.
a. On
b. Off
2. 2035 TEM_Ext_Eng_Spd_Control_Mode; This parameter sets the mode of operation for the TEM external
engine speed control feature and should be set to 3.
a. 3, Engine will ramp for only as long as the engine speed control input is held in its active state.
3. 2158 TEM_Ext_ Eng_Spd_ Ctrl_Active_State; This is the active state for the external engine speed control
switch input to the RPM and should be set to 3.
a. 3, 12 volts The input is connected to 12 volts through a switch.
Table 166
HARDWARE INSTALLATION
1. Reference the connectors tab within Diamond Logic
to force the
RPM input pin to the 12 volt.
2. Verify the RPM input labeled Remote_Engine_Speed_Sw_Input (pin position specified Diamond Logic
software) is receiving 12 volts as long as the switch is closed.
3. Verify that the engine ramps to the first preset speed.
4. If engine does not ramp to the first preset speed, check engine programming to verify that the correct
engine speed control parameters are set.
5. Deactivate the remote engine speed control switch (release 12 volts).
6. Verify the RPM input labeled Remote_Engine_Speed_Sw_Input (pin position specified Diamond Logic
software) is an open circuit when switch is in the down or open position.
7. Verify that the engine returns to idle.
f_156
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 24 - PAGE 39
REMOTE ENGINE SPEED CONTROL
FEATURES
REMOTE ENGINE SPEED CONTROL CATERPILLAR AND CUMMINS ENGINES
Caterpillar and Cummins engine controllers must be programmed using the appropriate
diagnostic/programming software for these functions to operate properly. Please see a certified Caterpillar or
Cummins dealer for proper installation and functionality of these features.
REMOTE ENGINE SPEED CONTROL FEATURES AVAILABLE WITH CATERPILLAR ENGINES
Feature codes 12VYC and 12VXY are not available on Caterpillar engines. The following features are available
to the Body Builder by directly wiring to the engine controller:
Vehicle Speed
Engine Speed
Remote PTO On/Off
Remote PTO Ramp Up/Ramp Down
Frequency Output Signals for Driving Off-board Engine Warning Lights
Remote Throttle (Pedal) Control
Remote Engine Speed Control Features Available with 2004 Cummins Engines
Vehicle speed on a Cummins engine can be accessed on a datalink or via a second vehicle speed sensor
added to the transmission.
ACCESSORY WIRING
12VYL
ACCESSORY WIRING, SPECIAL For Road Speed Wire Coiled Under Instrument Panel for Customer Use
This feature provides a vehicle speed signal source from the engine ECM. This speedometer output is
calibrated to 30,000 pulses per mile.
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
Software feature codes can be added through the Diamond Logic
software.
REQUIRED SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES
None
CONFLICTS WITH SOFTWARE FEATURES
None
PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
None
WIRING INFORMATION
The Road Speed Wire is coiled under the instrument panel.
TESTING
Specific testing requirements depend upon the customer application.
SECTION 24 - PAGE 40 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
REMOTE ENGINE SPEED CONTROL
FEATURES
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 25 - PAGE 1
REMOTE AIR SOLENOID MODULE
REMOTE AIR SOLENOID MODULE
TEM AIR SOLENOIDS
Refer to Circuit Diagram Manual S08322, Chapter 10, Chassis Accessories, Air Solenoid.
Normally Closed
08WGA
SOLENOID, AIR for Customer Use; Provides (1) Normally Closed Pilot Air Source, Approx. 4 CFM, Includes
Switch in Cab; Air Available Only With Key in Ignition (IGN) or Accessory Position; Air Will Exhaust with Key
in Off Position
08WGB
SOLENOID, AIR for Customer Use; Provides (2) Normally Closed Pilot Air Source, Approx. 4 CFM, Includes
Switch in Cab; Air Available Only With Key in IGN or Accessory Position; Air Will Exhaust with Key in Off
Position
08WGC
SOLENOID, AIR for Customer Use; Provides (3) Normally Closed Pilot Air Source, Approx. 4 CFM, Includes
Switch in Cab; Air Available Only With Key in IGN or Accessory Position; Air Will Exhaust with Key in Off
Position
08WGD
SOLENOID, AIR for Customer Use; Provides (4) Normally Closed Pilot Air Source, Approx. 4 CFM, Includes
Switch in Cab; Air Available Only With Key in IGN or Accessory Position; Air Will Exhaust with Key in Off
Position
08WKM
SOLENOID, AIR for Customer Use; Provides (6) Normally Closed Pilot Air Source, Approx. 4 CFM, Includes
Switch in Cab; Air Available Only With Key in Ignition or Accessory Position; Air Will Exhaust with key in
Off Position
Normally Open
08WGP
SOLENOID, AIR for Customer Use; Provides (5) Normally Open Pilot Air Source, Approx. 4 CFM, Includes
Switch in Cab; Air Exhausted Only With Key in IGN or Accessory Position; Air Will be Supplied with Key in
Off Position
08WGR
SOLENOID, AIR for Customer Use; Provides (6) Normally Open Pilot Air Source, Approx. 4 CFM, Includes
Switch in Cab; Air Exhausted Only With Key in IGN or Accessory Position; Air Will be Supplied with Key in
Off Position
These air solenoids provide Instrument Panel (IP)-mounted, rocker switches and normally closed and/or
normally open air solenoids that allow the operator to control up to four normally closed or five or six normally
open body-mounted air accessories from the cab. Note: these air solenoids are to be used as a pilot air source
and are not to be used as an air supply. All of the air solenoid feature codes include windowed latching rocker
switches and do not include any interlock features. Product graphics are included for application to each switch
window.
SECTION 25 - PAGE 2 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
REMOTE AIR SOLENOID MODULE
The air solenoids will turn off and the air will be exhausted for normally closed solenoids, and air pressure will
be maintained with the normally open solenoids with the IGN key turned off. Take precautions to ensure that
equipment controlled by these solenoids will not cause personal injury when the IGN key is turned off.
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES THAT MUST BE INSTALLED BASED ON THE FEATURE CODE BEING INSTALLED
08WGA 595AHX; 08WGB 595AHY; 08WGC 595AHZ; 08WGD 595AJA; 08WGP 595AKZ;
08WGR 595AJC; 08WKM --- 595BBD
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES THAT MUST NOT BE ENABLED
None
WIRING INFORMATION
Use the Diamond Logic Builder software to determine switch locations of the air solenoid switches.
Customer supplies air plumbing from the air solenoids to the desired air-controlled accessory.
(1) The first 4-pack is mounted on the inboard side of the drivers side frame rail in front of the rear cab
crossmember.
(2) The second and third 4-packs for a 6x4 suspension are mounted on the forward rear suspension
crossmember.
(3) The second and third 4-packs for a 4x2 suspension are located on the passenger side frame rail in front of
the rear suspension crossmember.
(4) A 6x4 or SS 4x2 can have a fourth 4-pack which mounts on the passenger side frame rail in front of the
forward rear suspension crossmember.
There are several positions where the solenoid packs may be mounted.
f_161
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 25 - PAGE 3
REMOTE AIR SOLENOID MODULE
TESTING
Directions For 4-Pack
This procedure can be used for each auxiliary air solenoid added to the vehicle.
1. Activate the in-cab auxiliary air solenoid switch.
2. Verify that the particular air solenoid either provides air pressure for normally closed or exhausts the air for
normally open solenoids.
3. Verify that the proper pin in the air solenoid 4-pack connector has battery voltage.
4. Pin A for all air solenoids should have continuity with the negative battery stud.
HOW TO ADD THESE FEATURES
See the How Do I General Information section of this electrical guide.
Feature codes 595AHX, 595AHY, 595AHZ, 595AJA, 595AKZ, or 595AJC must be added depending on the
number and type of air outputs desired.
Use the Diamond Logic Builder software to determine correct in-cab switch location(s) for the switches
controlling the air outputs.
f_162
SECTION 25 - PAGE 4 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
REMOTE AIR SOLENOID MODULE
Below is a listing of parts that may be required depending on how the vehicle was equipped at the factory.
Table 167
SCENARIOS FOR ADDING AIR SOLENOIDS
The vehicle has a 4-pack with unused solenoid locations.
Add the solenoid to the solenoid pack, and add the appropriate rocker to the switch pack. See the Switch Pack
section for switch information, and use the Diamond Logic
Builder software in conjunction with Circuit Diagram Manual S08322, Chapter 10, Chassis
Accessories, Air Solenoid for terminal and connector information.
The vehicle has a 4-pack, but it is full.
Use the same procedure that was used above for a vehicle that already has a solenoid pack that is completely
full. A total of two 4-packs may be added to DuraStar and 8000 series vehicles. Four total 4-packs may be
added to WorkStar series vehicles. Additional 4-packs are required to be wired per Circuit Diagram Manual
S08322, Chapter 10, Chassis Accessories, Air Solenoid.
The BC will have to be programmed for the additional air features to work properly.
Part Number Description
3610975C1 Support, 4-pack Solenoid (Bracket for 7700 w /Chalmers or HMX suspension)
3610976C1
Support, 8-pack Solenoid (Bracket holds 2 4-pack solenoids for 7700 w /Chalmers or HMX
suspension)
3610977C1 Support, 4-pack Solenoid (Bracket for 7700 w/ Hendrickson Air suspension w/ 3/8 frame rails)
3610978C1
Support, 8-pack Solenoid (Bracket holds 2 4-pack solenoids for 7700 w/ Hendrickson Air
suspension w/ 3/8 frame rails)
3610973C1 Support, 4-pack Solenoid (All other 6x4 vehicles)
3610974C1 Support, 8-pack Solenoid (Bracket holds 2 4-pack solenoids for all other 6x4 vehicles)
2506711C91 Kit, Air Brake Solenoid N.C. (includes labels and O-rings)
2506712C91 Kit, Air Brake Solenoid N.O. (includes labels and O-rings)
2506713C91 Kit, Air Horn Solenoid (includes labels and O-rings)
3549776C4 Housing, Switch 6-Pack DIN Multiplex
3549777C4 Housing, Switch 12-Pack DIN Multiplex
f_163
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 25 - PAGE 5
REMOTE AIR SOLENOID MODULE
SWITCH, AIR HORN, PASSENGER, FIRE TRUCK
08WEE
SWITCH, AIR HORN, PASSENGER Fire Truck Application; Switch Located in Instrument Panel (IP) Close to
Passenger; Driver Also To Activate Switch at Steering Wheel
The passenger side air horn switch provides a method for an individual to activate the vehicle air horn from the
passenger seat. The feature consists of a hard wired momentary switch that is located in the lower right corner
of the central IP. This second rocker switch is used in conjunction with the air horn switch that is located in the
steering wheel.
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
The air horn software feature code 595ALD must be enabled on the vehicle Body Controller (BC) using the
Diamond Logic Builder software (see local dealer).
There are no programmable parameters associated with this feature.
WIRING INFORMATION
Both the hard wired rocker switch in the IP and the air horn switch in the steering wheel are connected to a
single input on the BC connector 1602 Pin F8. The air solenoid is driven from the BC output connector 1602 Pin
E12.
TESTING SYSTEM OPERATION
1. Turn the Ignition (IGN) key to the accessory position.
2. Momentarily depress the air horn switch in the steering wheel. Note that the air horn sounds.
3. Momentarily depress the air horn rocker switch. Note that the air horn sounds.
HOW TO ADD THIS FEATURE
1. Remove the central IP trim piece.
Air Horn Switch Part Number 3551415C1
f_164
SECTION 25 - PAGE 6 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
REMOTE AIR SOLENOID MODULE
2. Locate an open switch position in the lower right corner of the IP.
3. Use a switch hole punching tool to cut a hole in the plastic plate of the central IP plate.
4. Remove the storage box or 12-pack of switches located above plastic plate. Use a scribe or other marker
tool to outline the hard wired switch openings in the steel plate located behind the plastic switch plate.
5. Drill a pilot hole in the center of the desired switch location.
6. Use the switch punch to open the hole in the plastic plate. The recommended method to create a
rectangular switch slot is to use a Green Lee Punch (part number ZTSE4426 from SPX).
7. Insert the air horn switch in the plastic plate.
8. Wire the mating switch connector as Circuit Diagram Manual S08322, Chapter 4 Cab Accessories, Horn
Electric.
9. Attach the switch connector to the air horn switch.
10. Reinstall the plastic switch plate and central IP trim piece.
Center Panels to Remove
f_165
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 25 - PAGE 7
REMOTE AIR SOLENOID MODULE
General Circuit Diagram for Adding the Passenger Side Air
Horn Switch
f_166
SECTION 25 - PAGE 8 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
REMOTE AIR SOLENOID MODULE
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 26 - PAGE 1
REMOTE START/STOP
REMOTE START/STOP
REMOTE START/STOP
Refer to the circuit diagram in S08322, Chapter 10, Chassis Accessories, Remote Start/Stop.
60ABC
BDY INTG, REMOTE START/STOP To Start and Stop Vehicle Engine
The Remote Start/Stop feature provides the operator with the ability to remotely start or stop the engine from a
single ground (GND) active switch closure located on the vehicle body equipment. The vehicle park brake must
be set, and the hood of the vehicle must be closed. The vehicle must also be equipped with an automatic
transmission and must be in neutral. This feature requires the customer to provide the GND active switch as
well as the wiring from that switch into the Remote Start/Stop connector located in the middle of the chassis.
The customer will also provide the terminals and seals for the International
-provided connector.
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
REQUIRED SOFTWARE FEATURE CODE
595AKW
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODE THAT MUST BE REMOVED
595AKV
If TEM_Rem_Start_Stop_PTO_Ilock is turned on, then the operator can only use Remote Start/Stop when the
in-cab, International
-provided connector so that the customer can wire the switch into the connector.
Table 169
Parameter ID Description Default Units Min Max Step
TEM_Rem_
Start_Stop_
PTO_Ilock
2192
If this parameter is set, the remote
start/stop functionality will not
function unless the PTO switch is in
the on position.
Off On/Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_Rem_
Start_Stop_
Crank_Delay_
Gen2
2438
This is the time that the remote
start/stop feature delays before
starting to crank the engine.
0.5 S 0.1 1 0.01
Customer Wire Gauge Terminal Part Numbers Seal Part Numbers
12AWG 1673748C1 0589390C1
14AWG 0587577C1 0589391C1
16AWG 0587577C1 1652325C1
SECTION 26 - PAGE 2 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
REMOTE START/STOP
TESTING
1. When starting and stopping the engine, make sure that the Body Builder switch is providing a GND signal
to the mid-chassis wire. The vehicle ignition (IGN) key must be in the ON position and the hood must be
closed.
2. If the engine is running, a momentary switch closure of the body builder-supplied switch will stop the
engine.
3. If the engine is stopped, push and hold the body builder-supplied switch until the vehicle starts.
HOW TO ADD THIS FEATURE
Refer to the circuit diagram in S08322, Chapter 10, Chassis Accessories, Remote Start/Stop for proper circuit
and connector/pin information.
Remote Start Stop Connector in Mid-Chassis Harness
f_167
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 26 - PAGE 3
REMOTE START/STOP
REMOTE START/STOP WITH EMERGENCY PUMP
Refer to the circuit diagram in S08322, Chapter 10, Chassis Accessories, Remote Start/Stop.
60ABD
BDY INTG, REMOTE START/STOP To Start and Stop Vehicle Engine, Will Start Emergency Pump Motor,
Programmable Time Intervals
The Remote Start/Stop feature provides the ability to remotely start or stop the engine from a single GND active
switch closure located on the vehicle body equipment. This feature operates in two modes, namely the remote
start/stop mode and the emergency pump mode. The vehicle park brake must be set and the hood of the
vehicle must be closed. The vehicle must also be equipped with an automatic transmission and must be in
neutral. The user may engage the same switch to control an emergency pump solenoid/motor combination, if
the vehicle engine cannot be restarted.
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
REQUIRED SOFTWARE FEATURE CODE
595AKV
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODE THAT MUST BE REMOVED
595AKW
If TEM_Rem_Start_Stop_PTO_Ilock is turned on, then the operator can only use Remote Start/Stop when the
in-cab, International
-provided connector so that the customer can wire the switch into the connector.
Parameter ID Description Default Units Min Max Step
TEM_Rem_
Start_Stop_
PTO_Ilock
2192
If this parameter is set, the remote
start/stop functionality will not
function unless the PTO switch is in
the on position.
Off On/Off N/A N/A N/A
TEM_ Remote_
Engine_Stop_
Time
2072
Time allotted to stop the engine for
the remote engine start stop with
emergency pump feature.
5 S - 6- 0.01
TEM_Rem_
Start_Stop_
Crank_Delay_
Gen2
2438
This is the time that the remote
start/stop feature delays before
starting to crank the engine.
0.5 S 0.1 1 0.01
SECTION 26 - PAGE 4 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
REMOTE START/STOP
Table 171
The customer must provide a GND active momentary switch that is wired into the mid-chassis connector.
If the customer orders 60ABD but decides not to use an emergency pump, the customer should simply use
the Diamond Logic
Builder software to enable software feature code 595AKW, and remove software
feature code 595AKV.
TESTING
1. When starting and stopping the engine, make sure that the Body Builder switch is providing a GND signal
to the mid-chassis wire. The vehicle IGN key must be in the ON position and the hood must be closed.
2. If the engine is running, a momentary switch closure of the body builder-supplied switch will stop the
engine.
3. If the engine is stopped, push and hold the body builder-supplied switch until the vehicle starts.
4. If the engine will not start, release the start/stop switch momentarily, activate the switch again, and hold it
until the emergency pump control wire supplies GND to the emergency pump relay. The emergency pump
will remain ON as long as the switch is active.
HOW TO ADD THIS FEATURE
Refer to the circuit diagram in S08322, Chapter 10, Chassis Accessories, Remote Start/Stop for proper circuit
and connector/pin information.
Customer Wire Gauge Terminal Part Numbers Seal Part Numbers
12AWG 1673748C1 0589390C1
14AWG 0587577C1 0589391C1
16AWG 0587577C1 1652325C1
Navistar does not suggest adding a remote start on vehicles
with manual transmissions.
f_168
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 27 - PAGE 1
LIFT GATE ACCOMMODATION PACKAGE
LIFT GATE ACCOMMODATION PACKAGE
POWER SOURCE FOR LIFT GATE
08WJA
POWER SOURCE, SPECIAL for Customer-Installed Lift Gate; 200 AMP max, includes 2 gauge power cable to
end-of-frame, switch on Instrument Panel (IP), with a time out feature, battery discharge protection, controlling
a mag switch which provides power
08WJB
POWER SOURCE, for Customer-Installed Lift Gate; heavy duty, includes 0 gauge power cable to
end-of-frame, switch on IP, with a time out feature, battery discharge protection, controlling a mag switch which
provides power
08WJH
POWER SOURCE, SPECIAL Special Socket; Dual Pole Terminal, for Power Lift Gate Feed, Battery Feed Thru
150 Amp Circuit Breaker To Operate Lift Gate On Trailer
08WCM
POWER SOURCE, SPECIAL Special Socket; Single Terminal, for Power Lift Gate Feed, Battery Feed Thru
150 Amp Circuit Breaker, To Operate Lift Gate On Trailer, Includes a 15 Power Cable Coiled in Cab
Feature code 08WJA or 08WJB provides a factory-installed, dedicated power source for lift gate operation. This
feature includes an IP-mounted master switch, which illuminates when the system is turned on, and an optional
AUX button on the key fob to enable or disable the lift gate. The purpose of the in-cab master switch and the
AUX button on the key fob is to help prevent unauthorized use of the lift gate. These switches also activate a
60 minute timer in the BC that will disable the lift gate after 60 minutes. For continued use of the lift gate, the
master switch or the aux button on the key fob must be used to activate the system for an additional ten
minutes. A Battery Protection Module, activated by the BC 60 minute timer, and a 200 AMP mag switch,
mounted in or at the battery box, enables power to the lift gate motor. A circuit protected cable from the battery
to the mag switch and a heavy gauge wire routed from the mag switch to the end of frame, to provide power to
the lift gate motor is also provided.
This feature will provide battery discharge protection for users who operate the lift gate with or without the
engine running. Without the engine running, key off, the Battery Protection Module will constantly monitor
battery voltage and shut down the lift gate operation before battery voltage reaches a state of charge that will
not allow the vehicle to restart. With the key switch in any position except start or off, an audible alarm will also
sound in the cab during certain low voltage conditions. In addition to battery voltage monitoring, this feature has
time out functionality from the BC to automatically disable the lift gate after a selected time. The default time out
is 60 minutes. A road speed interlock from the BC is provided that activates above approximately 2 MPH. If
activated, the indicator light in the switch flashes and the lift gate is disabled by the BC which prevents the lift
gate from being operated while the vehicle is in motion. The lift gate master switch, or the aux button on the key
fob, must be activated again to continue use of the lift gate after vehicle has stopped.
The lift gate shall be activated for 60 minutes when the key switch is in any position and the lift gate switch is
pressed to the momentary on position (up position), or key fob aux button is pressed, and the vehicle speed is
lower than 2 MPH and voltage conditions are met.
The lift gate shall be deactivated when any of the following conditions are met:
1. The lift gate switch is pressed to the momentary off position (down position), or the push button is cycled
depending on the programmable feature on the vehicle.
2. The aux button on the key fob is pressed.
SECTION 27 - PAGE 2 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
LIFT GATE ACCOMMODATION PACKAGE
3. The voltage is lower than the safe voltage value, and the shutdown override time expires or the vehicle
speed is greater than 2 MPH.
4. The programmable time limit, set at 60 minutes, has been reached.
A cable accommodation is required to fit body van length of 14-26 feet. An additional 40 inch cable length is
provided for ease of installation.
Design accommodation for a lift gate with maximum current draw of up to 200 AMPS for code 08WJA and 200+
AMPS for code 08WJB is available.
This feature can work with the work light feature but cannot work with the work light Remote Keyless Entry
(RKE) key fob feature.
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
Software feature codes can be added through the Diamond Logic
software.
REQUIRED SOFTWARE FEATURE CODE
595AYM for lift gate with rocker switch or 595AGN for lift gate with push button switch in the left side cluster
switch B location. Be careful: 595AGN LIFT GATE WIRING PAK Push Button B may conflict with other B
located switch features like Lamp Check (595AZY).
SOFTWARE FEATURES THAT MUST BE REMOVED
595ABT
The Lift_Gate_Alarm_Time parameter is programmed to allow the operation of the lift gate for a period of 60
seconds. At the end of 60 seconds, the master switch or the aux button on the key fob must be used to
reactivate the system.
The Lift_Gate_Enable_Timeout parameter is programmed to allow continual operation of the lift gate, in 10
minute increments, with the master switch or aux button on the key fob after the time out period of 60 minutes.
The Lift_Gate_Enable_Hi_Current parameter will set an alarm if amperage load goes above the programmed
value.
The Lift_Gate_Enable_Lo_Current parameter will set an alarm if amperage load goes below the programmed
value.
The Lift_Gate_Enable_OC_Current parameter will set an alarm if amperage load goes below the programmed
value.
The Lift_Gate_Enable_Timeout parameter can be adjusted to vary the amount of time, in ten minute
increments, that the lift gate will remain enabled. If this value is set to 6, the lift gate will remain enabled for 60
minutes from the time that it is enabled.
The Lift_Gate_Disable_Threshold parameter will disable the lift gate feature if the voltage falls below this
threshold voltage.
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 27 - PAGE 3
LIFT GATE ACCOMMODATION PACKAGE
Table 172
WIRING INFORMATION
For 08WJA and 08WJB
Please refer to Circuit Diagram Manual S08337, Chapter 10, Chassis Accessories, Power Source, Customer
Installed Lift Gate.
For 08WJA
The Body Builder will be required to cut the 2 straplocks securing the power cable and route and clip the power
cable to the lift gate motor. Then trim the power cable to length and add a lug terminal for securing cable to the
lift gate motor. Two product graphics, from the plastic bag for Body Builders, need to be installed on the van
body in the approximate locations shown.
For 08WJB
The Body Builder will be required to route a 0 gauge cable from the mag switch, back along the frame to the lift
gate motor.
Code 08WJB is identical to code 08WJA with the following exceptions:
Added 3598246C91 Cable Assy, Lift Gate Feed with 0 gauge cable and 3-10 Awg fusible links.
Removed 3592398C91 Cable Assy, Lift Gate Feed with 2 gauge cable and 2-10 Awg fusible links.
Also the 3592400C93-REF 2 gauge Cable Assy, Lift Gate 33.5 feet Ref Cut to length is changed to 0
gauge cable. The Body Builder will be required to remove the 2 gauge cable from the mag switch, back along
the frame to the lift gate motor and replace it with the 0 gauge cable.
Parameter ID Description Default Units Min Max Step
ift_Gate_
Alarm_Time
2249 Lift Gate Alarm Time Value 60 s 1 120 1
Lift_Gate_
Enable_Hi_
Current
2234
Lift Gate Enable High Current
Detection Level (AMPS)
10 A 0 10 0.1
Lift_Gate_
Enable_Lo_
Current
2233
Work Light Low Current Detection
Level (AMPS)
0.3 A 0 10 0.1
Lift_Gate_
Enable_OC_
Current
2232
Lift Gate Enable Open Circuit
Detection Level (AMPS)
0.3 A 0 10 0.1
Lift_Gate_
Enable_Timeou
t
2235
Amount of time, in 10 minute
increments, that the lift gate will
remain enabled.
60 Min 10 240 10
Lift_Gate_Disab
le_Threshold
2239
Voltage threshold below which the lift
gate is disabled
11.5 V 11.5 13.8 0.1
SECTION 27 - PAGE 4 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
LIFT GATE ACCOMMODATION PACKAGE
Harness Routing Diagram
f_169
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 27 - PAGE 5
LIFT GATE ACCOMMODATION PACKAGE
TESTING
1. The body builder or lift gate installer must bring the batteries up to a full charge before trying to test the
system for functionality.
2. With the batteries at a full charge, voltage in the 12.6 to 12.9 range and the lift gate power controlled by the
Battery Protection System, the system will operate as described in the above section.
HOW TO ADD THIS FEATURE
Use the Diamond Logic
,
factory-installed either mounted in the battery box or as a temporary mounted inverter module behind the cab.
The body upfitter is tasked with mounting the inverter in a body compartment with the temporary mount.
The PowerPack system consists of an inverter module, a special 3-phase 42 volt AC alternator, a multiplexed
switch in the cab, and associated wiring harness. The engine must be running in order for the PowerPack
system to generate AC or DC voltages. The 120 volt AC output is only functional when the vehicle is stationary
with the park brake set. The 120 volt AC output contains a Ground (GND) fault interrupter device and a weather
sealed power plug.
CAUTION: If 120 volts AC Shore power is integrated into the body wiring, the shore power connection must
never be directly connected to the PowerPack 3 AC output.
SECTION 28 - PAGE 2 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
POWERPACK 3 PRIMARY AND TEMPORARY
MOUNT FEATURES
PowerPack 3 Block Diagram
f_171
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 28 - PAGE 3
POWERPACK 3 PRIMARY AND TEMPORARY
MOUNT FEATURES
Battery Box Mounted PowerPack 3
f_172
Remote Mount PowerPack 3
f_173
SECTION 28 - PAGE 4 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
POWERPACK 3 PRIMARY AND TEMPORARY
MOUNT FEATURES
AC Derating Curve
f_174
DC Derating Curve
f_175
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 28 - PAGE 5
POWERPACK 3 PRIMARY AND TEMPORARY
MOUNT FEATURES
USING POWERPACK 3 WITH REMOTE ENGINE SPEED CONTROL
PowerPack 3 provides full power output for the 120 volt AC section at an engine RPM of 935 or greater. The
PowerPack 3 inverter module uses special datalink commands to raise the engine RPM to 935 when the 120
volt AC rocker switch is turned on. Since the engine cannot respond to both datalink commands and direct
Engine Control Module (ECM) hard wired engine speed control commands, the body upfitter must use specific
alternative wiring methods to permit remote engine speed control from remote body locations as well as allow
PowerPack 3 to raise engine speed as required. Vehicles equipped with PowerPack 3 may not be used with the
feature 12VZA which provides remote engine speed control through hard wires connected directly to the
engine ECM. The following alternative features are compatible with PowerPack 3 and may be used to achieve
various engine speed control functions.
Preset or variable engine speed control using the steering wheel cruise control switches
Preset variable or remote pedal/throttle using the Remote Engine Speed Control Module (RESCM). Requires
Body Controller (BC) feature 595AHA
Preset 1 using Remote Power Module (RPM) inputs; i.e., feature code 60AJE
Preset or variable engine speed control using Diamond Logic
Builder software (see local dealer).
Parameter PPE3_param_incrThrottle_rqst_enable will enable the automatic throttle request. This will
automatically ramp the engine to the value set in parameter 2344 when the PowerPack is requested on.
Parameter PPE3_param_incrThrottle_startDelay is the amount of time that the PowerPack will wait to turn on.
This is to allow the engine to ramp to the operating RPM before the PowerPack is activated.
Parameter PPE3_param_incrThrottle_targetRPMs is the target RPM for the engine to ramp to when the
PowerPack is activated.
Parameter PPE3_param_incrThrottle_timeout is the amount of time that the inverter is inhibited from coming
back on due to inadequate engine speed.
Table 173
Parameter ID Description Default Units Min Max Step
PPE3_param_
incrThrottle_
rqst_enable
2357
If this is true, then the automatic
throttle increase request has been
enabled.
1 On/Off 0 1 1
PPE3_param_
incrThrottle_
startDelay
2399
This parameter allows the throttle to
ramp to the target RPM prior to
enabling the PPE. The logic for this
parameter is that a maximum load on
the PPE would turn off the inverter if
the alternator RPMs are not at target.
2 Seconds 0 5 0.1
PPE3_param_
incrThrottle_
targetRPMs
2344
This is the target RPM rate for the
throttle increase feature.
935 RPM 900 2000 1
PPE3_param_
incrThrottle_
timeout
2345
The amount of time until the inverter
is inhibited because the engine
speed is not at an adequate level
5 Seconds 0 30 0.1
SECTION 28 - PAGE 6 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
POWERPACK 3 PRIMARY AND TEMPORARY
MOUNT FEATURES
WIRING INFORMATION
WARNING: All electrical connections to the PowerPack 3 must be made by a qualified electrician. Failure to
follow this warning could result in property damage, personal injury, or death.
A Hubbell Watertight Safety-Shroud male plug (Hubbell part number HBL2611SW) is needed to connect to the
AC output plug to mate with the PowerPack supplied Hubbell Watertight Safety-Shroud female socket (Hubbell
part number HBL2613SW). These plugs are available at electrical and industrial supply houses.
Using this part combination will allow for a weather resistant connection to the PowerPack 3 unit. Alteration of
the AC output plug, failure to use the correct male plug, or removal of the supplied socket will not guarantee a
watertight connection.
The AC output from the PowerPack 3 is wired to a Ground Fault Circuit Interrupter (GFCI) to ensure protection
against GND fault conditions. Be aware that standard duplex GFCI and non-GFCI receptacles need to be
protected with a circuit breaker, usually rated for 15 or 20 AMPS.
PowerPack 3 Kit, Left Side under Cab for vehicles built after March 2007.
PowerPack 3 Kit, Right Side under Cab for vehicles built after March 2007.
PowerPack 3 Kit, Remote Mount for vehicles built after March 2007.
Fuse, 58 volt, 10 amp: Alternator Field Wire fuse. Navistar Part Number: 2590768C1
TESTING SYSTEM OPERATION
Start engine; ensure that the park brake is set.
Verify that the batteries are being charged. The voltmeter should be reading greater than 13.5 volts.
Depress 120 VAC rocker switch in IP.
Verify that the engine ramps to 935 RPM.
Verify green light in rocker switch is on solid within five seconds.
Verify 120 volt AC output voltage.
PowerPack 3 Inverter/Regulator Component Detail
f_176
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 28 - PAGE 7
POWERPACK 3 PRIMARY AND TEMPORARY
MOUNT FEATURES
POWERPACK 3 TROUBLESHOOTING
If the PowerPack 3 output does not power up or shuts down during vehicle operation, follow these steps to
troubleshoot the system:
1. Set the 120VAC ON/OFF switch to OFF position, and ensure interlocks are satisfied, as described above,
correcting as necessary.
2. Attempt to restart the PowerPack 3 by pressing the ON switch.
3. If the unit continues to shut-down, (blinking green light in the rocker switch) disconnect any AC loads before
restarting the PowerPack 3.
4. Check for green light on GFCI. If there is a red light press the reset button on GFCI.
5. Press the 120VAC switch to OFF, check the 30-Amp circuit breaker, and reset if necessary.
6. Wait several minutes to allow the system alternator and PowerPack 3 unit to cool, and then attempt to
restart.
7. If the unit does not restart, then turn the vehicles ignition OFF, and then back ON again. This will restart the
PowerPack 3 output protection circuits.
8. If the above steps fail to restart the PowerPack 3 unit, then have the system serviced by a qualified
technician.
NOTE: If the unit does not restart, the problem could be caused by overheating or other circuit protection
devices. If the PowerPack 3 circuit breaker or the GFCI device is tripped, the green light in rocker switch will
continue to show an indication that AC power is ON. Be advised to check these other elements of the system if
120 volt AC power is not present as expected.
f_177
SECTION 28 - PAGE 8 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
POWERPACK 3 PRIMARY AND TEMPORARY
MOUNT FEATURES
Table 174 Diagnostic Indications Using the In-Cab Rocker Switch or Diamond Logic
(Pre-2007 Vehicles)
SPN FMI Byte 7 Byte 8 Switch Indicator
Blink Rate
Condition Description/Comments/Probable Cause(s)
168 2 0 0 Fast
Communication fault from ESC to the PowerPack. Check for open
circuit or short in J1939 datalink. If switch is not blinking, verify vehicle
is programmed for PowerPack feature and the switchpack is
operating correctly.
168 3 0 0 Fast
DC module over voltage on vehicle DC bus. System detected voltage
over 15 volts. Remove any external power supply/charger from
vehicle
168 3 0 0 Slow
AC module over voltage condition on high voltage DC bus. Likely an
internal failure for AC output. AC has been shut down. DC output
remains on.
168 4 0 0 Fast
DC module under voltage condition on vehicle DC bus. System
detected low DC voltage. This could be due to insufficient power from
the alternator. Check the 3 phase wires from the alternator to the
PowerPack.
168 4 0 0 Slow
AC module under voltage condition on high voltage DC bus. System
detected low internal voltages. This could be due to insufficient input
power from the alternator. Check the 3 phase wires from the
alternator to the PowerPack.
168 6 0 0 Slow
AC module has shut down due to overload condition. AC overloaded,
remove some or all of AC load.
168 8 0 0 Fast
Phase missing fault/alternator fault. One of the three 3-phase wires
has an open circuit. Check the 3 phase wires from the alternator to
the PowerPack.
168 16 0 0 Fast
DC module over temperature condition. PowerPack is experiencing
extremely high internal temperatures. AC and DC has been shut
down. Allow the system to cool down.
168 16 0 0 Slow
AC module over temperature condition. PowerPack has detected high
internal temperatures although less severe. AC inverter has shut
down, but DC output remains on. Shut the system down to all it to
cool down or remove some of the loads.
168 17 0 0 Fast
PowerPack Fuse Open. Check DC battery charging connections from
PowerPack. Check 150A fuse.
639 14 37 255 Fast
Communication fault between PowerPack and the ESC. Check for
open circuit or short in J1939 datalink. Also, check the ignition circuit
to the PowerPack module
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 28 - PAGE 9
POWERPACK 3 PRIMARY AND TEMPORARY
MOUNT FEATURES
Table 175 Diagnostic Indications Using the In-Cab Rocker Switch or Diamond Logic
,
factory-installed either mounted in the battery box or as a temporary mounted inverter module behind the cab.
The body builder is tasked with mounting the inverter in a body compartment with the temporary mounted
feature.
The PowerPack system consists of an inverter module, a special 3-phase 42 volt AC alternator, a multiplexed
switch in the cab, and associated wiring harness. The engine must be running in order for the PowerPack
system to generate AC or DC voltages. The 120 volt AC output is only functional when the vehicle is stationary
with the park brake set. The 120 volt AC output contains a Ground (GND) fault interrupter device and a weather
sealed power plug.
CAUTION: If 120 volts AC Shore power is integrated into the body wiring, the shore power connection must
never be directly connected to the PowerPack 3 AC output.
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 28 - PAGE 17
POWERPACK 3 PRIMARY AND TEMPORARY
MOUNT FEATURES
.
PowerPack 3 Block Diagram
f_171
SECTION 28 - PAGE 18 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
POWERPACK 3 PRIMARY AND TEMPORARY
MOUNT FEATURES
Battery Box Mounted PowerPack 3
f_172
Remote Mount PowerPack 3
f_173
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 28 - PAGE 19
POWERPACK 3 PRIMARY AND TEMPORARY
MOUNT FEATURES
AC Derating Curve
f_174
DC Derating Curve
f_175
SECTION 28 - PAGE 20 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
POWERPACK 3 PRIMARY AND TEMPORARY
MOUNT FEATURES
USING POWERPACK 3 WITH REMOTE ENGINE SPEED CONTROL
PowerPack 3 provides full power output for the 120 volt AC section at any engine speed. Vehicles equipped
with the mobile version of PowerPack 3 may be used with any of the following engine speed control functions.
Preset or variable engine speed control using the steering wheel cruise control switches
Preset variable or remote pedal/throttle using the Remote Engine Speed Control Module (RESCM). Requires
Body Controller (BC) feature 595AHA
Preset 1 using Remote Power Module (RPM) inputs; i.e., feature code 60AJE
Preset or variable engine speed control using Diamond Logic
software (see local dealer).
Parameter: PPE3_Stationary or Mobile: In Stationary mode the AC function can be used only while the trucked
is parked with the park brake set. Mobile operation enables 120 AC anytime the engine is running. These
features are defaulted to Mobile Operation.
Parameter: PPE3_Auto ON or Manual ON: Allows the AC power to turn ON automatically each time the vehicle
is started. These features are defaulted to AUTO ON.
Parameter: PPE3_Auto Restart: Allows the PowerPack to restart should there be an over current situation. The
number restart retries and duration before the restart is also programmable. These features are defaulted to
Auto Restart ON with 3 retries with 40 seconds between retries.
Parameter: PPE3_ReStart_Attempts: Number of times the PowerPack will attempt to re-start the system after
an overload. These features are defaulted to 3 retries.
Parameter: PPE3_ReStart_Delay: The amount of time between re-start attempts should there be an over
current situation. These features are defaulted to 40 seconds between retries.
Parameter: PPE3_param_incrThrottle_rqst_enable will enable the automatic throttle request. This will
automatically ramp the engine to the value set in parameter 2344 when the PowerPack is requested on. This
parameter is defaulted OFF for these features.
Parameter: PPE3_param_incrThrottle_startDelay is the amount of time that the PowerPack will wait to turn on.
This is to allow the engine to ramp to the operating RPM before the PowerPack is activated. This parameter is
defaulted to 2 seconds for these features.
Parameter: PPE3_param_incrThrottle_targetRPMs is the target RPM for the engine to ramp to when the
PowerPack is activated. This parameter is defaulted to 935 RPM for these features.
Parameter: PPE3_param_incrThrottle_timeout is the amount of time that the inverter is inhibited from coming
back on due to inadequate engine speed. This parameter is defaulted to 5 seconds for these features.
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 28 - PAGE 21
POWERPACK 3 PRIMARY AND TEMPORARY
MOUNT FEATURES
Table 176 Programmable Parameters used with 595BAH
WIRING INFORMATION
WARNING: All electrical connections to the PowerPack 3 must be made by a qualified electrician. Failure to
follow this warning could result in property damage, personal injury, or death.
A Hubbell Watertight Safety-Shroud male plug (Hubbell part number HBL2611SW) is needed to connect to the
AC output plug to mate with the PowerPack supplied Hubbell Watertight Safety-Shroud female socket (Hubbell
part number HBL2613SW). These plugs are available at electrical and industrial supply houses.
Using this part combination will allow for a weather resistant connection to the PowerPack 3 unit. Alteration of
the AC output plug, failure to use the correct male plug, or removal of the supplied socket will not guarantee a
watertight connection.
Parameter ID Description Default Units Min Max Step
PPE3_param_
Auto_or_
Manual_ON
2473
If this is true, then the AC Power is
automatically activated when the
engine is started.
1 On/Off 0 1 1
PPE3_param_
mobile_or_
stationary
2487
If this is true, then the AC Power is
available any time the engine is
running
1 On/Off 0 1 1
PPE3_param_
Auto_ReStart
2488
If this is true, then the PowerPack 3
system will automatically attempt a
re-start after an over load event.
1 On/Off 0 1 1
PPE3_param_
ReStart_
Attempts
2490
This number indicates the number of
re-start attempts after an overload
event.
3 Number 0 7 1
PPE3_param_
ReStart_Delay
2489
If this is true, then the automatic
throttle increase request has been
enabled.
40 Seconds 0 60 10
PPE3_param_
incrThrottle_
rqst_enable
2357
If this is true, then the automatic
throttle increase request has been
enabled.
0 On/Off 0 1 1
PPE3_param_
incrThrottle_sta
rtDelay
2399
This parameter allows the throttle to
ramp to the target RPM prior to
enabling the PPE. The logic for this
parameter is that a maximum load on
the PPE would turn off the inverter if
the alternator RPMs are not at target.
2 Seconds 0 5 0.1
PPE3_param_
incrThrottle_
targetRPMs
2344
This is the target RPM rate for the
throttle increase feature.
935 RPM 900 2000 1
PPE3_param_
incrThrottle_
timeout
2345
The amount of time until the inverter
is inhibited because the engine
speed is not at an adequate level
5 Seconds 0 30 0.1
SECTION 28 - PAGE 22 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
POWERPACK 3 PRIMARY AND TEMPORARY
MOUNT FEATURES
The AC output from the PowerPack 3 is wired to a Ground Fault Circuit Interrupter (GFCI) to ensure protection
against GND fault conditions. Be aware that standard duplex GFCI and non-GFCI receptacles need to be
protected with a circuit breaker, usually rated for 15 or 20 AMPS. ..
PowerPack 3 Kit, Left Side under Cab for vehicles built after March 2007.
PowerPack 3 Kit, Right Side under Cab for vehicles built after March 2007.
PowerPack 3 Kit, Remote Mount for vehicles built after March 2007.
Fuse, 58 volt, 10 amp: Alternator Field Wire fuse. International
(Pre-2007 Vehicles)
SPN FMI Byte 7 Byte 8 Switch Indicator
Blink Rate
Condition Description/Comments/Probable Cause(s)
168 2 0 0 Fast
Communication fault from ESC to the PowerPack. Check for open
circuit or short in J1939 datalink. If switch is not blinking, verify vehicle
is programmed for PowerPack feature and the switchpack is
operating correctly.
168 3 0 0 Fast
DC module over voltage on vehicle DC bus. System detected voltage
over 15 volts. Remove any external power supply/charger from
vehicle
168 3 0 0 Slow
AC module over voltage condition on high voltage DC bus. Likely an
internal failure for AC output. AC has been shut down. DC output
remains on.
168 4 0 0 Fast
DC module under voltage condition on vehicle DC bus. System
detected low DC voltage. This could be due to insufficient power from
the alternator. Check the 3 phase wires from the alternator to the
PowerPack.
168 4 0 0 Slow
AC module under voltage condition on high voltage DC bus. System
detected low internal voltages. This could be due to insufficient input
power from the alternator. Check the 3 phase wires from the
alternator to the PowerPack.
168 6 0 0 Slow
AC module has shut down due to overload condition. AC overloaded,
remove some or all of AC load.
168 8 0 0 Fast
Phase missing fault/alternator fault. One of the three 3-phase wires
has an open circuit. Check the 3 phase wires from the alternator to
the PowerPack.
168 16 0 0 Fast
DC module over temperature condition. PowerPack is experiencing
extremely high internal temperatures. AC and DC has been shut
down. Allow the system to cool down.
168 16 0 0 Slow
AC module over temperature condition. PowerPack has detected high
internal temperatures although less severe. AC inverter has shut
down, but DC output remains on. Shut the system down to all it to
cool down or remove some of the loads.
168 17 0 0 Fast
PowerPack Fuse Open. Check DC battery charging connections from
PowerPack. Check 150A fuse.
639 14 37 255 Fast
Communication fault between PowerPack and the ESC. Check for
open circuit or short in J1939 datalink. Also, check the ignition circuit
to the PowerPack module
SECTION 28 - PAGE 24 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
POWERPACK 3 PRIMARY AND TEMPORARY
MOUNT FEATURES
Table 178 Diagnostic Indications Using the In-Cab Rocker Switch or Diamond Logic
Theft Deterrent system provides a means to help control the mobility of a vehicle. Once the
vehicle has been started, the driver is required to enter a pre-programmed code (theft deterrent code). The theft
deterrent code must also be entered when driving is resumed after the vehicle is at idle with the park brake set.
The theft deterrent feature is effective in preventing a vehicle from being driven by unauthorized individuals.
THEFT DETERRENT CODE
The theft deterrent code is any combination of one to eight digits (between 1 and 99999999) selected by the
customer. The Theft Deterrent system will come from the factory disabled. The dealer will be responsible for
enabling the system and programming the desired theft deterrent code during the regular dealer Pre-Delivery
Inspection (PDI). This is not included in the normal PDI reimbursement and is not a warranty expense.
THEFT DETERRENT SWITCHES
Six switches located in the Instrument Panel (IP) provide the functions of the Theft Deterrent system. Five of
the switches are dual digit switches (3-position, center stable momentary switches) numbered 0 to 9. The
remaining switch is the ENGINE STOP/CLEAR ENTRY switch, which is a combination switch indicator and a
standard momentary switch (see the illustration below).
The red ENGINE STOP indicator portion of the ENGINE STOP/CLEAR ENTRY switch flashes to alert the
driver that the theft deterrent code must be entered (within the preprogrammed time delay or the engine will
shut down). The momentary CLEAR ENTRY position is pressed whenever the driver needs to clear a failed
code so that the correct code can be re-entered.
NOTE: If the operator enters the wrong security code, the vehicle must be stopped and the park brake must be
set/engaged before the system will clear the previous theft deterrent code entry.
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
Software feature code 595AYU must be enabled on the vehicle Body Controller (BC) using the Diamond
Logic
dealer
2. Add software feature code 595AYU to the vehicle BC using the Diamond Logic
software).
For convenience a diagram of the RPM pin connections (Figure 3) is included in this document.
595BBL
This feature adds advanced logic for open center hydraulic systems. It is similar to 595BAM and 595BJA, but
specifically assigns the following signals to the equivalent pins as follows:
Please use the Diamond Logic
software to determine pin locations for RPM inputs (refer to the CONNECTOR
screen view) and to set programmable parameters (refer to the FEATURE screen view).
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
Software feature codes can be added through the Diamond Logic
software to determine pin locations for RPM inputs (refer to the CONNECTOR
screen view) and to set programmable parameters (refer to the FEATURE screen view).
All wiring to RPM inputs and outputs is customer supplied.
One wire may be connected to an RPM output (RPM #1, brown connector terminal A labeled PTO_Output in
the DLB connector view) and use as a 12-volt, 20 ampere source power for body builder installed equipment.
(Note: this RPM output can be biased to either the accessory key position or interlocked to the activation of
the ePTO mode of operation [default state] via feature 595BAM parameter 2494).
A second wire must be connected from the Body Builder-installed PTO feedback switch (GND active) to the
pin labeled PTO_Feedback_Switch in the black 23-pin RPM input connector. This feedback switch is used to
determine whether or not the PTO is engaged by determining if the switch is in the active state. If the switch
is in its active state, then an indicator light in the gauge cluster shall be activated. When the switch is not in
the active state, the indicator light will not be on.
The switch provided is labeled PTO.
RPM CONNECTOR INFORMATION
HPV Wire Terminal Kits are REQUIRED to allow Body Builders to create wire harnesses for the RPM
connectors.
HPV terminal kits are pre-made kits that include six power output terminals and seals for the brown 8-way
connect7r and six terminals for the black 23-way connector.
Table 185
NOTE: The following connectors are optional because they are already provided with the RPMs.
This information is given so that the Body Builder can purchase connectors in the event that the original
connectors are damaged or lost, or so that the Body Builder can pre-fabricate a wire harness.
Table 188 8-Way RPM Output Connector (Brown) and 23-Way RPM Input Connector (Black)
HPV Terminal Kits Part Number
RPM Terminal Kit 12 Gauge 2585651C91
RPM Terminal Kit 14 Gauge 2585423C91
Connector Part No. 3548934C1 2585981C91
Description Connector, Body, Brown 8Way RPM Output Connector, Body, Black 23-Way RPM Input Kit
Terminal Part
3534163C1 12 Gauge
3535931C1 14 Gauge
3535930C1 16 & 18 Gauge
1698937C1
Cable Seal Part
C3548945C1 12 & 14 Gauge
3535937C1 16 & 18 Gauge
N/A
Connector Lock Part 3548943C1 N/A
CPA Lock 3573833C1 N/A
Cavity Plug 3535938C1 Built into the connector
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 30 - PAGE 15
HYBRID ELECTRIC VEHICLE
Overview of Hybrid with ePTO Capability
f_183
SECTION 30 - PAGE 16 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
HYBRID ELECTRIC VEHICLE
Body Builder Integration Points: This is where the connections are made to integrate the hybrid ePTO
application with the chassis. The following two figures illustrate the necessary connections.
RPM Mounting Location on a DuraStar Model Truck
f_184
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 30 - PAGE 17
HYBRID ELECTRIC VEHICLE
RPM Connections for ePTO Hybrid Application
f_185
SECTION 30 - PAGE 18 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
HYBRID ELECTRIC VEHICLE
Mounting positions for air solenoids are different based upon vehicle air accessory content. Locate the air
solenoid labeled Pwr Take Off for controlling the PTO mechanism.
NORMAL SYSTEM OPERATION TEST
NORMAL SYSTEM OPERATION TEST
Start the diesel engine with transmission in neutral and the park brake set and the chassis hood closed.
Make sure the air pressure is greater than 110 psi and battery voltage is greater than 13.3 volts.
Depress the ePTO button on the shifter.
Verify that PTO lamp in the gauge cluster is turned on when the ePTO is successfully engaged.
Verify that the diesel engine shuts off.
Activate one of the hybrid demand circuit inputs. Verify that the hybrid electric motor activates.
De-activate the hybrid demand circuit input. Verify that the hybrid electric motor shuts off after the
programmed timeout period has elapsed.
GENERAL SYSTEM TESTS
To determine if the HOOD OPEN warning is working, open the hood and check that the HOOD OPEN light is
on and that the diesel engine cannot be started. (This functionality/feature also includes the park brake and
the in-cab key switch in ignition run position. The feature is designed to prevent the hybrid electric motor from
cranking or starting the engine. If the hood is open and/or the park brake is not set, the engine can still be
started from the in-cab-key switch.)
Verify that the pin labeled HEV_ePTO_Body_Equip_Pwr_Cmd of the brown 8-way Remote Power Module
output connector has the battery voltage levels present. (If parameter 2494 is enabled [default] this output
will source 12 volts at 20 amperes once the unit is in the ePTO mode of operation. Otherwise it will source 12
volts at 20 amperes when the in-cab key switch is in the ignition/run position and the vehicle is stationary).
Verify that the RPM input labeled HEV_ePTO_Engaged_Feedback, HEV_Remote_PTO_Disable,
HEV_Demand_Circuit_1, HEV_Demand_Circuit_2, HEV_Demand_Circuit_3 and HEV_Demand_Circuit_4
(pin positions specified by the Diamond Logic
software.
Verify that the STOP HYBRID and CHECK HYBRID lamps work by cycling the in-cab key switch to the
ignition/run position. This action will initiate a lamp test, illuminating these lamps for a period of 8 seconds
following the key switch initialization.
If the Service Disconnect switch is pushed in, the Check Hybrid light should be solid ON to indicate the
hybrid system is offline.
Air Solenoid Connections for ePTO Hybrid Application
f_186
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 30 - PAGE 19
HYBRID ELECTRIC VEHICLE
LOW AIR PRESSURE TEST
Start the diesel engine with transmission in neutral and the park brake set. Make sure the air pressure is
greater than 110 psi and battery voltage is greater than 13.3 volts.
Depress the ePTO button on the shifter.
Verify that the diesel engine shuts off.
Depress the brake pedal a number of times to allow air pressure to drop below the minimum air pressure
(default = 100 psi).
Wait for the minimum air pressure time to elapse (default = 10 sec).
Verify that the diesel engine starts to recharge the air supply.
EPTO DISABLE TEST
Start the diesel engine with transmission in neutral and the park brake set. Make sure the air pressure is
greater than 110 psi and battery voltage is greater than 13.3 volts.
Depress the ePTO button on the shifter.
Verify that the diesel engine shuts off.
Disengage the ePTO through the RPM input HEV_Remote_PTO_Disable.
Verify that the ePTO is disabled.
Once the HEV_Remote_PTO_Disable switch has been activated, the PTO mechanism cannot be
re-engaged until the HEV_Remote_PTO_Disable switch has been returned to its inactive state and the
ePTO request switch located in the Eaton shift console is recycled.
HOW TO ADD THIS FEATURE
This feature cannot be added aftermarket at the present time.
EATON 6-SPD HYBRID WITHOUT ePTO CAPABILITY
13GUB
TRANSMISSION, MANUAL {Eaton Fuller Eaton Hybrid EH-8E406A-T} 6-Speed Automated Manual, Hybrid
Drive Unit, With Electronic Shift Controls, Without ePTO Capability
13GUC
TRANSMISSION, MANUAL {Eaton Fuller Eaton Hybrid EH-8E406A-CDG} 6-Speed Automated Manual, Hybrid
Drive Unit, With Electronic Shift Controls and APG Capability; Without ePTO Capability
13GUD
TRANSMISSION, MANUAL {Eaton Fuller Eaton Hybrid EH-8E406A-CD} 6-Speed Automated Manual, Hybrid
Drive Unit, With Electronic Shift Controls, Without ePTO Capability
13GSB
EATON 6SPD HYBRID WITHOUT ePTO CAPABILTY for a Hybrid Electric Vehicle, includes warning lights.
13GSS
EATON 6SPD HYBRID WITHOUT ePTO CAPABILTY for a Hybrid Electric Vehicle, includes warning lights
Beverage Tractor Only.
This feature provides two warning lamps (STOP HYBRID and CHECK HYBRID) in a switch pack. A software
feature (see below) will need to be added if the vehicle will have a mechanical PTO installed.
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
Software feature codes can be added through the Diamond Logic
software.
SECTION 30 - PAGE 20 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
HYBRID ELECTRIC VEHICLE
REQUIRED SOFTWARE FEATURE CODE
595BAN
Optional software feature code: 595BBA (used if a mechanical PTO is installed on the vehicle). Please see the
appropriate PTO sections elsewhere in this manual for the specific PTO installed.
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES THAT MUST BE REMOVED
None
HEV SIGNALS AVAILABLE TO ADVANCED LOGIC
The following signals are available for use in Advanced Logic in Diamond Logic
.
HYBRID FAULT
The HEV_Check_Hybrid_Input signal is an input from the Hybrid Control Module (HCM) to indicate a
non-critical fault in the hybrid system.
The HEV_Stop_Hybrid_Input signal is an input signal from the Hybrid Control Module (HCM) to indicate a
critical fault in the hybrid system.
Overview of Hybrid Without ePTO Capability
f_187
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 SECTION 30 - PAGE 21
HYBRID ELECTRIC VEHICLE
TESTING
1. Verify that the STOP HYBRID and CHECK HYBRID lamps work by having key in run position and perform
a bulb check. The lamps should be on for 8 seconds.
2. Simulate the light turning on with Diamond Logic
I6 Engines
595296 595AZY ESC PROG, PRE-TRIP, ALL EXTERIOR LAMPS
595297 595AKZ (TEM) ESC PROG, UNIVERSAL AIR SOLENOID using normally open solenoids (qty 5)
595298 595AJJ
(TEM) ESC PROG, IP CLUSTER DISPLAY Omit Display of Fault Codes in Instrument
Cluster, Requires Service Tool to Retrieve and View Fault Codes
595299 595AKT (TEM) ESC PROG, WARN TAILGATE OPEN Dump Box Application
595300 595AJC (TEM) ESC PROG, UNIVERSAL AIR SOLENOID using normally open solenoids (qty 6)
595301 595AKU (TEM) ESC PROG, WARN DUMP BODY UP Application
595302 None
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
(BUS) ESC PROG, BUS FMVSS VALIDATION
595303 None
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
(BUS) ESC PROG, BUS ABS FMVSS VALIDATION
595304 None
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
(BUS) ESC PROG, BUS PWL FMVSS VALIDATION
595306 595AEH (BUS) ESC PROG, EXTERIOR LIGHT CHECK with Rocker Switch Activation
595307 595AGH (BUS) ESC PROG, Redundant Door Controls
595308 595AGJ (BUS) ESC PROG, Manual Door
595309 None
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
ESC PROG, AXLE, LIFT, CONTROLS for Automated and Manual Controls
595310 None
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM CONTROLLER, NVM, FOR BUS
595311 None
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
ELECCTRICAL SYSTEM CONTROLLER, NVM, FOR TRUCK
595312 595AGW
(BUS) ESC PROG, PUPIL WARNING Steering Wheel Mounted (SEQUENTIAL
WHERE DOOR CLOSED EXTINGUISHES RED PWL MODE)
595313 595AGX
(BUS) ESC PROG, PUPIL WARNING SEQUENTIAL FLASHERS VARIATION WITH A
THREE POSITION ROTARY DOOR SWITCH
595314 595AAH ESC PROG, HEADLIGHTS ON W/WIPERS
595315 595AGA (BUS) ESC PROG, Red Always Hot Override With Exit Buzzer
595316 595ANK ESC PROG, VORAD ENGINE DISPLAY
595317 595AEL (BUS) T/R DATA , PRNDL W/LCT 5-SPD With Park Pawl & Shifter Interlock
595318 595AGY
(BUS) ESC PROG, PUPIL WARNING LIGHTS Steering Wheel Mounted Switch,
(Sequential) With Illinois Master Switch (SEQUENTIAL)
595319 595AGZ
(BUS) ESC PROG, PUPIL WARNING LIGHTS Steering Wheel Mounted Switch, With
Illinois Master Switch (SEQUENTIAL WHERE DOOR CLOSED EXTINGUISHES RED
PWL MODE)
595320 None
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
(BUS) ESC PROG, HARDWARE CONFIG DATA PT with Extra Advanced Logic Outputs
595321 595AYY ESC PROG, PLOW LIGHTS compatible w/ Fog Lights
595322 595AMX (BUS) ESC PROG, IDLE SYSTEM, ENGINE RAMP With Low Battery
595323 595AHP (BUS) ESC PROG, WHEELCHAIR LIFT INTERLOCK W/XMSN IN PARK ONLY
595324 595AMH (BUS) T/R DATA, PRNDL W/LCT 5-SPD W/PWR PK W/LIFT DOOR SWITCH
595325 595AMJ
(BUS) T/R DATA, PRNDL W/LCT 5-SPD With Park Pawl and Shifter Interlock With Lift
Door Switch
595326 595AHR
(BUS) ESC PROG, WHEELCHAIR LIFT INTERLOCK W/XMSN IN PARK ONLY W/O
INDICATOR
595327 595AHS (BUS) ESC PROG, WHEELCHAIR LIFT INTERLOCK W/O INDICATOR
595328 595AZV ESC PROG, PARK BRAKE ALARM
595329 None
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
ESC PROG, IDLE WARNING SHUTDOWN IND LIGHT
595330 595AMM ESC PROG, TRANSMISSION WARN IND for LCT AND WTEC
595331 595AND ESC PROG, ECONOMY MODE LIGHT
ESC 595 Code 2007 BC
595 Code
PRE 2007 Feature Description
***All denotes 2000, DuraStar, WorkStar, 8000, Bus and Prostar Models***
32 - PAGE 8 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
CROSS REFERENCE
595332 595ANC
ESC PROG, RANGE INHIBITED WARN Light, for LCT and WTEC XMSNs, Allison Gen 4
XMSNs
595333 595AZU ESC PROG, INVERTER ON In Cab Multiplex Switch enables 3kw Inverter
595334 595AYU ESC PROG, THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
595335 None
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
ESC PROG, AUXILLIARY IGNITION, 1 AMP
595336 595ADL ESC PROG, REFRIDGERANT CONTROL, HVAC W/LIGHT IN LOWER CLUSTER
595337 595AZS
(BUS) ESC PROG, DLB PWL AND TURN SIGNAL GATEWAYS, w/engineering
read/write access
595338 595AZM (BUS) ESC PROG, POST TRIP INSPECTION With Snooze
595339 595ANA ESC PROG, ENGINE RAMP With A/C on, BUS
595341 None
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
(TEM) ESC PROG, EXTERNAL ENGINE SPEED CONTROL for UTILITY application for
on-demand engine speed
595342 None
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
(TEM) ESC PROG, SPECIAL AERIAL PKG, for Aerial Device position and warning
system
595343 595AZN ESC PROG, POST TRIP INSPECTION for Child Reminder System
595344 595ANY
ESC PROG, INTERLOCK WHEELCHAIR Less Indicator Light in Cluster, for Cutaway Bus
Chassis
595345 595AZR
ESC PROG, DUAL A/C COMPRESSOR ACCOMMODATION; for Low Speed
Acceleration Disable for Aftermarket A/C System
595346 595AZW
ESC PROG, SPECIAL FUEL WARNING SINGLE TANK; Low Fuel Warning Light and
Audible Alarm Activated Separately so Warning Light is Activated Prior to Audible Alarm;
Gauge shows full at 7/8 Capacity
595347 None
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
ESC PROG, TURN SIGNAL/BRAKE WITH BULB OUT DETECTION
595348 595AYV ESC PROG, XFER CASE STATUS GEN 4 ALLISON
595349 None
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
ESC PROG, IND LIGHT AIR BRAKE PRESSURE FAILURE
595350 None
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
ESC PROG, TRACTION CONTROL IND (Wabco) WITH TRACTION WARNING LIGHT,
FOR FULL POWER HYDRAULIC BRAKE, AIR BRAKE SYSTEM, NOT INCLUDING
TRAILER
595351 595AZJ
ESC PROG, MAX SPEED PARAMETER; Set at 80 mph, With Bus Models with Steering
Wheel Control Pupil Warning lights.
595352 None
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
ESC PROG, TRACTION CONTROL (Wabco ATC ENABLE/DISABLE) With Traction
Warning Light, for Full Power Hydraulic
595353 None
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
ESC PROG, TRACTION CONTROL (Bendix ATC OFF ROAD) With Traction Control
Warning Light & Switch, for Air Brake Systems Only, Not Including Trailers
595354 None
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
ESC PROG, WORK LIGHT Includes Keyless Entry and Timer Function Effects, (2) Default
Switch Located in Center Panel
None 595ADA BC PROG, BRAKE APPL GAUGE IN Prostar Secondary Gauge Cluster
None 595ADB BC PROG, TRAILER AUX CIRCUIT Accessory Powered
None 595ADC BC PROG, TRAILER AUX CIRCUIT Battery Powered
None 595ADD BC PROG, TRANSMISSION PTO Single
None 595ADG BC PROG, FUEL HEATER Will be Activated by BC
None 595ADH BC PROG, COMPASS DISPLAY
None 595ADS BC PROG, PRNDL Gear Display Eaton
None 595ADT BC PROG, PRNDL Gear Display Freedomline
None 595ADU BC PROG, INTERIOR FLOOR LIGHTS in Cab
None 595AEA BC PROG, ROLL STABILITY PROG
None 595AEB BC PROG, TRANSMISSION PTO Dual PTO
None 595AEC BC PROG, ELECT LOAD W/ICON SYS
None 595AED
BC PROG, BRAKE WARN INDICATOR Light and Audible Alarm; Parking Brake/Motion
Warning System for Engaged Parking Brake
None 595AEE BC PROG, COLLISION AVOIDANCE Requires Input From the Right Turn Signal.
ESC 595 Code 2007 BC
595 Code
PRE 2007 Feature Description
***All denotes 2000, DuraStar, WorkStar, 8000, Bus and Prostar Models***
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 32 - PAGE 9
CROSS REFERENCE
None 595AEG BC PROG, SKIRT LIGHTS Customer Supplied
None 595AES BC PROG, EXTERIOR LIGHT CHECK for MD, RH & SS
None 595BAA BC PROG, AIR POWER HYD PARK
None 595BAB BC PROG, ENGINE FAN DRIVE {Borg-Warner} Variable Speed
None 595BAC
BC PROG, PRNDL With 1000/2000 5 Speed Transmission With Power Park & Arens
Shifter
None 595AAE BC PROG, WINDSHIELD WIPER
None 595AAG BC PROG, HEADLIGHTS W/DRL With Auto
None 595AAJ BC PROG, HEADLIGHT REMINDER
None 595AAM BC PROG, PARK/MARKER LIGHTS
None 595AAN BC PROG, MARKER INTERRUPT SW Located in Steering Wheel
None 595AAR BC PROG, INTERIOR DOME LIGHTS in Cab
None 595AAS BC PROG, INTERIOR DOME LIGHTS in Sleeper
None 595AAT BC PROG, INTERIOR FLOOR LIGHTS in Sleeper
None 595AAU BC PROG, HEATED MIRRORS Rocker Switch, Aftermarket Only
None 595ABM BC PROG, TACHOMETER 2500 RPM
None 595ABS BC PROG, WORKLIGHT ON W/BACKUP
None 595ABT BC PROG, REMOTE for Worklights
None 595ABU BC PROG, REMOTE for Trailer Auxiliary Circuit Battery Powered
None 595ABX BC PROG, EXTERIOR LIGHT CHECK for ProStar
None 595ACC BC PROG, AXLE TEMP GAUGE Dual
None 595ACD BC PROG, AXLE TEMP GAUGE Single
None 595ACE BC PROG, FOG LIGHTS Rocker Switch
None 595ACG BC PROG, OUTSIDE TEMP MONITOR
None 595ACL BC PROG, ELECTRICAL LOAD CONTL
None 595ACM BC PROG, ENGINE COMPRESSION BRAKE Located in Steering Wheel
None 595ACN BC PROG, AIR HORN Analog Input
None 595ACP BC PROG, FIFTH WHEEL UNLOCK
None 595ACR BC PROG, FRT AXLE LOAD MONITOR
None 595ACS BC PROG, RR AXLE LOAD MONITOR
None 595ACT BC PROG, LOCKING DIFFERENTIAL Includes Two Switches one for each Differential
None 595ACV BC PROG, ENGINE AIR MONITOR
None 595ACX BC PROG, INTAKE MANIFOLD PRESS
None 595ADJ BC PROG, REMOTE START/STOP In Bunk
None 595ADM BC PROG, HVAC In Sleeper
None 595ADY BC PROG, TRANS OIL TEMP Through Body
None 595ALL BC PROG, SNOW PLOW LIGHTS Rocker Switch
None 595ALM BC PROG, FLASHER SYS OUTPUTS
None 595ALT BC PROG, FUEL TANK GAUGE Single Left Side
None 595AMU BC PROG, WORK LIGHT Rocker Switch
None 595ANR BC PROG, PARK BRAKE RELAY
None 595ANS BC PROG, MAX. ENGINE OIL TEMP Before the Warn Indicator Light is Activated
None 595ANT
BC PROG, IDLE MANAGEMENT SYS for Cummins ICON, W/Freedomline Xmsns,
Cruise Control State Must be Maintained Across Key Cycles Instead of Resetting
None 595ANU
BC PROG, ENGINE IDLE Increment/Decrement to allow idle adjust on Cummins or IBB
Engines
None 595ANV BC PROG, DIAGNOSTICS LOCATION No On Board Display
None 595ANW BC PROG, DIAGNOSTICS LOCATION Display in Gauge Cluster
None 595ANX BC PROG, DIAGNOSTICS LOCATION In VID
None 595ANZ
BC PROG, IDLE MANAGEMENT SYS for Cummins ICON, N/Freedomline Xmsns, Cruise
Control State Must be Maintained Across Key Cycles Instead of Resetting
None 595AXY BC PROG, FUEL TANK GAUGE Dual Right Side Draw
None 595AYE BC PROG, IP CONFIGURATION for ProStar
None 595AYG
BC PROG, ENGINE TYPE MFG International
HDD
None 595AYH BC PROG, ENGINE FAN DRIVE Variable Speed
None 595AYJ BC PROG, CRUSE CONTL STEER WH ON/OFF, With Diagnosable Switches
None 595AYM BC PROG, LIFT GATE WIRING PACK Rocker Position
None 595AYR BC PROG, ECONOMY MODE SWITCH
None 595AYW
BC PROG, EXHAUST CLOGGED IND. Indicator for Clogged Diesel Particulate Filter in
Aftertreatment
ESC 595 Code 2007 BC
595 Code
PRE 2007 Feature Description
***All denotes 2000, DuraStar, WorkStar, 8000, Bus and Prostar Models***
32 - PAGE 10 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
CROSS REFERENCE
None 595AYX
BC PROG, EXHAUST HIGH TEMP Indicator for High Exhaust Temperatures
(Aftertreatment)
None 595AYZ BC PROG, INHIBIT REGEN SWITCH Latched (TWO POSITION, BI-STABLE)
None 595AZA
BC PROG, INHIBIT REGEN SWITCH Momentary (THREE POSITION,
CENTER-STABLE)
None 595AZB
BC PROG, ENGINE COMPRESSION BR With Programmable Levels; Uses On/Off
Switch in Steering Wheel and 1/2/3 Switch in Switchpack
None 595AZC
BC PROG, ENGINE COMPRESSION BR With Programmable Levels; Located in Switch
Pack
None 595AZD
BC PROG, ENGINE COMPRESSION BR With Variable & Programmable Levels; Located
in Switch Pack
None 595AZE
BC PROG, EXHAUST TEMP LIGHT Indicator Light in IP; for High Exhaust Temperatures
(Aftertreatment) for ProStar.
None 595AZG
BC PROG, EXHAUST CLOGGED IND. Indicator Light in IP; for Clogged Diesel
Particulate Filter In Aftertreatment, for ProStar
None 595AZH BC PROG, PARKED REGEN SWITCH for Aftertreatment
None 595AZK BC PROG, FRT AXLE LOAD MONITOR Meets SAE Standard, Forward Axle
None 595AZL BC PROG, RR AXLE LOAD MONITOR Meets SAE Standards, for Rear Axle
None 595BAD BC PROG, BODY CONTROLLER for Bus Body Controller
None 595BAE BC PROG, DATA LOG INDICATOR for Telematics System
None 595BAG
BC PROG, SEATBELT LIGHT IND. Alarm and Continuous Flashing Indicator until
Seatbelt is Fastened
None 595BAH BC PROG, INVERTER ON Stationary and Moving
None 595BAJ BC PROG, INVERTER ON Stationary Only
None 595BAK
BC PROG, ENGINE IDLE SHUTDOWN Indicator Light in Cluster Warning that Engine
Ready to Shutdown
None 595BAL BC PROG, INDICATOR, HOOD OPEN for Hybrid Electric Vehicle
None 595BAM BC PROG, HEV E-PTO for Hybrid Electric Vehicle
None 595BAN BC PROG, WARNING LIGHTS for Hybrid Electric Vehicle
None 595BAP
BC PROG, SEATBELT LIGHT IND. for BUS; Alarm and Continuous Flashing Indicator
until Seatbelt is Fastened
None 595BAR BC PROG, IDLE MANAGEMENT SYS for Heat/HVAC
None 595BAS BC PROG, REMOTE ENGINE SPEED With Cummins Engine
None 595BAT BC PROG, HEADLIGHTS W/DRL With Pupil Warning with Auto
None 595BAU BC PROG, HEADLIGHT REMINDER for Bus
None 595BAV Engine Exhaust Regeneration Control and Monitoring for BUS
None 595BAW BC PROG, FIFTH WHEEL UNLOCK Includes Two Air Solenoids
None 595BAX
BC PROG, TRACTION CONTROL IND {Wabco ATC ENABLE?DISABLE} With Traction
Warning Light, for Full Power Hydraulic
None 595BAY BC PROG, 5TH WHEEL JAW MONITOR Includes Two Warning Indicators
None 595BAZ
BC PROG, FOG LIGHTS With Auto Headlights, Rocker Switch to be located in Center
Panel Switch Housing, for Bus
None 595BBA BC PROG, CONVENTIONAL PTO With HEV (non-ePTO)
None 595BBB BC PROG, ENGINE FAN OVERRIADE for Low Air Pressure, No Switch
None 595BBC BC PROG, AIR SUSPENSION DUMP Programmable Max Speed
None 595BBD BC PROG, AIR SOLENOID #6 (Universal Normally Closed)
None 595BBE BC PROG, PRNDL Gear Display Eaton with Park Prawl
None 595BBG BC PROG, THEFT DETERRENT SYS for ProStar
None 595BBH
BC PROG, PRNDL No PRNDL With 1000/2000 6 Speed Transmission not With Power
Park or Park Prawl
None 595BBJ
BC PROG, PRNDL No PRNDL With 1000/2000 6 Speed Transmission With Power Park &
Shifter Interlock
None 595BBL BC PROG, HEV ADVANCED LOGIC for Open Center Hydraulic Systems
None 595BBM
BC PROG, ENGINE IDLE SHUTDOWN 2010 Indicator Light in Cluster Warning that
Engine Ready to Shutdown
None 595BBN BC PROG, HEV DRIVER DISPLAY Located in AGSP
None 595BBR BC PROG, TURN SIGNAL BULB OUT ECE R48 Compliant with Fault Detection
None 595BHG SINGLE SPD XFER CASE W/ODOMETER SHUTOFF
None 595BHH HEADLIGHT REMINDER #2
None 595BHJ BC PROG, LOGIC BUILDER FOR DLB LIGHT ACCESS
ESC 595 Code 2007 BC
595 Code
PRE 2007 Feature Description
***All denotes 2000, DuraStar, WorkStar, 8000, Bus and Prostar Models***
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 32 - PAGE 11
CROSS REFERENCE
None 595BHK BC PROG, HVAC In Cab With Switch Controls (Bergstrom)
None 595BHL BC PROG, DASH IND. LT RED (1)
None 595BHM BC PROG, DASH IND. LT RED (2)
None 595BHN BC PROG, DASH IND. LT RED (3)
None 595BHP BC PROG, DASH IND. LT RED (6)
None 595BHR BC PROG, DASH IND. LT GREEN (1)
None 595BHS BC PROG, DASH IND. LT GREEN (2)
None 595BHT BC PROG, DASH IND. LT GREEN (3)
None 595BHU BC PROG, DASH IND. LT GREEN (6)
None 595BHV BC PROG, DASH IND. LT YELLOW (1)
None 595BHW BC PROG, DASH IND. LT YELLOW (2)
None 595BHX BC PROG, DASH IND. LT YELLOW (3)
None 595BHY BC PROG, DASH IND. LT YELLOW (6)
None 595BHZ BC PROG, AUXILIARY LOAD #7 for (2) Rocker Switches and (2) Relays
None 595BJA BC PROG, HEV E-PTO 2010 Hybrid Electric Vehicle
None 595BJB BC PROG, WAIT TO START IND. 2010
None 595BJC
BC PROG, EXHAUST CLOGGED IND. 2010, Indicator for Clogged Diesel Particulate
Filter in Aftertreatment
None 595BJD
BC PROG, EXHAUST HIGH TEMP 2010, Indicator for High Exhaust Temperatures
(Aftertreatment)
None 595BJE BC PROG, INHIBIT REGEN SWITCH 2010, Latched
None 595BJG BC PROG, INHIBIT REGEN SWITCH 2010, Momentary
None 595BJH BC PROG, IP CONFIGURATION 2010, for MD, RH & SS
None 595BJJ BC PROG, PARKED REGEN SWITCH 2010 Aftertreatment
None 595BJK
BC PROG, RANGE INHIBITED WARN 2010, Light for 1000, 2000, 3000 & 4000 Allison
Gen 4 Transmission
None 595BJL
BC PROG, TRACTION CONTROL IND (Bendix ATC Off Road) 2010, With Traction
Warning Light, for Air Brakes
None 595BJM BC PROG, IP CONFIGURATION 2010, for ProStar & LoneStar
None 595BJN BC PROG, HVAC 2010, In Sleeper (Behr) and Cab (Bergstrom)
None 595BJP
BC PROG, TRACTION CONTROL IND (Wabco ATC MUD/SNOW) 2010, With Traction
Warning Light, for Full Power Hydraulic Brake or Air Brakes, Not Including Trailer
None 595BJR BC PROG, LOGIC BUILDER 2010 Enabler
None 595BJS
BC PROG, PTO MONITOR 2010, for Indicator and Alarm Connected to Remote Power
Module
None 595BJT BC PROG, PTO MONITOR 2010, for Indicator and Alarm Connected to Body Controller
None 595BJU BC PROG, IP CONFIGURATION 2010 for Bus
None 595BJV BC PROG, PARKED REGEN SWITCH 2010, for Aftertreatment Switch Blank for BUS
None 595BJW BC PROG, DIESEL PART FILTER ID 2010 Level Indicator
None 595BJX BC PROG, XFER CASE 2 SPD W/2007 V8
None 595BJY
BC PROG, TRACTION CONTROL IND {(Wabco ATC ENABLE/DISABLE}) 2010, With
Traction Warning Light, for Full Power Hydraulic
None 595BJZ BC PROG, HEADLIGHTS WIG WAG With Bus Pupil Warning Lights
None 595BKA BC PROG, FULL TIME LIGHTS
None 595BKB BC PROG, IDLE MANAGEMENT SYSTEM for Heat/HVAC (Bergstrom)
None 595BKC BC PROG, HVAC, In Sleeper (Bergstrom) and Cab (Behr)
None 595BKD BC PROG, BODY CONTROLLER for Truck Body Controller #2
None 595BKE BC PROG, BODY CONTROLLER for Bus Body Controller #2
None 595BKG BC PROG, INTERLOCK WHEELCHAIR 2010 With Indicator Light in Cluster
None 595BKH
BC PROG, INTERLOCK WHEELCHAIR 2010 With Transmission in Park, Indicator Light
in Cluster, Bus Only
None 595BKJ BC PROG, TRANSMISSION PTO SINGLE, for 2010
None 595BKK BC PROG, TRANSMISSION PTO for 2010; Dual PTO
None 595BKL BC PROG, ENGINE RETARDER for 2010; Located in Steering Wheel
None 595BKM
BC PROG, ENGINE RETARDER for 2010; With Programmable Levels; Uses On/Off
Switch in Steering Wheel and 1/2/3 Switch in Switchpack
None 595BKN BC PROG, ENGINE COMPRESSION BRAKE with Optional Jake Brake Foot Pedal
None 595BKX
BC PROG, TRACTION CONTROL IN {Bendix ATC ENABLE/DISABLE} With Traction
Warning Light, for Air Brakes
ESC 595 Code 2007 BC
595 Code
PRE 2007 Feature Description
***All denotes 2000, DuraStar, WorkStar, 8000, Bus and Prostar Models***
32 - PAGE 12 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
CROSS REFERENCE
None 595BKY
BC PROG, PTO SHIFT for (1) Dash Switch with 30 AMP Relay, for Customer Provided
PTO
None 595BKZ BC PROG, HVAC 2010, In Cab With Remote AC Condenser
None 595BLA BC PROG, HVAC 2010, In Cab & Sleeper With Remote AC Condenser
None 595BLB
BC PROG, HVAC 2010 in Cab With Remote AC Condenser, with Pinout/Relay Drivers 31
& 32
None 595BLM BC PROG, HVAC Condenser Pusher Fan Control
None 595BLN BC PROG, HEADLIGHTS WIG WAG With Highbeam Flash
None 595BLP BC PROG, HEADLIGHTS WIG WAG With Lowbeam or Highbeam Flash
None 595BLS
BC PROG, AIR SUSP LOAD CONTRL for Tandem Weight Bias Suspension Air Control
Valve
None 595BLT BC PROG, SNOW VALVE Engine Air Intake
None 595BLU BC PROG, REAR AXLE LOAD MONITOR #7 for Tandem Hendrickson HAS 40-6-K
None 595BLV BC PROG, REAR AXLE LOAD MONITOR #2 for Single HAS 23K
None 595BLW BC PROG, REAR AXLE LOAD MONITOR #3 for Single IROS Long MSM 12-15.5K
None 595BLX BC PROG, REAR AXLE LOAD MONITOR #4 for Single IROS Long MSM 18-21K
None 595BLY BC PROG, REAR AXLE LOAD MONITOR #5 for Single IROS Short MSM 20K
None 595BLZ BC PROG, REAR AXLE LOAD MONITOR #6 for Tandem Hendrickson HTB 40K
None 595BMA BC PROG, ROLL STABILLITY PROG {Wabco}
None 595BMH BC PROG, TRANS HILL START AID for Ultra Shift Plus Transmission
None 595BMJ BC PROG, FOG LIGHTS REAR ECE R38 Compliant, Red LED
None 595BMK BC PROG, FOG LIGHTS ECE R19/48 Compliant
None 595BML BC PROG, DAYTIME RUN/LIGHT ECE R87/48 Compliant
None 595BMN BC PROG, IND DAY RUN/LIGHTS ECE R48, On Dash
None 595BMS
BC PROG, TRACTION CONTROL IND {Bendix ATC Enable/Disable} with Traction
Warning Light, for Air Brakes, with 2010 Cluster
None 595BMT BC PROG, IND LIGHT AIR BRAKE Pressure Failure
None 595BMU BC PROG, ADJ SPEED LIMIT Include Switch in Center Panel
None 595BMV BC PROG, ACCELERATOR INTERLOCK
None 595BMW BC PROG, UPSHIFT INDICATOR LIGHT
None 595BMX BC PROG, USER ACTIVATED DATA Logger
None 595BMY BC PROG, ELECTRICAL LOAD CONTRL 11.8 Volts
None 595BMZ
BC PROG, PARKED REGEN SWITCH 2010, Aftertreatment to Allow Parked Regen
Below Light Level for Service Use Only, Do Not Infuse
None 595BNA
BC PROG, BRAKE LT W/Retarder ECE or ADR Compliant; Brake Light ON with Retarder
Activated
None 595BNB BC PROG, DM1 HEARTBEAT for pre 2007 Engines
None 595BNJ BC PROG, HYDRAULIC BRAKE SPLIT for Hydro Max
None 595BNN BC PROG, TRANSMISSION PTO Dual PTO, for 2010 with 42 Parameters
None 595BNP BC PROG, TRANSMISSION PTO, Single PTO, for 2010 with 42 Parameters
None 595BNY BC PROG, ENGINE FAN WARNING BUZZER
None 595BPB BC PROG, ENGINE FAN DRIVE Variable Speed
None 595BPC BC PROG, CRUISE SWITCH DISABLE with Park Brake Set
None 595BPD
BC PROG, PRNDL with 1000/2000 6 SPD Transmission not With Power Park or Park
Prawl
None 595BPE
BC PROG, PRNDL with 1000/2000 6 SPD Transmission With Park Prawl and Shifter
Interlock
None 595BPG
BC PROG, PRNDL with 1000/2000 6 SPD Transmission With Power Park and Shifter
Interlock
None 595BPK
BC PROG, PRNDL with 1000/2000 6 SPD Transmission With Sixth-Gear Disable and
Park Prawl and Shifter Interlock
None 595BPL
BC PROG, PRNDL with 1000/2000 6 SPD Transmission With Sixth-Gear Disable not With
Power Park or Park Prawl
None 595BPM
BC PROG, PRNDL with 1000/2000 6 SPD Transmission With Sixth-Gear Disable and
Power Park and Shifter Interlock
ESC 595 Code 2007 BC
595 Code
PRE 2007 Feature Description
***All denotes 2000, DuraStar, WorkStar, 8000, Bus and Prostar Models***
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 32 - PAGE 13
CROSS REFERENCE
Table 197 595 Feature Codes Sorted by Post-2007 Feature Code Number
2007 BC
595 CODE
ESC 595 CODE POST 2007 Feature Description
***All denotes 2000, DuraStar, WorkStar, 8000, Bus and Prostar Models***
595AAA 595232 BC PROG, BODY CONTROLLER
595AAC 595031 BC PROG, KEY STATE
595AAD 595015 BC PROG, BRAKE SWITCH
595AAE None BC PROG, WINDSHIELD WIPER
595AAG None BC PROG, HEADLIGHTS W/DRL With Auto
595AAH 595188 BC PROG, LIGHTS ON W/WIPERS
595AAH 595314 BC PROG, LIGHTS ON W/WIPERS
595AAJ None BC PROG, HEADLIGHT REMINDER
595AAK 595106 BC PROG, DRL OMIT
595AAL 595021 BC PROG, TURN SIGNALS/BRAKE With Combined Stop and Turns
595AAM None BC PROG, PARK/MARKER LIGHTS
595AAN None BC PROG, MARKER INTERRUPT SW Located in Steering Wheel
595AAP 595083 BC PROG, CRUISE CONTL STEER WHEEL
595AAR None BC PROG, INTERIOR DOME LIGHTS in Cab
595AAS None BC PROG, INTERIOR DOME LIGHTS in Sleeper
595AAT None BC PROG, INTERIOR FLOOR LIGHTS in Sleeper
595AAU None BC PROG, HEATED MIRRORS Rocker Switch, Aftermarket Only
595AAV 595023 BC PROG, HORN ELECTRIC
595AAW 595153 BC PROG, LOW ENGINE COOLANT
595AAX 595185 BC PROG, THROTTLE SWITCH Pack On/Off
595AAZ 595014 BC PROG, PARK BRAKE INDICATOR
595ABA 595063 BC PROG, SEATBELT INDICATOR
595ABB 595008 BC PROG, AIR PRESSURE GAUGES
595ABC 595030 BC PROG, TRAILER LIGHTING
595ABD 595052 BC PROG, FUEL TANK GAUGE Single Right Side
595ABE 595192 BC PROG, FUEL TANK GAUGE Dual Left Side Draw
595ABG 595130
BC PROG, ENGINE TYPE MFG International
HDD
595AYH None BC PROG, ENGINE FAN DRIVE Variable Speed
595AYJ None BC PROG, CRUISE CONTL STEER WH ON/OFF, With Diagnosable Switches
595AYK 595093 BC PROG, FRONT AIR SUSPENSION
595AYL 595287 BC PROG, THROTTLE CRUISE Without Cruise in Switch Pack
595AYM None BC PROG, LIFT GATE WIRING PAK Rocker Position
595AYN 595266 BC PROG, PTO MONITOR for Indicator and Alarm Connected to Body Controller
595AYP 595038 BC PROG, AUTO NEUTRAL
595AYR None BC PROG, ECONOMY MODE SWITCH
595AYS 595105 BC PROG, IP CONFIGURATION for MD, RH, & SS
595AYT 595227 BC PROG, IP CONFIGURATION for Bus
595AYU 595334
BC PROG, THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM to Read a Combination Code From a 6-Pack
and Send TSC1 Messages to Limit Engine Speed if an Incorrect Code is Entered
595AYV 595348 BC PROG, XFER CASE STATUS To TCM; for Allison Gen 4 Transmissions
595AYW None
BC PROG, EXHAUST CLOGGED IND. Indicator for Clogged Diesel Particulate Filter in
Aftertreatment
595AYX None
BC PROG, EXHAUST HIGH TEMP Indicator for High Exhaust Temperatures
(Aftertreatment)
595AYY 595321 BC PROG, SNOW PLOW LIGHTS GEN 2, With Rocker Switch
595AYZ None BC PROG, INHIBIT REGEN SWITCH Latched (TWO POSITION, BI-STABLE)
595AZA None
BC PROG, INHIBIT REGEN SWITCH Momentary (THREE POSITION,
CENTER-STABLE)
595AZB None
BC PROG, ENGINE COMPRESSION BRAKE With Programmable Levels; Uses On/Off
Switch in Steering Wheel and 1/2/3 Switch in Switchpack
595AZC None
BC PROG, ENGINE COMPRESSION BR With Programmable Levels; Located in Switch
Pack
595AZD None
BC PROG, ENGINE COMPRESSION BR With Variable & Programmable Levels; Located
in Switch Pack
595AZE None
BC PROG, EXHAUST TEMP LIGHT Indicator Light in IP; for High Exhaust Temperatures
(Aftertreatment) for ProStar.
595AZG None
BC PROG, EXHAUST CLOGGED IND. Indicator Light in IP; for Clogged Diesel Particulate
Filter In Aftertreatment, for ProStar
595AZH None BC PROG, PARKED REGEN SWITCH for Aftertreatment
595AZJ 595351
BC PROG, MAX SPEED PARAMETER for PWL; Set at 80 mph, With Bus Models with
Steering Wheel Control Pupil Warning lights.
595AZK None BC PROG, FRONT AXLE LOAD MONITOR Meets SAE Standard, Forward Axle
595AZL None BC PROG, REAR AXLE LOAD MONITOR Meets SAE Standards, for Rear Axle
595AZM 595338 BC PROG, POST TRIP INSPECTION With Snooze
595AZN 595343 BC PROG, POST TRIP INSPECTION for Child Reminder System
595AZR 595345
BC PROG, A/C COMPRESSOR ACCOM. DUAL; for Low Speed Acceleration Disable for
Aftermarket A/C System
595AZS 595337
BC PROG, ADVANCED LOGIC DLB for Service and Engineering Changes on Bus Only
Not to be infused on any vehicle (DO NOT INFUSE)
595AZU 595333 BC PROG, INVERTER ON In Cab Multiplex Switch enables 3kw Inverter
595AZV 595328 BC PROG, PARK BRAKE ALARM
595AZW 595346
BC PROG, SPECIAL FUEL WARNING SINGLE TANK; Low Fuel Warning Light and
Audible Alarm Activated Separately so Warning Light is Activated Prior to Audible Alarm;
Gauge shows full at 7/8 Capacity
595AZX 595231 BC PROG, LOGIC BUILDER Enabler
595AZY 595296 BC PROG, EXTERIOR LIGHT CHECK Push Button B; for MD, RH & SS
2007 BC
595 CODE
ESC 595 CODE POST 2007 Feature Description
***All denotes 2000, DuraStar, WorkStar, 8000, Bus and Prostar Models***
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 32 - PAGE 19
CROSS REFERENCE
595AZZ 595251 BC PROG, PARK/MARKER LIGHTS Dual Output, 20AMP
595BAA None BC PROG, AIR POWER HYD PARK
595BAB None BC PROG, ENGINE FAN DRIVE {Borg-Warner} Variable Speed
595BAC None
BC PROG, PRNDL With 1000/2000 5 Speed Transmission With Power Park & Arens
Shifter
595BAD None BC PROG, BODY CONTROLLER for Bus Body Controller
595BAE None BC PROG, DATA LOG INDICATOR for Telematics System
595BAG None
BC PROG, SEATBELT LIGHT IND. Alarm and Continuous Flashing until Seatbelt is
Fastened
595BAH None BC PROG, INVERTER ON Stationary and Moving
595BAJ None BC PROG, INVERTER ON Stationary Only
595BAK None
BC PROG, ENGINE IDLE SHUTDOWN Indicator Light in Cluster Warning that Engine
Ready to Shutdown
595BAL None BC PROG, INDICATOR, HOOD OPEN for Hybrid Electric Vehicle
595BAM None BC PROG, HEV E-PTO for Hybrid Electric Vehicle
595BAN None BC PROG, WARNING LIGHTS for Hybrid Electric Vehicle
595BAP None
BC PROG, SEATBELT LIGHT IND. for BUS; Alarm and Continuous Flashing Indicator
until Seatbelt is Fastened
595BAR None BC PROG, IDLE MANAGEMENT SYS for Heat/HVAC
595BAS None BC PROG, REMOTE ENGINE SPEED With Cummins Engine
595BAT None BC PROG, HEADLIGHTS W/DRL With Pupil Warning with Auto
595BAU None BC PROG, HEADLIGHT REMINDER for Bus
595BAV None Engine Exhaust Regeneration Control and Monitoring for BUS
595BAW None BC PROG, FIFTH WHEEL UNLOCK Includes Two Air Solenoids
595BAX None
BC PROG, TRACTION CONTROL IND {Wabco ATC ENABLE/DISABLE} With Traction
Warning Light, for Full Power Hydraulic
595BAY None BC PROG, 5TH WHEEL JAW MONITOR Includes Two Warning Indicators
595BAZ None
BC PROG, FOG LIGHTS With Auto Headlights, Rocker Switch to be located in Center
Panel Switch Housing, for Bus
595BBA None BC PROG, CONVENTIONAL PTO With HEV (non-ePTO)
595BBB None BC PROG, ENGINE FAN OVERRIADE for Low Air Pressure, No Switch
595BBC None BC PROG, AIR SUSPENSION DUMP Programmable Max Speed
595BBD None BC PROG, AIR SOLENOID #6 (Universal Normally Closed)
595BBE None BC PROG, PRNDL Gear Display Eaton with Park Prawl
595BBG None BC PROG, THEFT DETERRENT SYS for ProStar
595BBH None
BC PROG, PRNDL No PRNDL With 1000/2000 6 Speed Transmission not With Power
Park or Park Prawl
595BBJ None
BC PROG, PRNDL No PRNDL With 1000/2000 6 Speed Transmission With Power Park &
Shifter Interlock
595BBL None BC PROG, HEV ADVANCED LOGIC for Open Center Hydraulic Systems
595BBM None
BC PROG, ENGINE IDLE SHUTDOWN 2010 Indicator Light in Cluster Warning that
Engine Ready to Shutdown
595BBN None BC PROG, HEV DRIVER DISPLAY Located in AGSP
595BBR None BC PROG, TURN SIGNAL BULB OUT ECE R48 Compliant with Fault Detection
595BHG None BC PROG, SINGLE SPD XFER CASE W/ODOMETER SHUTOFF
595BHH None BC PROG, HEADLIGHT REMINDER #2
595BHJ None BC PROG, LOGIC BUILDER FOR DLB LIGHT ACCESS
595BHK None BC PROG, HVAC In Cab With Switch Controls (Bergstrom)
595BHL None BC PROG, DASH IND. LT RED (1)
595BHM None BC PROG, DASH IND. LT RED (2)
595BHN None BC PROG, DASH IND. LT RED (3)
595BHP None BC PROG, DASH IND. LT RED (6)
595BHR None BC PROG, DASH IND. LT GREEN (1)
595BHS None BC PROG, DASH IND. LT GREEN (2)
595BHT None BC PROG, DASH IND. LT GREEN (3)
595BHU None BC PROG, DASH IND. LT GREEN (6)
595BHV None BC PROG, DASH IND. LT YELLOW (1)
595BHW None BC PROG, DASH IND. LT YELLOW (2)
595BHX None BC PROG, DASH IND. LT YELLOW (3)
595BHY None BC PROG, DASH IND. LT YELLOW (6)
2007 BC
595 CODE
ESC 595 CODE POST 2007 Feature Description
***All denotes 2000, DuraStar, WorkStar, 8000, Bus and Prostar Models***
32 - PAGE 20 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
CROSS REFERENCE
595BHZ None BC PROG, AUXILIARY LOAD #7 for (2) Rocker Switches and (2) Relays
595BJA None BC PROG, HEV E-PTO 2010 Hybrid Electric Vehicle
595BJB None BC PROG, WAIT TO START IND. 2010
595BJC None
BC PROG, EXHAUST CLOGGED IND. 2010, Indicator for Clogged Diesel Particulate
Filter in Aftertreatment
595BJD None
BC PROG, EXHAUST HIGH TEMP 2010, Indicator for High Exhaust Temperatures
(Aftertreatment)
595BJE None BC PROG, INHIBIT REGEN SWITCH 2010, Latched
595BJG None BC PROG, INHIBIT REGEN SWITCH 2010, Momentary
595BJH None BC PROG, IP CONFIGURATION 2010, for MD, RH & SS
595BJJ None BC PROG, PARKED REGEN SWITCH 2010 Aftertreatment
595BJK None
BC PROG, RANGE INHIBITED WARN 2010, Light for 1000, 2000, 3000 & 4000 Allison
Gen 4 Transmission
595BJL None
BC PROG, TRACTION CONTROL IND (Bendix ATC Off Road) 2010, With Traction
Warning Light, for Air Brakes
595BJM None BC PROG, IP CONFIGURATION 2010, for ProStar & LoneStar
595BJN None BC PROG, HVAC 2010, In Sleeper (Behr) and Cab (Bergstrom)
595BJP None
BC PROG, TRACTION CONTROL IND (Wabco ATC MUD/SNOW) 2010, With Traction
Warning Light, for Full Power Hydraulic Brake or Air Brakes, Not Including Trailer
595BJR None BC PROG, LOGIC BUILDER 2010 Enabler
595BJS None
BC PROG, PTO MONITOR 2010, for Indicator and Alarm Connected to Remote Power
Module
595BJT None BC PROG, PTO MONITOR 2010, for Indicator and Alarm Connected to Body Controller
595BJU None BC PROG, IP CONFIGURATION 2010 for Bus
595BJV None BC PROG, PARKED REGEN SWITCH 2010, for Aftertreatment Switch Blank for BUS
595BJW None BC PROG, DIESEL PART FILTER ID 2010 Level Indicator
595BJX None BC PROG, XFER CASE 2 SPD W/2007 V8
595BJY None
BC PROG, TRACTION CONTROL IND (Wabco ATC ENABLE/DISABLE) 2010, With
Traction Warning Light, for Full Power Hydraulic
595BJZ None BC PROG, HEADLIGHTS WIG WAG With Bus Pupil Warning Lights
595BKA None
BC PROG, FULL TIME LIGHTS Provides Head Lights, Park Lights, and Panel Lights when
the Engine is Running
595BKB None
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
BC PROG, IDLE MANAGEMENT SYSTEM for Heat/HVAC (Bergstrom)
595BKC None
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
BC PROG, HVAC, In Sleeper (Bergstrom) and Cab (Behr)
595BKD None BC PROG, BODY CONTROLLER for Truck Body Controller #2
595BKE None BC PROG, BODY CONTROLLER for Bus Body Controller #2
595BKG None BC PROG, INTERLOCK WHEELCHAIR 2010 With Indicator Light in Cluster
595BKH None
BC PROG, INTERLOCK WHEELCHAIR 2010 With Transmission in Park, Indicator Light in
Cluster, Bus Only
595BKJ None BC PROG, TRANSMISSION PTO Single, for 2010
595BKK None BC PROG, TRANSMISSION PTO for 2010; Dual PTO
595BKL None BC PROG, ENGINE RETARDER for 2010; Located in Steering Wheel
595BKM None
BC PROG, ENGINE RETARDER for 2010; With Programmable Levels; Uses On/Off
Switch in Steering Wheel and 1/2/3 Switch in Switchpack
595BKN None BC PROG, ENGINE COMPRESSION BRAKE with Optional Jake Brake Foot Pedal
595BKX None
BC PROG, TRACTION CONTROL IND {Bendix ATC ENABLE/DISABLE} With Traction
Warning Light, for Air Brakes
595BKY None
BC PROG, PTO SHIFT for (1) Dash Switch with 30 AMP Relay, for Customer Provided
PTO
595BKZ None BC PROG, HVAC 2010, In Cab With Remote AC Condenser
595BLA None BC PROG, HVAC 2010, In Cab & Sleeper With Remote AC Condenser
595BLB None
BC PROG, HVAC 2010 in Cab With Remote AC Condenser, with Pinout/Relay Drivers 31
& 32
595BLM None BC PROG, HVAC Condenser Pusher Fan Control
595BLN None BC PROG, HEADLIGHTS WIG WAG With Highbeam Flash
595BLP None BC PROG, HEADLIGHTS WIG WAG With Lowbeam or Highbeam Flash
595BLS None
BC PROG, AIR SUSP LOAD CONTRL for Tandem Weight Bias Suspension Air Control
Valve
2007 BC
595 CODE
ESC 595 CODE POST 2007 Feature Description
***All denotes 2000, DuraStar, WorkStar, 8000, Bus and Prostar Models***
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 32 - PAGE 21
CROSS REFERENCE
595BLT None BC PROG, SNOW VALVE Engine Air Intake
595BLU None BC PROG, REAR AXLE LOAD MONITOR #7 for Tandem Hendrickson HAS 40-6-K
595BLV None BC PROG, REAR AXLE LOAD MONITOR #2 for Single HAS 23K
595BLW None BC PROG, REAR AXLE LOAD MONITOR #3 for Single IROS Long MSM 12-15.5K
595BLX None BC PROG, REAR AXLE LOAD MONITOR #4 for Single IROS Long MSM 18-21K
595BLY None BC PROG, REAR AXLE LOAD MONITOR #5 for Single IROS Short MSM 20K
595BLZ None BC PROG, REAR AXLE LOAD MONITOR #6 for Tandem Hendrickson HTB 40K
595BMA None BC PROG, ROLL STABILLITY PROG {Wabco}
595BMH None BC PROG, TRANS HILL START AID for Ultra Shift Plus Transmission
595BMJ None BC PROG, FOG LIGHTS REAR ECE R38 Compliant, Red LED
595BMK None BC PROG, FOG LIGHTS ECE R19/48 Compliant
595BML None BC PROG, DAYTIME RUN/LIGHT ECE R87/48 Compliant
595BMN None BC PROG, IND DAY RUN/LIGHTS ECE R48, On Dash
595BMS None
BC PROG, TRACTION CONTROL IND {Bendix ATC Enable/Disable} with Traction
Warning Light, for Air Brakes, with 2010 Cluster
595BMT None BC PROG, IND LIGHT AIR BRAKE Pressure Failure
595BMU None BC PROG, ADJ SPEED LIMIT Include Switch in Center Panel
595BMV None BC PROG, ACCELERATOR INTERLOCK
595BMW None BC PROG, UPSHIFT INDICATOR LIGHT
595BMX None BC PROG, USER ACTIVATED DATA Logger
595BMY None BC PROG, ELECTRICAL LOAD CONTRL 11.8 Volts
595BMZ None
BC PROG, PARKED REGEN SWITCH 2010, Aftertreatment to Allow Parked Regen Below
Light Level for Service Use Only, Do Not Infuse
595BNA None
BC PROG, BRAKE LT W/Retarder ECE or ADR Compliant; Brake Light ON with Retarder
Activated
595BNB None BC PROG, DM1 HEARTBEAT for pre 2007 Engines
595BNJ None BC PROG, HYDRAULIC BRAKE SPLIT for Hydro Max
595BNN None BC PROG, TRANSMISSION PTO Dual PTO, for 2010 with 42 Parameters
595BNP None BC PROG, TRANSMISSION PTO, Single PTO, for 2010 with 42 Parameters
595BNY None BC PROG, ENGINE FAN WARNING BUZZER
595BPB None BC PROG, ENGINE FAN DRIVE Variable Speed
595BPC None BC PROG, CRUISE SWITCH DISABLE with Park Brake Set
595BPD None
BC PROG, PRNDL with 1000/2000 6 SPD Transmission not With Power Park or Park
Prawl
595BPE None
BC PROG, PRNDL with 1000/2000 6 SPD Transmission With Park Prawl and Shifter
Interlock
595BPG None
BC PROG, PRNDL with 1000/2000 6 SPD Transmission With Power Park and Shifter
Interlock
595BPK None
BC PROG, PRNDL with 1000/2000 6 SPD Transmission With Sixth-Gear Disable and
Park Prawl and Shifter Interlock
595BPK None
BC PROG, PRNDL with 1000/2000 6 SPD Transmission With Sixth-Gear Disable not With
Power Park or Park Prawl
595BPM None
BC PROG, PRNDL with 1000/2000 6 SPD Transmission With Sixth-Gear Disable and
Power Park and Shifter Interlock
None 595006 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595010 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595013 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595020 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595025 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595026 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595027 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595028 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595029 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595035 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595036 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595042 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595045 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595046 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595049 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595050 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
2007 BC
595 CODE
ESC 595 CODE POST 2007 Feature Description
***All denotes 2000, DuraStar, WorkStar, 8000, Bus and Prostar Models***
32 - PAGE 22 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
CROSS REFERENCE
None 595054 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595057 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595058 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595059 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595064 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595065 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595068 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595070 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595071 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595072 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595073 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595074 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595076 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595077 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595078 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595079 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595080 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595081 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595082 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595084 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595085 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595088 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595089 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595090 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595094 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595095 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595096 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595098 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595101 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595102 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595103 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595104 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595109 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595117 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595123 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595124 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595128 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595131 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595132 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595133 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595134 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595135 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595136 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595138 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595139 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595140 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595141 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595142 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595144 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595147 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595148 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595149 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595152 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595154 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595169 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595176 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595177 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595187 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595194 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595195 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
2007 BC
595 CODE
ESC 595 CODE POST 2007 Feature Description
***All denotes 2000, DuraStar, WorkStar, 8000, Bus and Prostar Models***
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 32 - PAGE 23
CROSS REFERENCE
None 595199 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595204 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595207 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595209 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595220 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595222 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595229 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595233 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595234 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595235 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595242 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595243 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595247 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595256 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595280 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595281 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595289 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595302 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595303 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595304 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595309 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595310 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595311 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595320 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595341 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595342 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
None 595347 Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
2007 BC
595 CODE
ESC 595 CODE POST 2007 Feature Description
***All denotes 2000, DuraStar, WorkStar, 8000, Bus and Prostar Models***
32 - PAGE 24 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
CROSS REFERENCE
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 INDEX-1
INDEX
INDEX
Numerics
3200, DuraStar, WorkStar Models............................06-1
595 Feature Codes Sorted by Post-2007
Feature Code Number......................................32-13
595 Feature Codes Sorted by Pre-2007
Feature Code Number........................................32-1
A
A/C Compressor Accom. Dual ..................................15-3
Accessory Wiring.....................................................24-39
Air Conditioning.........................................................15-1
Alarm, Parking Brake................................................11-3
Automatic Transmission Interfaces...........................16-1
Auxiliary 40 Amp Circuit, Switch Controlled..............14-5
Auxiliary 7-Way Trailer Socket ................................13-10
Auxiliary Front Lights.................................................12-9
Auxiliary Harness for Auxiliary Power Source.........13-14
B
Battery Disconnect Switch.........................................07-5
Battery Warning Indicator..........................................07-8
Battery, Ignition & Accessory Taps...........................07-1
BC Connector J1 (1603)............................................06-8
BC Connector J2 (1604)............................................06-9
BC Connector J3 (1600)............................................06-2
BC Connector J4 (1601)............................................06-4
BC Connector J5 (1602)............................................06-6
Body Builder Integration Harness..............................22-1
Body Builder Wiring..........................................13-5, 22-2
Body Builder Wiring At End of Frame........................13-3
Body Builder Wiring for Stop/Tail/Turn Lights............13-1
Body Controller..........................................................06-1
Body Integrated, Indicator Lights (Utility Solutions)...21-5
Body Integration, I/O Expansion Harness.................22-1
Brake Applied BC Connections.................................31-2
C
CB & 2-Way Radio Accommodation Packages.........08-1
CB Radios.................................................................08-1
Center Chassis Extension Harness.........................13-13
Circuit Protection Devices.........................................04-2
Color Code System for International Truck.............04-1
Connectors 4450 and 4460.......................................04-3
Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeve Installation.................04-6
Cross Reference.......................................................32-1
D
Dash Indicator Lights...............................................21-12
Data Link Repair........................................................04-6
Dome Light Features.................................................31-1
Dual Output Latched Switch 40 Amps.......................20-1
Dump Box Indicator Lights And Alarm......................21-9
E
Eaton 6-Spd Hybrid Without ePTO Capability.........30-20
Electric Trailer Brakes.............................................13-15
Electrical Components Commonly Used
By Equipment Installers......................................04-2
Electrical Dos and Don'ts........................................04-15
Electrical Functionality Without Associated
Feature Codes....................................................31-1
Electrical Load Control 11.8 Volts.............................11-7
ePTO.......................................................................30-12
ePTO Demand Circuits.............................................30-2
ePTO Open Center Hydraulic Systems.....................30-6
Extending Tail Light Harnesses...............................13-11
F
Fog Light Installation.................................................12-7
Fog, Plow, Guide post & Wig Wag Accommodation
Packages............................................................12-1
Fog/Driving Lights.....................................................12-1
Front Guide Post Lights...........................................12-13
Fused Battery Connections Inside Cab.....................10-1
INDEX-2 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
INDEX
G
General Electrical ......................................................04-1
H
Hazard Light Override Stop Lights............................11-5
Headlight Warning Buzzer.........................................11-6
Headlights On W/Wipers...........................................07-4
Headlights Wig Wag................................................12-14
HEV Signals Available to Advanced Logic..............30-13
High Voltage Circuits (Greater Than 50 Volts) on
International Trucks and Buses......................04-10
How Do I - General Information...............................04-18
How to Identify High Voltage Circuits......................04-12
Hybrid Display Located in Auxiliary Gauge
and Switch Pack...............................................30-22
Hybrid Electric Vehicle...............................................30-1
I
In-Cab Lighting..........................................................14-9
Indicator Lights and Alarms.......................................21-1
Instrument Cluster Adding Air Gauges...................17-3
Instrument Cluster - Adding Gauges.........................17-6
Instrument Cluster - Fault Codes.............................17-11
Instrument Cluster - Omit Fault Codes....................17-11
J
J1939 High Speed Data Link Cable........................04-10
J1939 High Speed Data Link Cable (SAE J1939/15) 04-1
Junction Block Stud...................................................22-3
K
Keyless Entry System Remote/Window, Power........09-1
L
Lift Gate Accommodation Package...........................27-1
Lights On With Wipers (LOWW)/Day Time
Running Lights (DTRL) .....................................14-10
O
One Interlocked Latched Switch Disengage
at 30 MPH...........................................................20-2
One Momentary Rocker Switch/Remote Switch
Capability..........................................................20-14
Other External Lighting..............................................14-6
P
Park Brake Applied BC Connections.........................31-2
Parts Information.......................................................09-5
Power Features Using Remote Power Modules........20-1
Power Source for Lift Gate........................................27-1
Power Take Off (PTO)...............................................23-1
Power Windows, Locks, Remote Keyless Entry........09-1
PowerPack 3 for Mobile Operation..........................28-15
PowerPack 3 Primary and Temporary Mount
Features..............................................................28-1
Productivity Features.................................................11-1
PTO Accommodation Cable Shift..............................23-1
PTO Accommodation Electric Over Air Clutched....23-35
PTO Accommodation Electric over Air
Non-Clutched....................................................23-26
PTO Accommodation for Electric over
Hydraulic
PTO...................................................................23-17
PTO Accommodation Muncie Powerflex*
Lectra-Shift..........................................................23-6
PTO Control.............................................................23-54
PTO Control Only for Line Haul and ProStar
Models..............................................................23-60
PTO Hourmeter.......................................................23-83
Push Buttons - Left Side of Cluster Table.................19-3
R
Radios, 2-Way...........................................................08-2
Recommended Circuit Protection..............................04-1
Remote Air Solenoid Module.....................................25-1
Remote Engine Speed Control Caterpillar and
Cummins Engines.............................................24-39
Electrical Data Body Builder Book October 2012 INDEX-3
INDEX
Remote Engine Speed Control features....................24-1
Remote Mounted Engine Control ............................24-13
Remote Power Modules............................................18-1
Remote Start/Stop.....................................................26-1
Remote Start/Stop with Emergency Pump................26-3
Remote Throttle Control Interlocked to Park Brake
Applied..............................................................24-21
Routing Guidelines..................................................04-14
Run/Stop Diesel Engine..........................................30-10
S
Safety Information.....................................................01-1
Seatbelt Warning Prewire..........................................11-6
Servicing Navistar Products....................................04-12
Splice Clip Installation...............................................04-4
Splice Inspection.......................................................04-5
Standard Battery and Ignition Taps...........................07-1
Standard Tail, Marker, and Clearance Lamp
Connection..........................................................13-1
Standard Terminals and Splices...............................04-3
Stop/Turn/Tail............................................................13-1
Suppression............................................................04-13
Switch Actuators for Multiplex System......................19-2
Switch, Air Horn, Passenger, Fire Truck...................25-5
Switches and Switch Label part Numbers and
Information..........................................................19-1
T
TEM Air Solenoids.....................................................25-1
Test Exterior Lamps Except Back Ups......................11-1
Theft Deterrent .................................................29-1, 30-1
Three Interlocked Latched Switches Disengage
at 30 MPH with PTO Accommodation..............23-44
Three Momentary Rocker Switches/Remote Switch
Capability..........................................................20-19
Throttle, Hand Control, Mobile, Variable Speed......24-13
Throttle, Hand Control, Stationary Pre-Set..............24-12
Throttle, Hand Control, Stationary, Variable Speed24-12
Trailer Auxiliary Feed Circuit, 30 Amp
Accessory Feed................................................13-11
Trailer Sockets........................................................13-18
Transmission Spare Inputs/Outputs and Transmission
Codes.................................................................16-1
Two Indicator Lights and Audible Alarms
Programmable Mode for Various Switch
Actions (Waste Solution) ....................................21-1
Two Interlocked Latched Switch Disengage
at 30 MPH...........................................................20-7
Two Momentary Rocker Switches/Remote Switch
Capability..........................................................20-16
U
Understanding High Voltage Equipment and
Circuits on International Products..................04-11
W
Windshield Wiper Speed Control ..............................11-4
Wire Splicing.............................................................04-7
Work Light and Outside Cab Power Features...........14-1
Work Light/Auxiliary Rear Light.................................14-1
INDEX-4 October 2012 Electrical Data Body Builder Book
INDEX